Documente Academic
Documente Profesional
Documente Cultură
CONTENTS
Foreword
SECTION 1 GENERAL
Group 1 Safety Hints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
Group 2 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10
Group 3 Operational checkout record sheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23
SECTION 2 ENGINE
Group 1 Structure and function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
Group 2 Engine speed & stall rpm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14
Group 3 Fuel warmer system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15
1. STRUCTURE
This service manual has been prepared as an aid to improve the quality of repairs by giving the
serviceman an accurate understanding of the product and by showing him the correct way to
perform repairs and make judgements. Make sure you understand the contents of this manual and
use it to full effect at every opportunity.
This service manual mainly contains the necessary technical information for operations performed in
a service workshop.
For ease of understanding, the manual is divided into the following sections.
The specifications contained in this shop manual are subject to change at any time and without any
advance notice. Contact your Hyundai distributor for the latest information.
0-1
2. HOW TO READ THE SERVICE MANUAL
Distribution and updating Revised edition mark (①②③…)
Any additions, amendments or other changes When a manual is revised, an edition mark is
will be sent to HYUNDAI distributors. recorded on the bottom outside corner of the
Get the most up-to-date information before you pages.
start any work.
Revisions
Filing method Revised pages are shown at the list of revised
1. See the page number on the bottom of the pages on the between the contents page and
page. section 1 page.
File the pages in correct order.
2. Following examples shows how to read the Symbols
page number. So that the shop manual can be of ample
Example 1 practical use, important places for safety and
3-3 quality are marked with the following symbols.
Section number (3. Power train
system)
Consecutive page number for Symbol Item Remarks
each section.
Special safety precautions are
3. Additional pages : Additional pages are necessary when performing the
indicated by a hyphen(-) and number after the work.
Safety
page number. File as in the example. Extra special safety precautions
10 - 4 are necessary when performing
10 - 4 - 1 the work because it is under
Added pages internal pressure.
10 - 4 - 2
10 - 5 Special technical precautions or
※ Caution
other precautions for preserving
standards are necessary when
performing the work.
0-2
3. CONVERSION TABLE
Method of using the Conversion Table
The Conversion Table in this section is provided to enable simple conversion of figures. For details of
the method of using the Conversion Table, see the example given below.
Example
1. Method of using the Conversion Table to convert from millimeters to inches
Convert 55 mm into inches.
(1) Locate the number 50 in the vertical column at the left side, take this as ⓐ, then draw a horizontal
line from ⓐ.
(2) Locate the number 5in the row across the top, take this as ⓑ, then draw a perpendicular line
down from ⓑ.
(3) Take the point where the two lines cross as ⓒ. This point ⓒ gives the value when converting
from millimeters to inches. Therefore, 55 mm = 2.165 inches.
Millimeters to inches ⓑ
1mm = 0.03937 in
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
0-3
Millimeters to inches 1mm = 0.03937in
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
50 1.969 2.008 2.047 2.087 2.126 2.165 2.205 2.244 2.283 2.323
60 2.362 2.402 2.441 2.480 2.520 2.559 2.598 2.638 2.677 2.717
70 2.756 2.795 2.835 2.874 2.913 2.953 2.992 3.032 3.071 3.110
80 3.150 3.189 3.228 3.268 3.307 3.346 3.386 3.425 3.465 3.504
90 3.543 3.583 3.622 3.661 3.701 3.740 3.780 3.819 3.858 3.898
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
50 110.23 112.44 114.64 116.85 119.05 121.25 123.46 125.66 127.87 130.07
60 132.28 134.48 136.69 138.89 141.10 143.30 145.51 147.71 149.91 152.12
70 154.32 156.53 158.73 160.94 163.14 165.35 167.55 169.76 171.96 174.17
80 176.37 178.57 180.78 182.98 185.19 187.39 189.60 191.80 194.01 196.21
90 198.42 200.62 202.83 205.03 207.24 209.44 211.64 213.85 216.05 218.26
0-4
Liter to U.S. Gallon 1ℓ = 0.2642 U.S.Gal
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
50 13.209 13.473 13.737 14.001 14.265 14.529 14.795 15.058 15.322 15.586
60 15.850 16.115 16.379 16.643 16.907 17.171 17.435 17.700 17.964 18.228
70 18.492 18.756 19.020 19.285 19.549 19.813 20.077 20.341 20.605 20.870
80 21.134 21.398 21.662 21.926 22.190 22.455 22.719 22.983 23.247 23.511
90 23.775 24.040 24.304 24.568 24.832 25.096 25.631 25.625 25.889 26.153
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
50 10.998 11.281 11.438 11.658 11.878 12.098 12.318 12.528 12.758 12.978
60 13.198 13.418 13.638 13.858 14.078 14.298 14.518 14.738 14.958 15.178
70 15.398 15.618 15.838 16.058 16.278 16.498 16.718 16.938 17.158 17.378
80 17.598 17.818 18.037 18.257 18.477 18.697 18.917 19.137 19.357 19.577
90 19.797 20.017 20.237 20.457 20.677 20.897 21.117 21.337 21.557 21.777
0-5
kgf·m to lbf
kgf lbf·ftft 1kgf·m = 7.233lbf·ft
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
50 361.7 368.9 376.1 383.4 390.6 397.8 405.1 412.3 419.5 426.8
60 434.0 441.2 448.5 455.7 462.9 470.2 477.4 484.6 491.8 499.1
70 506.3 513.5 520.8 528.0 535.2 542.5 549.7 556.9 564.2 571.4
80 578.6 585.9 593.1 600.3 607.6 614.8 622.0 629.3 636.5 643.7
90 651.0 658.2 665.4 672.7 679.9 687.1 694.4 701.6 708.8 716.1
100 723.3 730.5 737.8 745.0 752.2 759.5 766.7 773.9 781.2 788.4
110 795.6 802.9 810.1 817.3 824.6 831.8 839.0 846.3 853.5 860.7
120 868.0 875.2 882.4 889.7 896.9 904.1 911.4 918.6 925.8 933.1
130 940.3 947.5 954.8 962.0 969.2 976.5 983.7 990.9 998.2 10005.4
140 1012.6 1019.9 1027.1 1034.3 1041.5 1048.8 1056.0 1063.2 1070.5 1077.7
150 1084.9 1092.2 1099.4 1106.6 1113.9 1121.1 1128.3 1135.6 1142.8 1150.0
160 1157.3 1164.5 1171.7 1179.0 1186.2 1193.4 1200.7 1207.9 1215.1 1222.4
170 1129.6 1236.8 1244.1 1251.3 1258.5 1265.8 1273.0 1280.1 1287.5 1294.7
180 1301.9 1309.2 1316.4 1323.6 1330.9 1338.1 1345.3 1352.6 1359.8 1367.0
190 1374.3 1381.5 1388.7 1396.0 1403.2 1410.4 1417.7 1424.9 1432.1 1439.4
0-6
kgf/cm2 to lbf/in2 1kgf / cm2 = 14.2233lbf / in2
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
50 711.2 725.4 739.6 753.8 768.1 782.3 796.5 810.7 825.0 839.2
60 853.4 867.6 881.8 896.1 910.3 924.5 938.7 953.0 967.2 981.4
70 995.6 1010 1024 1038 1053 1067 1081 1095 1109 1124
80 1138 1152 1166 1181 1195 1209 1223 1237 1252 1266
90 1280 1294 1309 1323 1337 1351 1365 1380 1394 1408
100 1422 1437 1451 1465 1479 1493 1508 1522 1536 1550
110 1565 1579 1593 1607 1621 1636 1650 1664 1678 1693
120 1707 1721 1735 1749 1764 1778 1792 1806 1821 1835
130 1849 2863 1877 1892 1906 1920 1934 1949 1963 1977
140 1991 2005 2020 2034 2048 2062 2077 2091 2105 2119
150 2134 2148 2162 2176 2190 2205 2219 2233 2247 2262
160 2276 2290 2304 2318 2333 2347 2361 2375 2389 2404
170 2418 2432 2446 2460 2475 2489 2503 2518 2532 2546
180 2560 2574 2589 5603 2617 2631 2646 2660 2674 2688
200 2845 2859 2873 2887 2901 2916 2930 2944 2958 2973
210 2987 3001 3015 3030 3044 3058 3072 3086 3101 3115
220 3129 3143 3158 3172 3186 3200 3214 3229 3243 3257
230 3271 3286 3300 3314 3328 3343 3357 3371 3385 3399
240 3414 3428 3442 3456 3470 3485 3499 3513 3527 3542
0-7
TEMPERATURE
Fahrenheit-Centigrade Conversion.
A simple way to convert a fahrenheit temperature reading into a centigrade temperature reading or vice verse
is to enter the accompanying table in the center or boldface column of figures.
These figures refer to the temperature in either Fahrenheit or Centigrade degrees.
If it is desired to convert from Fahrenheit to Centigrade degrees, consider the center column as a table of
Fahrenheit temperatures and read the corresponding Centigrade temperature in the column at the left.
If it is desired to convert from Centigrade to Fahrenheit degrees, consider the center column as a table of
Centigrade values, and read the corresponding Fahrenheit temperature on the right.
˚C ˚F ˚C ˚F ˚C ˚F ˚C ˚F
-40.4 -40 -40.0 -11.7 11 51.8 7.8 46 114.8 27.2 81 117.8
-37.2 -35 -31.0 -11.1 12 53.6 8.3 47 116.6 27.8 82 179.6
-34.4 -30 -22.0 -10.6 13 55.4 8.9 48 118.4 28.3 83 181.4
-31.7 -25 -13.0 -10.0 14 57.2 9.4 49 120.2 28.9 84 183.2
-28.9 -20 -4.0 -9.4 15 59.0 10.0 50 122.0 29.4 85 185.0
0-8
SECTION 1 GENERAL
73031GE01
75791GE01
1-1
PREPARE FOR EMERGENCIES
Be prepared if a fire starts.
Keep a first aid kit and fire extinguisher handy.
Keep emergency numbers for doctors,
ambulance ser vice, hospital, and fire
department near your telephone.
73031GE03
73031GE04
73031GE05
1-2
PARK MACHINE SAFELY
Before working on the machine:
· Park machine on a level surface.
· Lower bucket to the ground.
· Turn key switch to OFF to stop engine.
Remove key from switch.
· Move pilot control shutoff lever to locked
position.
· Allow engine to cool. 73031GE23
73031GE07
73031GE08
1-3
Store flammable fluids away from fire hazards.
Do not incinerate or puncture pressurized
containers.
Make sure machine is clean of trash,
grease, and debris.
Do not store oily rags ; They can ignite and
burn spontaneously.
73031GE09
1-4
ILLUMINATE WORK AREA SAFELY
Illuminate your work area adequately but safely.
Use a portable safety light for working inside or
under the machine. Make sure the bulb is
enclosed by a wire cage. The hot filament of an
accidentally broken bulb can ignite spilled fuel
or oil.
73031GE11
73031GE13
1-5
AVOID HIGH PRESSURE FLUIDS
Escaping fluid under pressure can penetrate the
skin causing serious injury.
Avoid the hazard by relieving pressure before
disconnecting hydraulic or other lines. Tighten
all connections before applying pressure.
Search for leaks with a piece of cardboard.
Protect hands and body from high pressure
73031GE14
fluids.
If an accident occurs, see a doctor immediately.
Any fluid injected into the skin must be
surgically removed within a few hours or
gangrene may result.
73031GE15
other materials.
1-6
PREVENT ACID BURNS
Sulfuric acid in battery electrolyte is poisonous. It
is strong enough to burn skin, eat holes in
clothing, and cause blindness if splashed into
eyes.
1. Avoid the hazard by:
2. Filling batteries in a well-ventilated area.
3. Wearing eye protection and rubber gloves.
Avoiding breathing fumes when electrolyte
is added.
4. Avoiding spilling of dripping electrolyte.
5. Use proper jump start procedure.
1. If you spill acid on yourself:
2. Flush your skin with water.
Apply baking soda or lime to help neutralize
the acid.
3. Flush your eyes with water for 10-15 minutes.
Get medical attention immediately.
1. If acid is swallowed:
2. Drink large amounts of water or milk.
Then drink milk of magnesia, beaten eggs,
or vegetable oil.
73031GE18
3. Get medical attention immediately.
1-7
SERVICE TIRES SAFELY
Explosive separation of a tire and rim parts can
cause serious injury or death.
Do not attempt to mount a tire unless you have the
proper equipment and experience to perform the job.
Always maintain the correct tire pressure. Do not
inflate the tires above the recommended pressure.
Never weld or heat a wheel and tire assembly.
The heat can cause an increase in air pressure
resulting in a tire explosion.
Welding can structurally weaken or deform the
wheel.
When inflating tires, use a clip-on chuck and
extension hose long enough to allow you to stand
to one side and not in front of or over the tire
assembly. Use a safety cage if available.
Check wheels for low pressure, cuts, bubbles, 73031GE24
73031GE25
1-8
REPLACE SAFETY SIGNS
Replace missing or damaged safety signs.
See the machine operator's manual for correct
safety sign placement.
73031GE21
K E E P RO P S I N S TA L L E D P RO P E R LY
(option)
Make certain all parts are reinstalled correctly if
the roll-over protective structure (ROPS) is
loosened or removed for any reason. Tighten
mounting bolts to proper torque.
The protection offered by ROPS will be
impaired if ROPS is subjected to structural
damage, is involved in an overturn incident, or is
in any way altered by welding, bending, drilling, 73031GE22
or cutting. A damaged ROPS should be
replaced, not reused.
1-9
GROUP 2 SPECIFICATION
1. MAJOR COMPONENT
Precleaner(option)
Bucket link Bell crank Steering cylinder Cab Rain cap(std) Muffler Engine
Front axle Boom cylinder Main pump Transmission Rear axle Fuel tank
7809S2SE01
1-10
2. SPECIFICATIONS
1) WITH BOLT-ON CUTTING EDGE TYPE BUCKET (HL780-9S)
6160
B
F
I
H
4150
C
G
K
40
D
6
758 430
5 E
A
7809S2SE03
1-11
WITH BOLT-ON CUTTING EDGE TYPE BUCKET (HL780XTD-9S)
6590
B
F
I
H
4930
C
G
K
40
D
64
779 30
0 E
A
7809S2SE03-1
1-12
2) WITH TOOTH TYPE BUCKET (HL780-9S)
6160
J
B
F
I
H
4150
C
G
K
40
D
64
767 30
0 E
A
7809S2SE04
1-13
WITH TOOTH TYPE BUCKET (HL780XTD-9S)
6590
J
B
F
I
4930
H
C
G
K
40
D
64
787 30
5 E
A
7809S2SE04-1
1-14
3. WEIGHT
Item kg lb
Front frame assembly 2697 5950
Rear frame assembly 3595 7930
Front fender (LH & RH) 48 106
Counterweight 1300 2870
Additional counterweight (HL780XTD-9S) 552 1220
Cab assembly 780 1720
Engine assembly 984 2170
Transmission assembly 780 1720
Drive shaft (front) 25 55
Drive shaft (center) 48 106
Drive shaft (rear) 30 66
Drive shaft (upper) 14 31
Front axle (include differential) 1814 4000
Rear axle (include differential) 1805 3980
Tire (29.5-25, 22PR, L3) 430 948
Hydraulic tank assembly 300 661
Fuel tank assembly 374 825
Main pump 38.6 85
Steering pump 38.6 85
Main control valve (2 / 3 spool) 95 / 115 209 / 254
Flow amplifier 29 64
HL780-9S 2060 4540
Boom assembly
HL780XTD-9S 2260 4980
Bell crank assembly 282 620
Bucket link 55 120
5.1 m3 bucket, with bolt on cutting edge 2590 5710
4.8 m3 bucket, with tooth 2460 5420
Boom cylinder assembly (2EA) 290 639
Bucket cylinder assembly (2EA) 130 287
Steering cylinder assembly (2EA) 60 132
Seat 40 88
Battery 55 121
1-15
4. SPECIFICATION FOR MAJOR COMPONENTS
1) ENGINE
Item Specification
Model Cummins QSM 11
Type 4-cycle turbocharged, charge air cooled diesel engine
Control type Electronic control
Cooling method Water cooling
Number of cylinders and arrangement 6 cylinders, in-line
Firing order 1-5-3-6-2-4
Combustion chamber type Direct injection type
Cylinder bore × stroke 125×147 mm (4.92"×5.79")
Piston displacement 10800 cc (659 cu in)
Compression ratio 16.3 : 1
Rated gross horse power 353 ps at 2000 rpm
Maximum gross torque at 1400 rpm 171 kgf·m (1235 lbf·ft)
Engine oil quantity 38ℓ (10 U.S. gal)
Wet weight 984 kg (2170 lb)
High idling speed 2130 ± 50 rpm
Low idling speed 800 ± 50 rpm
Rated fuel consumption 218 g/kw·hr
Starting motor Delco Remy 39MT (24 V)
Alternator Delco Remy 24SI (24 V - 70 Amp)
Battery 2×12V×220Ah
1-16
2) MAIN PUMP (+ BRAKE PUMP)
Specification
Item
Main pump Brake pump
Type Fixed displacement double vane pump
Capacity 113.5 cc/rev 15.9 cc/rev
Maximum operating pressure 210 kgf/cm2 (2990 psi) 150 kgf/cm2 (2130 psi)
Rated oil quantity 212ℓ/min (56 U.S.gpm) 30ℓ/min (7.9 U.S.gpm)
Rated speed 2000 rpm
1-17
6) CYLINDER
Item Specification
Boom cylinder Bore dia×Rod dia×Stroke Ø200×Ø110×863 mm
Bucket cylinder Bore dia×Rod dia×Stroke Ø160×Ø 80×580 mm
Steering cylinder Bore dia×Rod dia×Stroke Ø110×Ø 55×480 mm
Item Specification
Model ZF 4WG310
Converter Single-stage, double-phase
Type
Transmission Full-automatic power shift
Converter stall ratio 2.51 : 1
Transmission
Gear shift Forward fourth gear, reverse third gear
Electrical single lever type, kick-down system,
Control Automatic kick down from 2nd to 1st gear
FNR Switch on joystick lever (option)
Pump rated flow 105ℓ/min (27.7 U.S.gpm) at 2000 rpm
Drive devices 4-wheel drive
Axle Front Front fixed location
Rear Oscillation ±13˚ of center pin-loaded
Wheels Tires 29.5-25, 22PR (L3)
Travel Four-wheel, wet-disc type, full hydraulic
Brakes
Parking Spring applied, hydraulic released brake
Type Full hydraulic, articulated
Steering
Steering angle 40˚ to both right and left angle, respectively
1-18
5. TIGHTENING TORQUE OF MAJOR COMPONENT
Torque
No. Descriptions Bolt size
kgf·m lbf·ft
1 Engine mounting bolt, nut (rubber, 4EA) M24×3.0 100 ± 15.0 723 ± 108
2 Engine mounling bolt (flywheel housing, 14EA) M10×1.5 4.6 ± 0.7 33.3 ± 5.1
3 Engine mounling bolt (coupling, 8EA) 1/2-13UNC 8.37 ± 0.41 53.3 ± 3.0
Engine
4 Engine mounting bolt (gear housing, 6EA) M10×1.5 4.6 ± 0.7 33.3 ± 5.1
5 Radiator mounting bolt M20×2.5 57.9 ± 8.7 419 ± 62.9
6 Fuel tank mounting bolt, nut M16×2.0 29.7 ± 4.5 215 ± 32.5
7 Main pump housing mounting bolt M16×2.0 29.7 ± 4.5 215 ± 32.5
8 Steering pump housing mounting bolt M16×2.0 29.7 ± 4.5 215 ± 32.5
9 Main control valve mounting bolt M12×1.75 12.8 ± 3.0 92.6 ± 21.7
10 Steering unit mounting bolt M10×1.5 6.9 ± 1.4 49.9 ± 10.1
11 Hydraulic Flow amplifier mounting bolt M10×1.5 6.9 ± 1.4 49.9 ± 10.1
12 system Brake valve mounting bolt M8×1.25 2.5 ± 0.5 18.1 ± 3.6
13 Cut-off valve mounting bolt M12×1.75 12.3 ± 2.0 89.0 ± 14
14 Remote control lever mounting bolt M6×1.0 1.1 ± 0.2 8.0 ± 1.4
15 Safety valve M8×1.25 2.5 ± 0.5 18.1 ± 3.6
16 Hydraulic oil tank mounting bolt M20×2.5 57.9 ± 8.7 419 ± 62.9
17 Transmission mounting bolt, nut (rubber, 4EA) M24×3.0 100 ± 15.0 723 ± 108
18 Transmission mounting bolt (bracket, 8EA) M20×2.5 24.0 ± 2.4 174 ± 18.1
19 Transmission bolt (bracket, converter side) M16×2.0 18.4 ± 2.0 133 ± 14.5
20 Power train Front axle mounting bolt, nut M36×3.0 270 ± 30 1950 ± 217
21 system Rear axle support mounting bolt, nut M36×3.0 270 ± 30 1950 ± 217
22 Tire mounting nut M22×1.5 79 ± 2.5 571 ± 18
23 Drive shaft joint mounting bolt (front, center, rear) 1/2-20UNF 15.5 ± 0.5 112 ± 3.6
24 Drive shaft joint mounting bolt (upper) 1/2-20UNF 10.5 ± 0.5 75.9 ± 3.6
25 Counterweight mounting bolt M30×2.0 199 ± 30 1439 ± 217
26 Counterweight mounting bolt M24×3.0 100 ± 15 723 ± 108
Others
27 Operator's seat mounting bolt M8×1.25 3.4 ± 0.8 24.6 ± 5
28 Cab mounting bolt (4EA) M20×2.5 58 ± 8.7 419 ± 63
1-19
6. TORQUE CHART
1-20
2) PIPE AND HOSE (FLARE type)
Thread size Width across flat (mm) kgf·m lbf·ft
1/4" 19 4 28.9
3/8" 22 5 36.2
1/2" 27 9.5 68.7
3/4" 36 18 130
1" 41 21 152
1-1/4" 50 35 253
9/16-18 19 4 28.9
11/16-16 22 5 36.2
13/16-16 27 9.5 68.7
1-3/16-12 36 18 130
1-7/16-12 41 21 152
1-11/16-12 50 35 253
4) FITTING
1/4" 19 4 28.9
3/8" 22 5 36.2
1/2" 27 9.5 68.7
3/4" 36 18 130
1" 41 21 152
1-1/4" 50 35 253
1-21
7. RECOMMENDED LUBRICANTS
Use only oils listed below or equivalent.
Do not mix different brand oil.
Ambient temperature˚C (˚F)
Capacity
Service point Kind of fluid -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40
ℓ (U.S. gal)
(-4) (14) (32) (50) (68) (86) (104)
SAE 30
SAE 10W
Engine oil pan Engine oil 38 (10.0)
SAE 10W-30
SAE 15W-40
SAE 10W-30
Transmission Engine oil 43 (11.4)
SAE 15W-40
Front : 58 (15.3) ★
Axle UTTO Refer to below list
Rear : 58 (15.3)
ISO VG 32
Tank :
203 (53.6)
Hydraulic tank Hydraulic oil ISO VG 46
System :
336 (88.8)
ISO VG 68
NLGI NO.1
Fitting
Grease As required
(grease nipple) NLGI NO.2
Mixture of
antifreeze Ethylene glycol base permanent type
Radiator 65 (17.2)
and water
50 : 50
1-22
GROUP 3 OPERATIONAL CHECKOUT RECORD SHEET
·Owner :
·Date :
·Hours :
·Serial No. :
·Technician :
OK NOT
Item Comments
OK
1-23
4. Brake system and clutch cut off checks
5. Driving checks
1-24
7. Steering system checks
8. Accessory checks
1-25
SECTION 2 ENGINE
1. STRUCTURE
Exhaust manifold
Corrosion resistor
Dipstick
Coolant inlet
Filler cap
Oil filter
Oil pan sump heater
Oil drain
Compressor
mounting location
Electronic control
module(ECM)
Flywheel
Fuel inlet to pump
Fuel filter
Engine support
Oil pan
7807AEN01
· Direct 4-stroke, 6-cylinders, water-cooling and charge air cooled diesel engine in installed, cylinder
block and cylinder head are made of case iron and turbocharger is attached.
2-1
2. COMPONENTS
1) The ECM receives information from various
components in the QSM system.
2-2
5) The Oil Temperature Sensor is mounted in
the main oil rifle. It provides input to the
engine protection system.
2-3
9) The Boost Pressure Sensor is mounted
next to the intake manifold temperature
sensor. Its input is crucial to the precise
electronic control of fuel metering.
2-4
12) Engines with QSM systems will have a
service data link mounted next to the ECM.
This additional data link was added
because new calibration procedures
require that the key switch must be off
during calibration transfer. But many
OEM harnesses have a small amount of
voltage across the data link connection
even with the key off.
The OEM harness data link can be used
for all service tool operations except
transferring calibrations. Only the engine-
mounted data link should be used for
calibration transfer.
2-5
15) The potentiometer provides a DC voltage
signal propor tional to pedal angle
displacement.
The ECM sees this voltage signal as an
indication of throttle position.
2-6
19) It's a gear-type pump, using one-and-a-
quarter-inch gears.
The pressure regulator is set at
approximately 150 psi.
2-7
23) The QSM injector includes the top stop
shim; injector control valve; spring guide;
timing chamber; bias spring; metering
plunger; pressure relief valve; closed nozzle
subassembly, with its cup, needle valve and
return spring; metering check valve;
metering spill port; fuel drain passage; fuel
supply passage; timing plunger; bottom
stop shim; return spring; and the top stop
assembly.
2-8
27) The ECM determines the end of metering
by signaling the injector control valve to
open.
2-9
30) Now the timing plunger begins its
downward travel. Initially, the injector
control valve remains open, allowing fuel to
flow from the timing chamber, through the
injector control valve, to the fuel supply
passage.
2-10
34) Injection continues until the spill passage of
the metering plunger passes the metering
spill port.
Metering-chamber pressure drops rapidly,
allowing the needle valve to close abruptly.
This action results in a positive end of
injection. The positive end of injection
prevents dribble, and results in cleaner
burning.
It is also at this point that the pressure relief
valve "pops off" thereby reducing the
effects of the high pressure "spike" that
occurs at the time of metering spill. The
relief valve passage connects to the fuel
drain line.
2-11
37) To summarize QSM system operation, the
injector is camshaft-actuated to achieve
high pressures.
2-12
41) The primary diagnostic tool for use with the
QSM system will be the INSITE computer
based diagnostic tool.
Echek and Compulink cartridges will be
available for use with QSM.
2-13
GROUP 2 ENGINE SPEED & STALL RPM
1. TEST
TEST CONDITION
1) Normal temperature of the whole system
- Coolant : Approx 80˚C (176˚F)
- Hydraulic oil : 45 ± 5˚C (113 ± 10˚F)
- Transmission oil : 75 ± 5˚C (167 ± 10˚F)
2) Normal operating pressure : See page 6-47.
2. S
SPECIFICATION
PECIFICATION
Engine speed, rpm (P mode)
Remark
Low idle High idle Pump stall Converter stall Full stall Fan motor
800±25 2130±50 2040±70 2010±70 1530±100 1150±50
3. E
ENGINE
NGINE RPM CHECK
Remark : If the checked data is not normal, it indicates that the related system is not working properly.
Therefore, it is required to check the related system pressure : See page 6-47.
1) Pump stall rpm
- Start the engine and raise the bucket
approx 45 cm (1.5 ft) as the figure.
- Press the accelerator pedal fully and
45cm
M H
- Set the clutch cut off mode switch at the Clutch cut off mode switch
OFF position.
- Press the brake pedal and accelerator
pedal fully.
- Shift the transmission lever to the 4th
forward position.
- Check the engine rpm at the above 78092EG02
condition.
3) Full stall rpm
- Start the engine and raise the bucket
OFF
L
- Set the clutch cut off mode switch at the Clutch cut off mode switch
OFF position.
- Press the brake pedal and accelerator
45cm
pedal fully .
- Shift the transmission lever to the 4th
forward position and operate the bucket
lever to the retract position fully. 78092EG03
1. S
SPECIFICATION
PECIFICATION
1) Operating voltage : 24±4V
2) Power : 350±50W
3) Current : 15A
2. O
OPERATION
PERATION
1) T h e c u r r e n t o f f u e l w a r m e r s y s t e m i s Fuel warmer
automatically controlled without thermostat
according to fuel temperature.
2) At the first state, the 15A current flows to the fuel
warmer and engine may be started in 1~2 Prefilter
minutes.
3) If the fuel starts to flow, ceramic-disk in the fuel
warmer heater senses the fuel temperature to
reduce the current as low as 1.5A.
So, fuel is protected from overheating by this
2507A5MS12
mechanism.
3. E
ELECTRIC
LECTRIC CIRCUIT
CN-60
MASTER SW 40A
3R 104 104 3R 105 FUSE MAXI
3R 102 111 15R 106
80A
3R
15R
CN-95
CS-74 BATT. RY
80R 107 108
80R 109
BATTERY
CR-1
TO STARTER
MCU
AC COMP. OFF SIG_REVERSE FAN
AUDIO/ROOM LAMP
HORN/CONVERTER
WORK LAMP_REAR
AIR-CON/HEATER 1
AIR-CON/HEATER 2
JOYSTICK-DETENT
SPARE_HIGH SOURCE
BACK.STOP LAMP
JOYSTIC_SWITCH
RIDE CONTROL
CIGARLIGHTER
FAN REVERSE
FUEL WARMER
TURN LAMP
HEAD LAMP
FUEL WARMER
WIPER INT SIG
ILL.LAMP
BEACON
SPARE
WIPER
CAN2 LOW
PARK
FUSE BOX
WASH SIG
CAN2 HI
CN-36
10A
20A
20A
20A
20A
10A
20A
30A
20A
30A
20A
20A
20A
20A
20A
10A
20A
20A
10A
10A
20A
30A
10A
20A
20A
20A
10A
5A
A38
B14
B15
A16
A24
B40
B30
A05
A18
A08
A23
A31
A35
A26
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
L 380
CN-58B
CN-5
20
21
22
CR-25 23
86 30 87a 24
B G01A
85 25
87
RW 531
ECM POWER IG 26
86 27
85 87 87a R 530
30 28
ECM POWER RY 29
40
CR-35 31
86 30 87a 32 CN-13 FUEL WARMER
B G01
85 33 1 B
Gr 550
87 MCU POWER IG 30 2 A
RW 531
86 35 3
85 87 87a R 530 CN-96
30 4
POWER RY 5
6
LW 381
Y 370A
Y 370B
H BR ACC ST C
6 7
Y 370
L 380
5 CS-2
8
6
3 5
CR-46
CR-36
2
87
30
87a
85
85 8787a 86
4
B
1
1
5
3
2
4
RW 531
4 3
R 530
0, I
1 5 4
1
H 0 I II
86 30
2 3
RW 531
2
2-15
SECTION 3 POWER TRAIN SYSTEM
Front axle Front drive shaft Rear drive shaft Rear axle
Center drive shaft
78093PT01
3-1
HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT
KR K4 K1 K3 KV K2
P1 F 60 P2 E 55 P3 D 56 P4 C 58 P5 B 53 P6 A 57
B D B D B D B D B D B D
Pressure
Temp reducing
sensor valve
9+0.5 bar
System
pressure
Valve block control circuit valve
16+2 bar
Converter
Filter
Relief
valve
11+2 bar Filter pressure
differential valve
Oil cooler Bcak
pressure
valve Pump
Bypass 4.3+3 bar
valve 16+2 bar
3 bar
Oil sump
Lubrication Main oil circuit
7707APT09
Current
Forward Reverse Positions
Engaged No. of the
Speed Neutral on the
clutch measuring
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 valve block
points
Y1 X X X KR F 55
Y2 X K4 E 60
Y3 X X K1 D 56
Y4 X X X K3 C 58
Y5 X X X KV B 53
Y6 X X K2 A 57
Engaged
K1,KV KV,K2 KV,K3 K4,K3 KR,K1 KR,K2 KR, K3 - - -
clutch
X : Pressure regulator under voltage
3-2
2. TORQUE CONVERTER
5 1 2 3 4
7704PT03
The converter is working according to the Trilok-system, i.e. it assumes at high turbine speed the
characteristics, and with it the favorable efficiency of a fluid clutch.
The converter will be defined according to the engine power so that the most favorable operating
conditions for each installation case are given.
The Torque converter is composed of 3 main components :
Pump wheel - turbine wheel - stator (reaction member)
These 3 impeller wheels are arranged in such a ring-shape system that the fluid is streaming through
the circuit components in the indicated order.
Pressure oil is constantly streaming out of the transmission pump through the converter. In this way,
the converter can fulfill its task to multiply the torque of the engine, and at the same time, the heat
created in the converter is dissipated through the escaping oil.
The oil, escaping out of the pump wheel, enters the turbine wheel and is there inversed in the direction
of flow.
According to the rate of inversion, the turbine wheel and with it also the output shaft, receive a more or
less high reaction moment. The stator (reaction member), following the turbine, has the task to inverse
again the oil which is escaping out of the turbine and to delivery it under the suitable discharge direction
to the pump wheel.
Due to the inversion, the stator receives a reaction moment.
The relation turbine moment/pump moment is called torque conversion. This is the higher the greater
the speed difference of pump wheel and turbine wheel will be.
Therefore, the maximum conversion is created at standing turbine wheel.
With increasing output speed, the torque conversion is decreasing. The adoption of the output speed to
a certain required output moment is infinitely variable and automatically achieved by the torque
converter.
3-3
If the turbine speed is reaching about 80% of the pump speed, the conversion becomes 1.0 i.e. the
turbine moment becomes equal to that of the pump moment.
From this point on, the converter is working similar to a fluid clutch.
A stator freewheel serves to improve the efficiency in the upper driving range, it is backing up in the
conversion range the moment upon the housing, and is released in the coupling range.
In this way, the stator can rotate freely.
Pump wheel TR
Turbine wheel
From the engine
TT
TP
To the gearbox
Starting
condition 1 1.5 Reaction member 2.5
nT = 0
(Stator) Machine
stopped
Intermediate
condition 1 <1.5 <2.5 nT < n engine
Condition shortly
before the converter 1 1 nT = 0.8n engine
0
clutch is closed.
Turbine wheel is running with
about the same speed as
pump wheel.
3-4(770-3)
3-4
3. TRANSMISSION
1) LAYOUT
1 2 3 4
KV K1
KR K2
K4 K3
10
13 12 11
78093PT03
3-5
2) INSTALLATION VIEW
1 2 7 8 9 10 18 16 14 15 17 24 19 20
3 4 5 6 11 2' 12 13 23 22 21
7809S3PT05
1 Breather 12 Cover
2 Transmission suspension M16 13 Output flange
2' Transmission suspension M20 14 Pressure oil line clutch K2
3 Attachment possibility for an oil filler 15 Pressure oil line clutch KR
tube with oil dipstick. 16 Pressure oil line clutch KV
4 Output flange 17 1st power take off
5 Oil drain plug 18 2nd power take off
6 Coarse filter 19 Pressure oil line clutch K3
7 Input flange 20 Pressure oil line clutch K1
8 Converter bell 21 Lubricating oil line S2 clutch K4/K3
9 Lifting lug 22 Lubricating oil line S1 clutch KR/K2
10 Electrohydraulic shift controller 23 Parking brake
11 Gearbox housing 24 Pressure oil line clutch K4
3-6
3) OPERATION OF TRANSMISSION
(1) Forward
① Forward 1st
In 1st forward, forward clutch and 1st clutch are engaged.
Forward clutch and 1st clutch are actuated by the hydraulic pressure applied to the clutch piston.
INPUT
KV K1
KR K2
K4 K3
OUTPUT OUTPUT
78093PT07
3-7
② Forward 2nd
In 2nd forward, forward clutch and 2nd clutch are engaged.
forward clutch and 2nd clutch are actuated by the hydraulic pressure applied to the clutch piston.
INPUT
KV
K1
KR K2
K4 K3
OUTPUT OUTPUT
78093PT08
3-8
③ Forward 3rd
In 3rd forward, forward clutch and K3 (3rd) clutch are engage.
Forward clutch and 3rd clutch are actuated by the hydraulic pressure applied to the clutch piston.
INPUT
KV K1
KR K2
K4 K3
OUTPUT OUTPUT
78093PT09
3-9
④ Forward 4th
In 4th forward, 4th clutch and 3rd clutch are engaged.
4th clutch and 3rd clutch are actuated by the hydraulic pressure applied to the clutch piston.
INPUT
KV K1
KR K2
K4 K3
OUTPUT OUTPUT
78093PT10
3-10
(2) Reverse
① Reverse 1st
In 1st reverse, reverse clutch and 1st clutch are engaged.
reverse clutch and 1st clutch are actuated by the hydraulic pressure applied to the clutch piston.
INPUT
KV K1
KR K2
K4 K3
OUTPUT OUTPUT
78093PT11
3-11
② Reverse 2nd
In 2nd reverse, reverse clutch and 2nd clutch are engaged.
reverse clutch and 2nd clutch are actuated by the hydraulic pressure applied to the clutch piston.
INPUT
KV K1
KR K2
K4 K3
OUTPUT OUTPUT
78093PT12
3-12
③ Reverse 3rd
In 3rd reverse, reverse clutch and 3rd clutch are engaged.
reverse clutch and 3rd clutch are actuated by the hydraulic pressure applied to the clutch piston.
INPUT
KV K1
KR K2
K4 K3
OUTPUT OUTPUT
78093PT13
3-13
4) ELECTRO-HYDRAULIC SHIFT CONTROL WITH PROPORTIONAL VALVE
2 1 3
A A
Y6 Y1
Y5 Y2
B
Y4 Y3
3 6
2 6 1 4 11 9 10
Y5
Transmission control, see schedule of measuring points, hydraulic schematic and electro-hydraulic
control unit at page 3-2, 3-14 and 3-64.
The six clutches of the transmission are selected via the 6 proportional valves P1 to P6. The
proportional valve (pressure regulator unit) consists of pressure regulator (e.g. Y6), follow-on slide
and vibration damper.
The control pressure of 9 bar for the actuation of the follow-on slides is created by the pressure
reducing valve. The pressure oil (16+2bar) is directed via the follow-on slide to the respective
clutch.
3-14
Due to the direct proportional selection with separated pressure modulation for each clutch, the
pressures to the clutches, which are engaged in the gear change, will be controlled. In this way, a
hydraulic intersection of the clutches to be engaged and disengaged becomes possible.
This is creating spontaneous shiftings without traction force interruption.
At the shifting, the following criteria will be considered:
- Speed of engine, turbine, central gear train and output.
- Transmission temperature.
- Shifting mode (up-, down-, reverse shifting and speed engagement out of neutral).
- Load condition (full and part load, traction, overrun inclusive consideration of load cycles during
the shifting).
The main pressure valve is limiting the maximum control pressure to 16+2 bar and releases the
main stream to the converter and lubricating circuit.
In the inlet to the converter, a convert safety valve is installed which protects the converter from
high internal pressures (opening pressure 11bar).
Within the converter, the oil serves to transmit the power according to the well-known
hydrodynamic principle (see torque converter, page 3-3).
To avoid cavitation, the converter must be always completely filled with oil.
This is achieved by a converter pressure holding valve, rear-mounted to the converter, with an
opening pressure of at least 5bar.
The oil, escaping out of the converter, is directed to a oil cooler.
The oil is directed from the oil cooler to the transmission and there to the lubricating oil circuit so
that all lubricating points are supplied with cooled oil.
In the electro-hydraulic control unit there are 6 pressure regulators installed.
R
lever, the driving direction Forward
(F)-Neutral (N)-Reverse (R).
The gear selector is also available with
integrated kickdown push button.
For the protection from unintended start off,
a neutral interlock is installed :
Position N - Gear selector lever blocked in N D
this position.
Position D - Driving. 73033TM17
3-15
6) ELECTRIC CONTROL UNIT
(1) Complete system
8
5 10
9
4
3 11
6
12
13
14
8
1
16
15
7
17
7809S3PT23
3-16
·Protection from operating errors as far as necessary, is possible via electronic protection
(programming).
·Protection from over-speeds (On the basis of engine and turbine speed).
·Automatic reversing (Driving speed-dependent).
·Pressure cut-off possible (Disconnecting of the drive train for maximum power on the power
take-off).
·Change-over possibility for Auto-/Manual mode.
·Kick down functions possible.
(3) Driving and shifting
- Neutral position :
Neutral position will be selected via the controller.
After the ignition is switched on, the electronics remains in the waiting state. By the position
NEUTRAL of the controller, resp. by pressing the pushbutton NEUTRAL, the EST-37A becomes
ready for operation.
Now, a gear can be engaged.
- Starting :
The starting of the engine has always to be carried out in the NEUTRAL POSITION of the
controller.
For safety reasons it is to recommend to brake the machine securely in position with the parking
brake prior to start the engine.
After the starting of the engine and the preselection of the driving direction and the gear, the
machine can be set in motion by acceleration.
At the start off, the converter takes over the function of a master clutch.
On a level road it is possible to start off also in higher gears.
- Upshifting under load
Upshifting under load will be then realized if the machine can still accelerate by it.
- Downshifting under load
Downshifting under load will be realized if more traction force is needed.
- Upshifting in overrunning condition
In the overrunning mode, the upshifting will be suppressed by accelerator pedal idling position, if
the speed of the machine on a downgrade should not be further increased.
- Downshifting in overrunning condition
Downshiftings in overrunning mode will be then carried out if the machine should be retarded.
If the machine will be stopped and is standing with running engine and engaged transmission,
the engine cannot be stalled. On a level and horizontal roadway it is possible that the machine
begins to crawl, because the engine is creating at idling speed a slight drag torque via the
converter.
It is convenient to brake the machine at every stop securely in position with the parking brake.
At longer stops, the controller has to be shifted to the NEUTRAL POSITION.
At the start off, the parking brake has to be released. We know from experience that at a
converter transmission it might not immediately be noted to have forgotten this quite normal
operating step because a converter, due to its high ratio, can easily overcome the braking
torque of the parking brake.
3-17
Temperature increases in the converter oil as well as overheated brakes will be the
consequences to be find out later.
Neutral position of the selector switch at higher machine speeds (above stepping speed) is not
admissible.
Either a suitable gear is to be shifted immediately, or the machine must be stopped at once.
(4) Independent calibration of the shifting elements (AEB)
The AEB has the task to compensate tolerances (plate clearance and pressure level) which are
influencing the filling procedure of the clutches. For each clutch, the correct filling parameters are
determined in one test cycle for :
·Period of the quick-filling time
·Level of the filling compensating pressure
The filling parameters are stored, together with the AEB-program and the driving program in the
transmission electronics. Because the electronics will be separately supplied, the AEB-cycle
must be started only after the installation of both components in the machine, thus ensuring the
correct mating (Transmission and electronics).
※ It is imperative, to respect the following test conditions :
- Shifting position neutral
- Engine in idling speed
- Parking brake actuated
- Transmission in operating temperature
※ After a replacement of the transmission, the electrohydraulic control or the TCU in the machine,
the AEB-cycle must be as well carried out again.
The AEB-cylcle continues for about 3 to 4 minutes. The determined filling parameters are stored
in the EEProm of the electronics. In this way, the error message F6 shown on the display will be
cancelled also at non-performed AEB.
(5) Pressure cut-off
In order to provide the full engine power for the hydraulic system, the control can be enlarged for
the function of a pressure cut-off in the 1st and 2nd speed. In this way, the pressure in the
powershift clutches will be cut-off, and the torque transmission in the drive train will be eliminated
by it. This function will be released at the actuation of a switch, arranged on the brake pedal.
For a soft restart, the pressure will be build-up via a freely programmable characteristic line.
3-18
4. FAULT CODE
1) MACHINE FAULT CODE
HCESPN FMI Description
Hydraulic oil temperature sensor circuit - Voltage above normal, or shorted to high source (or
3
101 open circuit)
4 Hydraulic oil temperature sensor circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source
5 Engine cooling fan EPPR valve circuit - Current below normal, or open circuit
145
6 Engine cooling fan EPPR valve bircuit - Current above normal
Boom up lever detent solenoid circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source (or
4
172 open circuit)
6 Boom up lever detent solenoid circuit - Current above normal
Boom down lever detent solenoid circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source (or
4
173 open circuit)
6 Boom down lever detent solenoid circuit - Current above normal
Bucket lever detent solenoid circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source (or open
4
174 circuit)
6 Bucket lever detent solenoid circuit - Current above normal
Engine cooling fan reverse solenoid circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source (or
4
181 open circuit)
6 Engine cooling fan reverse solenoid circuit - Current above normal
Engine cooling fan reverse driving status signal circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to
4
183 low source (or open circuit)
6 Engine cooling fan reverse driving status signal circuit - Current above normal
Emergency steering pump relay circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source (or
4
187 open circuit)
6 Emergency steering pump relay circuit – Current above normal
0 Steering main pump pressure sensor data above normal range (or open circuit)
1 Steering main pump pressure sensor data below normal range
202
2 Steering main pump pressure sensor data error
4 Steering main pump pressure sensor circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source
0 Emergency steering pump pressure sensor data above normal range (or open circuit)
1 Emergency steering pump pressure sensor data below normal range
203 2 Emergency steering pump pressure sensor data error
Emergency steering pump pressure sensor circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low
4
source
0 Boom cylinder pressure sensor data above normal range (or open circuit)
1 Boom cylinder pressure sensor data below normal range
204
2 Boom cylinder pressure sensor data error
4 Boom cylinder pressure sensor circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source
0 Bucket cylinder pressure sensor data above normal range (or open circuit)
1 Bucket cylinder pressure sensor data below normal tange
205
2 Bucket cylinder pressure sensor data error
4 Bucket cylinder pressure sensor circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source
3-19
HCESPN FMI Description
3 Fuel level sensor circuit - Voltage above normal, or shorted to high source (or open circuit)
301
4 Fuel level sensor circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source
Engine coolant temperature sensor circuit - Voltage above normal, or shorted to high source
3
304 (or open circuit)
4 Engine coolant temperature sensor circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source
310 8 Engine speed signal error – Abnormal frequency or pulse width
318 8 Engine cooling fan speed signal error – Abnormal frequency or pulse width
4 Engine preheat relay circuit – Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source (or open circuit)
322
6 Engine preheat relay circuit - Current above normal
4 Fuel warmer relay circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source (or open circuit)
325
6 Fuel warmer relay circuit – Current above normal
4 Anti-restart relay circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source (or open circuit)
327
6 Anti-restart relay circuit – Current above normal
Engine power mode selector circuit – Voltage above normal, or shorted to high source (or
3
346 open circuit)
4 Engine power mode selector circuit – Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source
0 Brake oil pressure sensor data above normal range (or open circuit)
1 Brake oil pressure sensor data below normal range
503
2 Brake oil pressure sensor data error
4 Brake oil pressure sensor circuit – Voltage below normal, or shorted to Low Source
0 Parking oil pressure sensor data above normal range (or open circuit)
1 Parking oil pressure sensor data below normal range
507
2 Parking oil pressure sensor data error
4 Parking oil pressure sensor circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source
Clutch cut off mode selector circuit – Voltage above normal, or shorted to high source (or
3
551 open circuit)
4 Clutch cut off mode selector circuit – Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source
Transmission shift mode selector circuit – Voltage above normal, or shorted to high source (or
3
552 open circuit)
4 Transmission shift mode selector circuit – Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source
0 Differential lock pressure sensor data above normal range (or open circuit)
1 Differential lock pressure sensor data below normal range
558
2 Differential lock pressure sensor data error
4 Differential lock pressure sensor circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source
701 4 Hourmeter circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source
0 Battery voltage high
705
1 Battery voltage low
3-20
HCESPN FMI Description
707 1 Alternator node I voltage low (or open circuit)
3 Buzzer circuit - Voltage above normal, or shorted to high source
723
4 Buzzer circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source (or open circuit)
4 Wiper relay circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source (or open circuit)
727
6 Wiper relay circuit – Current above normal
Boom position sensor signal circuit – Voltage above normal, or shorted to high
3
728 source (or open circuit)
4 Boom position sensor signal circuit – Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source
Bucket position sensor signal circuit – Voltage above normal, or shorted to high
3
source (or open circuit)
729
Bucket position sensor signal circuit – Voltage below normal, or shorted to low
4
source
730 19 APTC heater PWM output duty operation error
830 12 MCU internal memory error
840 2 Cluster communication error
841 2 ECM communication error
842 2 TCU communication error
843 2 APTC communication error
844 2 Monitor communication error
850 2 RCM communication error
3-21
2) ENGINE FAULT CODES
Fault code
J1939 SPN Reason Effect (only when fault code is active)
J1939 FMI
Engine control module critical internal failure - Possible no noticeable performance effects,
111
Bad intelligent device or component. Error engine dying, or hard starting.
629
internal to the ECM related to memory hardware
12
failures or internal ECM voltage supply circuits.
Engine magnetic crankshaft speed/position lost Fueling to injectors is disabled and the engine
115 both of two signals - Data erratic, intermittent, or can not be started.
612 incorrect. The ECM has detected that the
2 primary engine speed sensor and the backup
engine speed sensor signals are reversed.
Intake manifold 1 pressure sensor circuit - Engine power derate.
122 Voltage above normal, or shorted to high source.
102 High signal voltage detected at the intake
3 manifold pressure circuit.
Intake manifold 1 pressure sensor circuit - Engine power derate.
123 Voltage below normal, or shorted to low Source.
102 Low signal voltage or open circuit detected at the
4 intake manifold pressure circuit.
Intake manifold 1 pressure - Data valid but above Engine power derate.
124 normal operational range - Moderately severe
102 level. Intake manifold pressure has exceeded the
16 maximum limit for the given engine rating.
Accelerator pedal or lever position sensor 1 Severe derate in power output of the engine.
131 circuit - Voltage above normal, or shorted to high Limp home power only.
91 source. High voltage detected at accelerator
3 pedal position circuit.
Accelerator pedal or lever position sensor 1 Severe derate in power output of the engine.
132 circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low Limp home power only.
91 source. Low voltage detected at accelerator
4 pedal position signal circuit.
Remote accelerator pedal or lever position Remote accelerator will not operate. Remote
133 sensor 1 circuit - Voltage above normal, or accelerator position will be set to zero percent.
974 shorted to high source. High voltage detected at
3 remote accelerator pedal position circuit.
Remote accelerator pedal or lever position Remote accelerator will not operate. Remote
134 sensor 1 circuit - Voltage below normal, or accelerator position will be set to zero percent.
974 shorted to low source. Low voltage detected at
4 remote accelerator pedal position signal circuit.
Engine oil rifle pressure 1 sensor circuit - Voltage None on performance. No engine protection
135 above normal, or shorted to high source. High for oil pressure.
100 signal voltage detected at the engine oil pressure
3 circuit.
Engine oil rifle pressure 1 sensor circuit - Voltage None on performance. No engine protection
141 below normal, or shorted to low source. Low for oil pressure.
100 signal voltage detected at engine oil pressure
4 circuit.
143 Engine oil rifle pressure - Data valid but below None on performance.
100 normal operational range - Moderately severe
18 level.
Engine coolant temperature 1 sensor circuit - Possible white smoke. Fan will stay ON if
144
Voltage above normal, or shorted to high source. controlled by ECM. No engine protection for
110
High signal voltage or open circuit detected at engine coolant temperature.
3
engine coolant temperature circuit.
3-22
Fault code
J1939 SPN Reason Effect (only when fault code is active)
J1939 FMI
Engine Coolant Temperature 1 Sensor Circuit - Possible white smoke. Fan will stay ON if
145
Voltage Below Normal, or Shorted to Low controlled by ECM. No engine protection for
110
Source. Low signal voltage detected at engine engine coolant temperature.
4
coolant temperature circuit.
Engine Coolant Temperature - Data Valid but Progressive power derate increasing in
146 Above Normal Operational Range - Moderately severity from time of alert.
110 Severe Level. Engine coolant temperature signal
16 indicates engine coolant temperature is above
engine protection warning limit.
Accelerator Pedal or Lever Position 1 Sensor Severe derate in power output of the engine.
Circuit Frequency - Data Valid but Below Normal Limp home power only.
147
Operational Range - Most Severe Level. A
91
frequency of less than 100 Hz has been
1
detected at the frequency throttle input to the
ECM.
Accelerator Pedal or Lever Position Sensor 1 - Severe derate in power output of the engine.
148 Data Valid but Above Normal Operational Limp home power only.
91 Range - Most Severe Level. A frequency of
0 more than 1500 Hz has been detected at the
frequency throttle input to the ECM.
Engine Coolant Temperature - Data Valid but Progressive power derate increasing in
151 Above Normal Operational Range - Most severity from time of alert. If Engine Protection
110 Severe Level. Engine coolant temperature signal Shutdown feature is enabled, engine will shut
0 indicates engine coolant temperature above down 30 seconds after Red Stop Lamp starts
engine protection critical limit. flashing.
Intake Manifold 1 Temperature Sensor Circuit - Possible white smoke. Fan will stay ON if
153 Voltage Above Normal, or Shorted to High controlled by ECM. No engine protection for
105 Source. High signal voltage detected at intake intake manifold air temperature.
3 manifold air temperature circuit.
Intake Manifold 1 Temperature Sensor Circuit - Possible white smoke. Fan will stay ON if
154 Voltage Below Normal, or Shorted to Low controlled by ECM. No engine protection for
105 Source. Low signal voltage detected at intake intake manifold air temperature.
4 manifold air temperature circuit.
Intake Manifold 1 Temperature - Data Valid but Progressive power derate increasing in
155 Above Normal Operational Range - Most severity from time of alert. If Engine Protection
105 Severe Level. Intake manifold air temperature Shutdown feature is enabled, engine will shut
0 signal indicates intake manifold air temperature down 30 seconds after Red Stop Lamp starts
above engine protection critical limit. flashing.
187 Sensor Supply 2 Circuit - Voltage Below Normal, Engine power derate.
520195 or Shorted to Low Source. Low voltage detected
4 at the sensor supply number 2 circuit.
195 Coolant Level Sensor 1 Circuit - Voltage Above None on performance.
111 Normal, or Shorted to High Source. High signal
3 voltage detected at engine coolant level circuit.
196 Coolant Level Sensor 1 Circuit - Voltage Below None on performance.
111 Normal, or Shorted to Low Source. Low signal
4 voltage detected at engine coolant level circuit.
197 Coolant Level - Data Valid but Below Normal None on performance.
111 Operational Range - Moderately Severe Level.
18 Low coolant level has been detected.
Barometric Pressure Sensor Circuit - Voltage Engine power derate.
221
Above Normal, or Shorted to High Source. High
108
signal voltage detected at barometric pressure
3
circuit.
3-23
Fault code
J1939 SPN Reason Effect (only when fault code is active)
J1939 FMI
Barometric Pressure Sensor Circuit - Voltage Engine power derate.
222
Below Normal, or Shorted to Low Source. Low
108
signal voltage detected at barometric pressure
4
circuit.
227 Sensor Supply 2 Circuit - Voltage Above Normal, Engine power derate.
520195 or Shorted to High Source. High voltage
3 detected at sensor supply number 2 circuit.
Engine Crankshaft Speed/Position - Data Valid Fuel injection disabled until engine speed falls
234
but Above Normal Operational Range - Most below the overspeed limit.
190
Severe Level. Engine speed signal indicates
0
engine speed above engine protection limit.
Coolant Level - Data Valid but Below Normal Progressive power derate increasing in
235 Operational Range - Most Severe Level. Low severity from time of alert. If Engine Protection
111 engine coolant level detected. Shutdown feature is enabled, engine will shut
1 down 30 seconds after Red Stop Lamp starts
flashing.
237 External Speed Command Input (Multiple Unit
644 Synchronization) - Data Erratic, Intermittent, or
2 Incorrect. Communication between multiple
engines may be intermittent.
238 Sensor Supply 3 Circuit - Voltage Below Normal, Possible hard starting and rough running.
520196 or Shorted to Low Source. Low voltage detected
4 on the +5 volt sensor supply circuit to the engine
speed sensor.
241 Wheel-based vehicle speed - Data erratic, Engine speed limited to ,maximum engine
84 intermittent, or incorrect. The ECM lost the speed without VSS parameter value. Cruise
2 vehicle speed signal. control, gear-down protection, and road speed
governor will not work.
242 Wheel-based vehicle speed sensor circuit Engine speed limited to maximum engine
84 tampering has been detected - Abnormal rate of speed without VSS parameter value. Cruise
10 change. Signal indicates an intermittent control, gear-down protection, and road speed
connection or VSS tampering. g+H53overnor will not work.
245 Fan control circuit - Voltage below normal, or The fan may stay on continuously or not run at
647 shorted to low source. Low signal voltage all.
4 detected at the fan control circuit when
commanded on.
271 Fuel pump pressurizing assembly 1 circuit - Engine will run poorly at idle. Engine will have
1347 Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source. low power. Fuel pressure will be higher than
4 Low signal voltage detected at the fuel pump commanded.
actuator circuit.
Fuel pump pressurizing assembly 1 circuit - Engine will not run or engine will run poorly.
272
Voltage above normal, or shorted to high source.
1347
High signal voltage or open circuit detected at
3
the fuel pump actuator circuit.
281 Fuel pump pressur izing assembly 1 - Engine will not run or possible low power.
1347 Mechanical system not responding properly or
7 out of adjustment.
SAE J1939 multiplexing PGN timeout error - At least one multiplexed device will not
285
Abnormal update rate. The ECM expected operate properly.
639
information from a multiplexed device but did not
9
receive it soon enough or did not receive it at all.
SAE J1939 multiplexing configuration error - At least one multiplexed device will not
286
Out of calibration. The ECM expected operate properly.
639
information from a multiplexed device but only
13
received a portion of the necessary information.
3-24
Fault code
J1939 SPN Reason Effect (only when fault code is active)
J1939 FMI
SAE J1939 multiplexed accelerator pedal or Engine may only idle or engine will not
287 lever sensor system - received network data In accelerate to full speed.
91 error. The OEM vehicle electronic control unit
19 (VECM) detected a fault with its accelerator
pedal.
SAE J1939 Multiplexing Remote Accelerator The engine will not respond to the remote
288 Pedal or Lever Position Sensor Circuit - throttle. Engine may only idle. The primary or
974 Received Network Data In Error. The OEM cab accelerator may be able to be used.
19 vehicle electronic control unit (VECM) detected
a fault with the remote accelerator.
292 Auxiliary temperature Sensor Input 1 - Special Possible engine power derate.
441 instructions.
14
Auxiliary temperature sensor input 1 circuit - None on performance.
293 Voltage above normal, or shorted to high
441 source. High signal voltage or open circuit
3 detected at the OEM auxiliary temperature
circuit.
Auxiliary temperature sensor input 1 circuit - None on performance.
294 Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source.
441 Low signal voltage detected at the OEM
4 auxiliary temperature circuit.
296 Auxiliary pressure sensor input 1 - Special Possible engine power derate.
1388 instructions.
14
Auxiliary pressure sensor input 1 circuit - None on performance.
297
Voltage above normal, or shorted to high
1388
source. High signal voltage detected at the OEM
3
pressure circuit.
Auxiliary pressure sensor input 1 circuit - None on performance.
298 Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source.
1388 Low signal voltage or open circuit detected at
4 the OEM pressure circuit.
319 Real time clock power interrupt - Data erratic, None on performance. Data in the ECM will
251 intermittent, or incorrect. Real time clock lost not have accurate time and date information.
2 power.
Injector solenoid driver cylinder 1 circuit - Engine can possibly misfire or run rough.
Current below normal, or open circuit. High
322 resistance detected on injector number 1 circuit
651 or no current detected at number 1 injector
5 driver or return pin when the voltage supply at
the harness is on.
Injector solenoid driver cylinder 5 circuit - Engine can possibly misfire or run rough.
Current below normal, or open circuit. High
323 resistance detected on injector number 5 circuit
655 or no current detected at number 5 injector
5 driver or return pin when the voltage supply at
the harness is on.
Injector solenoid driver cylinder 3 circuit - Engine can possibly misfire or run rough.
Current below normal, or open circuit. High
324 resistance detected on injector number 3 circuit
653 or no current detected at number 3 injector
5 driver or return pin when the voltage supply at
the harness is on.
Injector solenoid driver cylinder 6 circuit - Engine can possibly misfire or run rough.
Current below normal, or open circuit. High
325 resistance detected on injector number 6 circuit
656 or no current detected at number 6 injector
5 driver or return pin when the voltage supply at
the harness is on.
3-25
Fault code
J1939 SPN Reason Effect (only when fault code is active)
J1939 FMI
Injector solenoid driver cylinder 2 circuit - Engine can possibly misfire or run rough.
Current below normal, or open circuit. High
331
resistance detected on injector number 2 circuit
652
or no current detected at number 2 injector
5
driver or return pin when the voltage supply at
the harness is on.
Injector solenoid driver cylinder 4 circuit - Engine can possibly misfire or run rough.
Current below normal, or open circuit. High
332
resistance detected on injector number 4 circuit
654
or no current detected at number 4 injector
5
driver or return pin when the voltage supply at
the harness is on.
Engine coolant temperature - Data erratic, The ECM will estimate engine coolant
334
intermittent, or incorrect. The engine coolant temperature.
110
temperature reading is not changing with engine
2
operating conditions.
342 Electronic calibration code incompatibility - Out Possible no noticeable performance effects,
630 of calibration. An incompatible calibration has engine dying, or hard starting.
13 been detected in the ECM.
343 Engine control module warning internal No performance effects or possible severe
620 hardware failure - Bad intelligent device or power derate.
12 component. Internal ECM failure.
351 Injector power supply - Bad intelligent device or Possible smoke, low power, engine misfire,
627 component. The ECM measured injector boost and/or engine will not start.
12 voltage is low.
352 Sensor supply 1 circuit - Voltage below normal, Engine power derate.
1079 or shorted to low source. Low voltage detected
4 at sensor supply number 1 circuit.
386 Sensor supply 1 circuit - Voltage above normal, Engine power derate.
1079 or shorted to high source. High voltage detected
3 at sensor supply number 1 circuit.
Engine oil rifle pressure - Data valid but below Progressive power derate increasing in
415 normal operational range - Most severe level. Oil severity from time of alert. If engine protection
100 pressure signal indicates oil pressure below the shutdown feature is enabled, engine will shut
1 engine protection critical limit. down 30 seconds after red stop lamp starts
flashing.
418 Water in fuel indicator - Data valid but above Possible white smoke, loss of power, or hard
97 normal operational range - Least severe level. starting.
15 water has been detected in the fuel filter.
428 Water in fuel indicator sensor circuit - Voltage None on performance. No water in fuel
97 above normal, or shorted to high source. High warning available.
3 voltage detected at the water in fuel circuit.
429 Water in fuel indicator sensor circuit - Voltage None on performance. No water in fuel
97 below normal, or shorted to low source. Low warning available.
4 voltage detected at the water in fuel circuit.
Accelerator pedal or lever idle validation switch - Engine will only idle.
431 Data erratic, intermittent, or incorrect. Voltage
558 detected simultaneously on both idle validation
2 and off-idle validation switches.
Accelerator pedal or lever idle validation circuit - Engine will only idle.
432 Out of calibration. Voltage at idle validation
558 on-idle and off-idle circuit does not match
13 accelerator pedal position.
3-26
Fault code
J1939 SPN Reason Effect (only when fault code is active)
J1939 FMI
Engine oil rifle pressure - Data erratic, None on performance. No engine protection
435
intermittent, or incorrect. An error in the engine for oil pressure.
100
oil pressure switch signal was detected by the
2
ECM.
Battery 1 voltage - Data valid but below normal Engine may stop running or be difficult to start.
441
operational range - Moderately severe level.
168
ECM supply voltage is below the minimum
18
system voltage level.
Battery 1 Voltage - Data valid but above normal Possible electrical damage to all electrical
442
operational range - Moderately severe level. components.
168
ECM supply voltage is above the maximum
16
system voltage level.
449 Injector metering rail 1 pressure - Data valid but None or possible engine noise associated with
157 above normal operational range - Most severe higher injection pressures (especially at idle or
0 level. light load). Engine power is reduced.
Injector metering rail 1 pressure sensor circuit - Power and or speed derate.
451
Voltage above normal, or shorted to high source.
157
High signal voltage detected at the rail fuel
3
pressure sensor circuit.
Injector metering rail 1 pressure sensor circuit - Power and or speed derate.
452
Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source.
157
Low signal voltage detected at the rail fuel
4
pressure sensor circuit.
Intake manifold 1 temperature - Data valid but Progressive power derate increasing in
488 above normal operational range - Moderately severity from time of alert.
157 severe level. Intake manifold air temperature
16 signal indicates intake manifold air temperature
is above the engine protection warning limit.
497 Multiple unit synchronization switch - Data
1377 erratic, intermittent, or incorrect.
2
523 Auxiliary intermediate (PTO) speed switch None on performance.
611 validation - Data erratic, intermittent, or
2 incorrect.
Auxiliary input/output 2 circuit - Voltage above None on performance.
527 normal, or shorted to high source. High signal
702 voltage or open circuit has been detected at the
3 auxiliary input/output 2 circuit.
528 Auxiliary alternate torque validation switch - None on performance.
93 Data erratic, intermittent, or incorrect.
2
Auxiliary input/output 3 circuit - Voltage above
529
normal, or shorted to high source. Low signal
703
voltage has been detected at the auxiliary input/
3
output 2 circuit.
Injector metering rail 1 pressure - Data valid but The ECM will estimate fuel pressure and
553 above normal operational range - Moderately power is reduced.
157 severe level. The ECM has detected that fuel
16 pressure is higher than commanded pressure.
Injector metering rail 1 pressure - Data erratic, Possibly hard to start, low power, or engine
554 Intermittent, or incorrect. The ECM has smoke.
157 detected that the fuel pressure signal is not
2 changing.
3-27
Fault code
J1939 SPN Reason Effect (only when fault code is active)
J1939 FMI
Injector metering rail 1 pressure - Data Valid Either the engine will not start or the engine
559 but Below Normal Operational Range - will not have starter lockout protection.
157 Moderately Severe Level. The ECM has
18 detected that fuel pressure is lower than
commanded pressure.
Starter relay driver circuit - Voltage above The engine will not have starter lockout
584
normal, or shorted to high source. Open circuit protection.
677
or high voltage detected at starter lockout
3
circuit.
585 Starter relay driver circuit - Voltage below Engine power derate. The ECM uses an
677 normal, or shorted to low source. Low voltage estimated turbocharger speed.
4 detected at starter lockout circuit.
Turbocharger 1 speed - Data valid but above Amber lamp will light until high battery voltage
595
normal operational range - Moderately severe condition is corrected.
103
level. High turbocharger speed has been
16
detected.
599 Auxiliary commanded dual output shutdown - None or possible engine noise associated with
640 Special instructions. higher injection pressures (especially at idle or
14 light load). Engine power is reduced.
Turbocharger 1 speed - Data valid but below Engine can run rough. Possibly poor starting
687
normal operational range - Moderately severe capability. Engine runs using backup speed
103
level. Low turbocharger speed detected by the sensor. Engine power is reduced.
18
ECM.
689 Engine crankshaft speed/position - Data Engine power derate.
190 erratic, intermittent, or incorrect. Loss of signal
2 from crankshaft sensor.
Turbocharger 1 compressor inlet temperature Engine power derate.
691 circuit - Voltage above normal, or shorted to
1172 high source. High signal voltage detected at
3 turbocharger compressor inlet air temperature
circuit.
Turbocharger 1 compressor inlet temperature Engine will run derated. Excessive black
692
circuit - Voltage below normal, or shorted to low smoke, hard start, and rough idle possible.
1172
source. Low signal voltage detected at
4
turbocharger compressor inlet air tempera
Engine speed / position camshaft and Possible no noticeable performance effects,
crankshaft misalignment - Mechanical system engine dying, or hard starting.
731
not responding properly or out of adjustment.
723
mechanical misalignment between the
7
crankshaft and camshaft engine speed
sensors.
757 Electronic control module data lost - Condition Possible poor starting. Engine power derate.
611 exists. Severe loss of data from the ECM.
31
Engine camshaft speed / position sensor - Possible engine power derate.
778
Data erratic, intermittent, or incorrect. The ECM
723
has detected an error in the camshaft position
2
sensor signal.
Auxiliary equipment sensor input 3 - Root Possible no noticeable performance effects or
779 cause not known. e n g i n e d y i n g o r h a r d s t a r t i n g . Fa u l t
703 information, trip information, and maintenance
11 monitor data may be inaccurate.
3-28
Fault code
J1939 SPN Reason Effect (only when fault code is active)
J1939 FMI
Power supply lost with ignition on - Data erratic, Engine will shut down.
intermittent, or incorrect. Supply voltage to the
1117 ECM fell below 6.2 volts momentarily, or the
627 ECM was not allowed to power down correctly
2 (retain battery voltage for 30 seconds after key
OFF).
1633 OEM datalink cannot transmit - Data erratic, Engine will only idle.
625 intermittent, or incorrect. Communications
2 within the OEM datalink network is intermittent.
Sensor supply 4 circuit - Voltage above normal, Engine will only idle.
2185 or shor ted to high source. High voltage
520197 detected at +5 volt sensor supply circuit to the
3 accelerator pedal position sensor.
Sensor supply 4 circuit - Voltage below normal, Possibly hard to start, low power, or engine
2186 or shorted to low source. Low voltage detected smoke.
520197 at +5 volt sensor supply circuit to the
4 accelerator pedal position sensor.
Injector metering rail 1 pressure - Data valid but Engine may be difficult to start.
2249 below normal operational range - Most severe
157 level. The ECM has detected that fuel pressure
1 is lower than commanded pressure.
Electric lift pump for engine fuel supply circuit - Engine may be difficult to start.
2265 Voltage above normal, or shorted to high
1075 source. High voltage or open detected at the
3 fuel lift pump signal circuit.
Electric lift pump for engine fuel supply circuit - Possible low power.
2266 Voltage below normal, or shorted to low source.
1075 Low signal voltage detected at the fuel lift pump
4 circuit.
Electronic fuel injection control valve circuit -Engine may exhibit misfire as control switches
2311 Condition exists. Fuel pump actuator circuit from the primary to the backup speed sensor.
633 resistance too high or too low. Engine power is reduced while the engine
31 operates on the backup speed sensor.
2321 Engine crankshaft speed/position - Data erratic, Possible low power.
190 intermittent, or incorrect. crankshaft engine
2 speed sensor intermittent synchronization.
Engine camshaft speed / position sensor - Data Engine power derate.
2322
erratic, intermittent, or incorrect. Camshaft
723
engine speed sensor intermittent
2
synchronization.
2345 Turbocharger 1 Speed - Abnormal rate of Engine power derate.
103 change. The turbocharger speed sensor has
10 detected an erroneous speed value.
Turbocharger turbine inlet temperature Engine power derate.
2346 (Calculated) - Data valid but above normal
2789 operational range - Least severe level.
15 Turbocharger turbine inlet temperature has
exceeded the engine protection limit.
2347 Turbocharger compressor outlet temperature Engine brake on cylinders 1, 2, and 3 can not
2790 (Calculated) - Data valid but above normal be activated or exhaust brake will not operate.
15 operational range - Least severe level.
2377 Fan control circuit - Voltage above normal, or Variable geometry turbocharger will go to the
647 shorted to high source. Open circuit or high open position.
3 voltage detected at the fan control circuit.
3-29
Fault code
J1939 SPN Reason Effect (only when fault code is active)
J1939 FMI
2384 VGT actuator driver circuit - Voltage below Variable geometry turbocharger may be in
641 normal, or shorted to low source. Low voltage either the open or closed position.
4 detected at turbocharger control valve circuit.
VGT actuator driver circuit - Voltage above The intake air heaters may be ON or OFF all
2385
normal, or shorted to high source. Open circuit the time.
641
or high voltage detected at turbocharger
3
control valve circuit.
2555 Intake air heater 1 circuit - Voltage above The intake air heaters may be ON or OFF all
729 normal, or shorted to high source. High voltage the time.
3 detected at the intake air heater signal circuit.
2556 Intake air heater 1 circuit - Voltage below Can not control transmission.
729 normal, or shorted to low source. Low voltage
4 detected at the intake air heater signal circuit.
2557 Auxiliary PWM driver 1 circuit - Voltage above Can not control transmission.
697 normal, or shorted to high source. High signal
3 voltage detected at the analog torque circuit.
2558 Auxiliary PWM driver 1 circuit - Voltage below Power derate and possible engine shutdown if
697 normal, or shorted to low source. Low signal engine protection shutdown feature is enabled.
4 voltage detected at the analog torque circuit.
Intake manifold 1 pressure - Data erratic,
2973 intermittent, or incorrect. The ECM has
102 detected an intake manifold pressure signal
2 that is too high or low for current engine
operating conditions.
3-30
3) DEFINITION OF OPERATING MODES
(1) Normal
There's no failure detected in the transmission system or the failure has no or slight effects on
transmission control. TCU will work without or in special cases with little limitations. (See
following table)
(2) Substitute clutch control
TCU can't change the gears or the direction under the control of the normal clutch modulation.
TCU uses the substitute strategy for clutch control. All modulations are only time controlled.
(Comparable with EST 25)
(3) Limp-home
The detected failure in the system has strong limitations to transmission control. TCU can
engage only one gear in each direction. In some cases only one direction will be possible.
TCU will shift the transmission into neutral at the first occurrence of the failure. First, the operator
must shift the gear selector into neutral position.
If output speed is less than a threshold for neutral to gear and the operator shifts the gear selector
into forward or reverse, the TCU will select the limp-home gear.
If output speed is less than a threshold for reversal speed and TCU has changed into the limp-
home gear and the operator selects a shuttle shift, TCU will shift immediately into the limp-home
gear of the selected direction.
If output speed is greater than the threshold, TCU will shift the transmission into neutral. The
operator has to slow down the vehicle and must shift the gear selector into neutral position.
(4) Transmission-shutdown
TCU has detected a severe failure that disables control of the transmission.
TCU will shut off the solenoid valves for the clutches and also the common power supply (VPS1).
Transmission shifts to neutral. The park brake will operate normally, also the other functions
which use ADM1 to ADM8.
The operator has to slow down the vehicle. The transmission will stay in neutral.
(5) TCU-shutdown
TCU has detected a severe failure that disables control of system.
TCU will shut off all solenoid valves and also both common power supplies (VPS1, VPS2). The
park brake will engage, also functions are disabled which use ADM 1 to ADM 8.
The transmission will stay in neutral.
※ Abbreviations
OC : Open circuit
SC : Short circuit
OP mode : Operating mode
TCU : Transmission control unit
EEC : Electronic engine controller
PTO : Power take off
3-31
4) TRANSMISSION FAULT CODES
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
10 Logical error at direction select signal TCU shifts transmission to · Check the cables from TCU to shift
3rd shift lever neutral if selector active lever 3
T C U d e t e c t e d a w r o n g s i g n a l OP mode : Transmission · Check signal combinations of shift
combination for the direction shutdown if lever positions F-N-R
·Cable from shift lever 3 to TCU is broken selector active · If shift lever is a CAN shift lever
·Cable is defective and is contacted to check CAN cable/shifter/device
battery voltage or vehicle ground ※ Fault is cleared if TCU detects a
·Shift lever is defective valid neutral signal for the direction
at the shift lever
11 Logical error at gear range signal TCU shifts transmission to · Check the cables from TCU to shift
TCU detected a wrong signal combination neutral lever
for the gear range OP mode : Transmission · Check signal combinations of shift
·Cable from shift lever to TCU is broken shutdown lever positions for gear range
·Cable is defective and is contacted to ※ Failure cannot be detected in
battery voltage or vehicle ground systems with DW2/DW3 shift lever.
·Shift lever is defective Fault is taken back if TCU detects a
valid signal for the position
12 Logical error at direction select signal TCU shifts transmission to · Check the cables from TCU to shift
TCU detected a wrong signal combination neutral lever
for the direction OP mode : Transmission · Check signal combinations of shift
·Cable from shift lever to TCU is broken shutdown lever positions F-N-R
·Cable is defective and is contacted to ※ Fault is taken back if TCU detects a
battery voltage or vehicle ground valid signal for the direction at the
·Shift lever is defective shift lever
13 Logical error at engine derating device After selecting neutral, · Check engine derating device
TCU detected no reaction of engine while TCU change to OP mode ※ This fault is reset after power up of
derating device active limp home TCU
15 Logical error at direction select signal 2 TCU shifts transmission to · Check the cables from TCU to shift
shift lever neutral if selector active lever 2
TCU detected a wrong signal combination OP mode : Transmission · Check signal combinations of shift
for the direction shutdown if lever positions F-N-R
·Cable from shift lever 2 to TCU is broken elector active ※ Fault is taken back if TCU detects a
·Cable is defective and is contacted to valid neutral signal for the direction
battery voltage or vehicle ground at the shift lever
·Shift lever is defective
17 S.C. to ground at customer specific Customer specific · Check the cable from TCU to
function No. 1 (ride control) customer specific function No. 1
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the device
output pin, that looks like a S.C. to vehicle · C h e ck t h e c o n n e c t o r s f r o m
ground customer specific function No. 1 to
·Cable is defective and is contacted to TCU
vehicle ground · Check the resistance of customer
·Customer specific function No. 1 device specific function No. 1 device
has an internal defect
·Connector pin is contacted to vehicle
ground
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-32
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
18 S.C. to battery voltage at customer specific Customer specific · Check the cable from TCU to
function No. 1 (ride control) customer specific function No. 1
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the device
output pin, that looks like a S.C. to battery · C h e ck t h e c o n n e c t o r s f r o m
voltage customer specific function No. 1 to
·Cable is defective and is contacted to TCU
battery voltage · Check the resistance of customer
·Customer specific function No. 1 device specific function No. 1 device
has an internal defect
·Connector pin is contacted to battery
voltage
19 O.C. at customer specific function No. 1 Customer specific · Check the cable from TCU to
(ride control) customer specific function No. 1
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the device
output pin, that looks like a O.C. for this · C h e ck t h e c o n n e c t o r s f r o m
output pin customer specific function No. 1
·C a b l e i s d e fe c t i ve a n d h a s n o device to TCU
connection to TCU · Check the resistance of customer
·Customer specific function No. 1 device specific function No. 1 device
has an internal defect
·Connector has no connection to TCU
21 S.C. to battery voltage at clutch cut off Clutch cut off function is · Check the cable from TCU to the
input disabled sensor
The measured voltage is too high: OP mode : Normal · Check the connectors
·Cable is defective and is contacted to · Check the clutch cut off sensor
battery voltage
·Clutch cut off sensor has an internal
defect
·Connector pin is contacted to battery
voltage
22 S.C. to ground or O.C. at clutch cut off Clutch cut off function is · Check the cable from TCU to the
input disabled sensor
The measured voltage is too low: OP mode : Normal · Check the connectors
·Cable is defective and is contacted to · Check the clutch cut off sensor
vehicle ground
·Cable has no connection to TCU
·Clutch cut off sensor has an internal
defect
·Connector pin is contacted to vehicle
ground or is broken
25 S.C. to batter y voltage or O.C. at No reaction, TCU use · Check the cable from TCU to the
transmission sump temperature sensor default temperature sensor
input OP mode : Normal · Check the connectors
The measured voltage is too high: · Check the temperature sensor
·Cable is defective and is contacted to
battery voltage
·Cable has no connection to TCU
·Temperature sensor has an internal
defect
·Connector pin is contacted to battery
voltage or is broken
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-33
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
26 S.C. to batter y voltage or O.C. at No reaction, TCU uses · Check the cable from TCU to the
transmission sump temperature sensor default temperature sensor
input OP mode : Normal · Check the connectors
The measured voltage is too low: · Check the temperature sensor
·Cable is defective and is contacted to
vehicle ground
·Temperature sensor has an internal
defect
·Connector pin is contacted to vehicle
ground
27 S.C. to batter y voltage or O.C. at No reaction, TCU uses · Check the cable from TCU to the
retarder temperature sensor input default temperature sensor
The measured voltage is too high: OP mode : Normal · Check the connectors
·Cable is defective and is contacted to · Check the temperature sensor
battery voltage
·Cable has no connection to TCU
·Temperature sensor has an internal
defect
·Connector pin is contacted to battery
voltage or is broken
28 S.C. to ground at retarder temperature No reaction, TCU uses · Check the cable from TCU to the
sensor input default temperature sensor
The measured voltage is too low: OP mode : Normal · Check the connectors
·Cable is defective and is contacted to · Check the temperature sensor
vehicle ground
·Temperature sensor has an internal
defect
·Connector pin is contacted to vehicle
ground
31 S.C. to battery voltage or O.C. at engine OP mode : Substitute clutch · Check the cable from TCU to the
speed input control sensor
TCU measures a voltage higher than · Check the connectors
7.00V at speed input pin · Check the speed sensor
·Cable is defective and is contacted to
battery voltage
·Cable has no connection to TCU
·Speed sensor has an internal defect
·Connector pin is contacted to battery
voltage or has no contact
32 S.C. to ground at engine speed input OP mode : Substitute clutch · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU measures a voltage less than 0.45V control sensor
at speed input pin · Check the connectors
·Cable/connector is defective and is · Check the speed sensor
contacted to vehicle ground
·Speed sensor has an internal defect
33 Logical error at engine speed input OP mode : Substitute clutch · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU measures a engine speed over a control sensor
threshold and the next moment the · Check the connectors
measured speed is zero · Check the speed sensor
·Cable/connector is defective and has · Check the sensor gap
bad contact ※ This fault is reset after power up of
·Speed sensor has an internal defect TCU
·Sensor gap has the wrong size
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-34
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
34 S.C. to battery voltage or O.C. at turbine OP mode : Substitute clutch · Check the cable from TCU to the
speed input control sensor
TCU measures a voltage higher than If a failure is existing at · Check the connectors
7.00V at speed input pin output speed, · Check the speed sensor
·Cable is defective and is contacted to TCU shifts to neutral
vehicle battery voltage OP mode : Limp home
·Cable has no connection to TCU
·Speed sensor has an internal defect
·Connector pin is contacted to battery
voltage or has no contact
35 S.C. to ground at turbine speed input OP mode : Substitute clutch · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU measures a voltage less than 0.45V control sensor
at speed input pin If a failure is existing at · Check the connectors
·Cable/connector is defective and is output speed, · Check the speed sensor
contacted to vehicle ground TCU shifts to neutral ※ This fault is reset after power up of
·Speed sensor has an internal defect OP mode : Limp home TCU
36 Logical error at turbine speed input OP mode : Substitute clutch · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU measures a turbine speed over a control sensor
threshold and at the next moment the If a failure is existing at · Check the connectors
measured speed is zero output speed, · Check the speed sensor
·Cable/connector is defective and has TCU shifts to neutral · Check the sensor gap
bad contact OP mode : Limp home
·Speed sensor has an internal defect
·Sensor gap has the wrong size
37 S.C. to battery voltage or O.C. at internal OP mode : Substitute clutch · Check the cable from TCU to the
speed input control sensor
TCU measures a voltage higher than · Check the connectors
7.00V at speed input pin · Check the speed sensor
·Cable is defective and is contacted to
vehicle battery voltage
·Cable has no connection to TCU
·Speed sensor has an internal defect
·Connector pin is contacted to battery
voltage or has no contact
38 S.C. to ground at turbine speed input OP mode : Substitute clutch · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU measures a voltage less than 0.45V control sensor
at speed input pin · Check the connectors
·Cable/connector is defective and is · Check the speed sensor
contacted to vehicle ground
·Speed sensor has an internal defect
39 Logical error at internal speed input OP mode : Substitute clutch · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU measures a internal speed over a control sensor
threshold and at the next moment the · Check the connectors
measured speed is zero · Check the speed sensor
·Cable/connector is defective and has · Check the sensor gap
bad contact ※ This fault is reset after power up of
·Speed sensor has an internal defect TCU
·Sensor gap has the wrong size
3A S.C. to battery voltage or O.C. at output Special mode for gear · Check the cable from TCU to the
speed input selection sensor
TCU measures a voltage higher than OP mode : S u b s t i t u t e · Check the connectors
12.5V at speed input pin clutch control · Check the speed sensor
·Cable is defective and is contacted to If a failure is existing at
battery voltage turbine speed,
·Cable has no connection to TCU TCU shifts to neutral
·Speed sensor has an internal defect OP mode : Limp home
·Connector pin is contacted to battery
voltage or has no contact
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-35
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
3B S.C. to ground at output speed input Special mode for gear · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU measures a voltage less than 1.00V selection sensor
at speed input pin OP mode : Substitute clutch · Check the connectors
·Cable/connector is defective and is control · Check the speed sensor
contacted to vehicle ground If a failure is existing at
·Speed sensor has an internal defect turbine speed,
TCU shifts to neutral
OP mode : Limp home
3C Logical error at output speed input Special mode for gear · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU measures a turbine speed over a selection sensor
threshold and at the next moment the OP mode : Substitute clutch · Check the connectors
measured speed is zero control · Check the speed sensor
·Cable/connector is defective and has If a failure is existing at · Check the sensor gap
bad contact turbine speed, ※ This fault is reset after power up of
·Speed sensor has an internal defect TCU shifts to neutral TCU
·Sensor gap has the wrong size OP mode : Limp home
3D Turbine speed zero doesn't fit to other - · Not used
speed signals
3E Output speed zero doesn't fit to other Special mode for gear · Check the sensor signal of output
speed signals selection speed sensor
If transmission is not neutral and the OP mode : Substitute clutch · Check the sensor gap of output
shifting has finished, control speed sensor
TCU measures output speed zero and If a failure is existing at · Check the cable from TCU to the
turbine speed or internal speed not equal turbine speed, sensor
to zero. TCU shifts to neutral ※ This fault is reset after power up of
·Speed sensor has an internal defect OP mode : Limp home TCU
·Sensor gap has the wrong size
54 DCT1 timeout OP mode : Normal · Check display computer
Timeout of CAN-message DCT1 from · Check wire of CAN-Bus
display computer · Check cable to display computer
·Interference on CAN-Bus
·CAN wire/connector is broken
·CAN wire/connector is defective and
has contact to vehicle ground or battery
voltage
55 JSS timeout TCU shifts to neutral while · Check joystick steering controller
Timeout of CAN-message JSS from joystick steering is active · Check wire of CAN-Bus
joystick steering controller OP mode : Normal · Check cable to joystick steering
·Interference on CAN-Bus controller
·CAN wire/connector is broken
·CAN wire/connector is defective and
has contact to vehicle ground or battery
voltage
56 Engine CONF timeout OP mode : Substitute · Check engine controller
Timeout of CAN-message engine CONF clutch control · Check wire of CAN-Bus
from engine controller · Check cable to engine controller
·Interference on CAN-Bus
·CAN wire/connector is broken
·CAN wire/connector is defective and
has contact to vehicle ground or battery
voltage
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-36
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
57 EEC1 timeout OP mode : Substitute · Check EEC controller
Timeout of CAN-message EEC1 from clutch control · Check wire of CAN-Bus
EEC controller · Check cable to EEC controller
·Interference on CAN-Bus
·CAN wire/connector is broken
·CAN wire/connector is defective and
has contact to vehicle ground or battery
voltage
58 EEC3 timeout OP mode : Substitute · Check EEC controller
Timeout of CAN-message EEC3 from clutch control · Check wire of CAN-Bus
EEC controller · Check cable to EEC controller
·Interference on CAN-Bus
·CAN wire/connector is broken
·CAN wire/connector is defective an has
contact to vehicle ground or battery
voltage
5C Auto downshift signal No reaction · Check cluster controller
CAN signal for automatic downshift is · Check wire of CAN-Bus
defective · Check cable to cluster controller
·Cluster controller is defective
·Interference on CAN-Bus
5D Manual downshift signal No reaction · Check cluster controller
CAN signal for manual downshift is · Check wire of CAN-Bus
defective · Check cable to controller
·Cluster controller is defective
·Interference on CAN-Bus
5E CCO request signal No reaction · Check cluster controller
CAN signal for CCO request is defective · Check wire of CAN-Bus
·Cluster controller is defective · Check cable to controller
·Interference on CAN-Bus
61 AEB request signal No reaction · Check I/O controller, Omron master
CAN signal for AEB request is defective OP mode : Normal · Check wire of CAN-Bus
·I/O controller is defective · Check cable to I/O controller,
·Interference on CAN-Bus Omron master
64 Sarting gear signal No reaction. · Check I/O controller
CAN signal for starting gear is defective TCU uses default starting · Check wire of CAN-Bus
·I/O controller is defective gear · Check cable to I/O controller
(illegal starting gear) OP mode : Normal
·Interference on CAN-Bus
65 Engine torque signal OP mode : Substitute · Check engine controller
CAN signal for engine torque is defective clutch control · Check wire of CAN-Bus
·Engine controller is defective · Check cable to engine controller
·Interference on CAN-Bus
69 Reference engine torque signal OP mode : Substitute · Check engine controller
CAN signal for reference of engine torque clutch control · Check wire of CAN-Bus
is defective · Check cable to engine controller
·Engine controller is defective
·Interference on CAN-Bus
6A Actual engine torque signal OP mode : Substitute · Check engine controller
CAN signal for actual engine torque is clutch control · Check wire of CAN-Bus
defective · Check cable to engine controller
·Engine controller is defective
·Interference on CAN-Bus
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-37
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
6E EEC2 timeout No reaction, TCU uses · Check EEC controller
Timeout of CAN-message EEC2 from default signal accelerator · Check wire of CAN-Bus
EEC controller pedal in idle position · Check cable to EEC controller
·Interference on CAN-Bus OP mode : Normal
·CAN wire/connector is broken
·CAN wire/connector is defective and
has contact to vehicle ground or battery
voltage
71 S.C. to battery voltage at clutch K1 TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the valve OP mode : Limp home gearbox
is out of limit, the voltage at K1 valve is too If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from TCU to
high is pending the gearbox
·Cable/connector is defective and has TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
contact to battery voltage OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
·Cable/connector is defective and has gearbox
contact to another regulator output of * See page 3-49
the TCU
·Regulator has an internal defect
72 S.C. to ground at clutch K1 TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the valve OP mode : Limp home gearbox
is out of limit, the voltage at K1 valve is too If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
low is pending to TCU
·Cable/connector is defective and has TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
contact to vehicle ground OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
·Regulator has an internal defect gearbox
* See page 3-49
73 O.C. at clutch K1 TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the OP mode : Limp home gearbox
valve is out of limit If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
·Cable/connector is defective and has no is pending to TCU
contact to TCU TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
·Regulator has an internal defect OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
gearbox
* See page 3-49
74 S.C. to battery voltage at clutch K2 TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the OP mode : Limp home gearbox
valve is out of limit, the voltage at K2 valve If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
is too high is pending to TCU
·Cable/connector is defective and has TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
contact to battery voltage OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
·Cable/connector is defective and has gearbox
contact to another regulator output of * See page 3-49
the TCU
·Regulator has an internal defect
75 S.C. to ground at clutch K2 TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the valve OP mode : Limp home gearbox
is out of limit, the voltage at K2 valve is too If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
low is pending to TCU
·Cable/connector is defective and has TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
contact to vehicle ground OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
·Regulator has an internal defect gearbox
* See page 3-49
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-38
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
76 O.C. at clutch K2 TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the OP mode : Limp home gearbox
valve is out of limit If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
·Cable/connector is defective and has no is pending to TCU
contact to TCU TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
·Regulator has an internal defect OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
gearbox
* See page 3-49
77 S.C. to battery voltage at clutch K3 TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the OP mode : Limp home gearbox
valve is out of limit, the voltage at K3 valve If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
is too high is pending to TCU
·Cable/connector is defective and has TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
contact to battery voltage OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
·Cable/connector is defective and has gearbox
contact to another regulator output of * See page 3-49
the TCU
·Regulator has an internal defect
78 S.C. to ground at clutch K3 TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the valve OP mode : Limp home gearbox
is out of limit, the voltage at K3 valve is too If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
low is pending to TCU
·Cable/connector is defective and has TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
contact to vehicle ground OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
·Regulator has an internal defect gearbox
* See page 3-49
79 O.C. at clutch K2 TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the OP mode : Limp home gearbox
valve is out of limit If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
·Cable/connector is defective and has no is pending to TCU
contact to TCU TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
·Regulator has an internal defect OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
gearbox
* See page 3-49
7D S.C. ground at engine derating device Engine derating will be on · Check the cable from TCU to the
·Cable is defective and is contacted to until engine derating device
vehicle ground TCU power down even if · Check the connectors from engine
·Engine derating device has an internal fault vanishes (Loose derating device to TCU
defect connection) · Check the resistance* of engine
·Connector pin is contacted to vehicle OP mode : Normal derating device
ground ※ Not used
* See page 3-49
7E S.C. battery voltage at engine derating No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
device OP mode : Normal engine derating device
·Cable/connector is defective and is · Check the connectors from backup
contacted to battery voltage alarm device to TCU
·Engine derating device has an internal · Check the resistance* of backup
defect alarm device
* See page 3-49
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-39
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
7F O.C. at engine derating device No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the OP mode : Normal engine derating device
output pin, that looks like a O.C. for this · Check the connectors from engine
output pin derating device to TCU
·C a b l e i s d e fe c t i ve a n d h a s n o · Check the resistance* of engine
connection to TCU derating device
·Engine derating device has an internal * See page 3-49
defect
·Connector has no connection to TCU
81 S.C. to battery voltage at clutch K4 TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the OP mode : Limp home gearbox
valve is out of limit, the voltage at K4 valve If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
is too high is pending to TCU
·Cable/connector is defective and has TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
contact to battery voltage OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
·Cable/connector is defective and has gearbox
contact to another regulator output of * See page 3-49
the TCU
·Regulator has an internal defect
82 S.C. to ground at clutch K4 TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the valve OP mode : Limp home engine derating device
is out of limit, the voltage at K4 valve is too If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
low is pending to TCU
·Cable/connector is defective and has TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
contact to vehicle ground OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
·Regulator has an internal defect gearbox
* See page 3-49
83 O.C. at clutch K4 · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the TCU shifts to neutral gearbox
valve is out of limit OP mode : Limp home · Check the connectors from gearbox
·Cable/connector is defective and has If failure at another clutch to TCU
contact to TCU is pending · Check the regulator resistance*
·Regulator has an internal defect TCU shifts to neutral · Check internal wire harness of the
OP mode : TCU shutdown gearbox
* See page 3-49
84 S.C. to battery voltage at clutch K4 TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the OP mode : Limp home gearbox
valve is out of limit, the voltage at K4 valve If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
is too high is pending to TCU
·Cable/connector is defective and has TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
contact to battery voltage OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
·Cable/connector is defective and has gearbox
contact to another regulator output of * See page 3-49
the TCU
·Regulator has an internal defect
85 S.C. to ground at clutch KV TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the valve OP mode : Limp home gearbox
is out of limit, the voltage at K4 valve is too If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
low is pending to TCU
·Cable/connector is defective and has TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
contact to vehicle ground OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
·Regulator has an internal defect gearbox
* See page 3-49
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-40
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
86 O.C. at clutch KV TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the OP mode : Limp home gearbox
valve is out of limit If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
·Cable/connector is defective and has is pending to TCU
contact to TCU TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
·Regulator has an internal defect OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
gearbox
* See page 3-49
87 S.C. to battery voltage at clutch KR TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the OP mode : Limp home gearbox
valve is out of limit, the voltage at KR valve is If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
too high is pending to TCU
·Cable/connector is defective and has TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
contact to battery voltage OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
·Cable/connector is defective and has gearbox
contact to another regulator output of the * See page 3-49
TCU
·Regulator has an internal defect
88 S.C. to ground at clutch KR TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the valve OP mode : Limp home gearbox
is out of limit, the voltage at KR valve is too If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
low is pending to TCU
·Cable/connector is defective and has TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
contact to vehicle ground OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
·Regulator has an internal defect gearbox
* See page 3-49
89 O.C. at clutch KR TCU shifts to neutral · Check the cable from TCU to the
The measured resistance value of the OP mode : Limp home gearbox
valve is out of limit If failure at another clutch · Check the connectors from gearbox
·Cable/connector is defective and has no is pending to TCU
contact to TCU TCU shifts to neutral · Check the regulator resistance*
·Regulator has an internal defect OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check internal wire harness of the
gearbox
* See page 3-49
91 S.C. to ground at relay reverse warning Backup alarm will be on · Check the cable from TCU to the
alarm until backup alarm device
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the TCU power down even if · Check the connectors from backup
output pin, that looks like a S.C. to vehicle fa u l t va n i s h e s ( L o o s e alarm device to TCU
ground connection) · Check the resistance* of backup
·Cable is defective and is contact to OP mode : Normal alarm device
vehicle ground * See page 3-49
·Backup alarm device has an internal
defect
·Connector pin is contacted to vehicle
ground
92 S.C. to battery voltage at relay reverse No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
warning alarm OP mode : Normal backup alarm device
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the · Check the connectors from backup
output pin, that looks like a S.C. to battery alarm device to TCU
voltage · Check the resistance* of backup
·Cable is defective and is contacted to alarm device
battery voltage * See page 3-49
·Backup alarm device has an internal
defect
·Connector pin is contacted to battery
voltage
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-41
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
93 O.C. at relay reverse warning alarm No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the OP mode : Normal backup alarm device
output pin, that looks like a O.C. for this · Check the connectors from backup
output pin alarm device to TCU
·C a b l e i s d e fe c t i ve a n d h a s n o · Check the resistance* of backup
connection to TCU alarm device
·Backup alarm device has an internal * See page 3-49
defect
·Connector has no connection to TCU
94 S.C. to ground at relay starter interlock No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the OP mode : Normal stater interlock relay
output pin, that looks like a S.C. to vehicle · Check the connectors from starter
ground interlock relay to TCU
·Cable is defective and is connection to · Check the resistance* of starter
vehicle ground interlock relay
·Starter interlock relay has an internal * See page 3-49
defect
·Connector pin is contacted to vehicle
ground
95 S.C. to battery voltage at relay starter No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
interlock OP mode : Normal starter interlock relay
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the · Check the connectors from starter
output pin, that looks like a S.C. to battery interlock relay to TCU
voltage · Check the resistance* of starter
·C a b l e i s d e fe c t i ve a n d h a s n o interlock relay
connection to battery voltage * See page 3-49
·Starter interlock relay has an internal
defect
·Connector pin is contacted to battery
voltage
96 O.C. at relay starter interlock No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the OP mode : Normal starter interlock relay
output pin, that looks like a O.C. for this · Check the connectors from starter
output pin interlock relay to TCU
·C a b l e i s d e fe c t i ve a n d h a s n o · Check the resistance* of starter
connection to TCU interlock relay
·Starter interlock relay has an internal * See page 3-49
defect
·Connector has no connection to TCU
9A S.C. to ground at conver ter lock up No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
clutch solenoid OP mode : Normal converter clutch solenoid
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the · C h e ck t h e c o n n e c t o r s f r o m
output pin, that looks like a S.C. to vehicle converter clutch solenoid to TCU
ground · Check the resistance* of converter
·Cable is defective and is contacted to clutch solenoid
vehicle ground * See page 3-49
·Conver ter clutch solenoid has an
internal defect
·Connector pin is contacted to vehicle
ground
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-42
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
9B O.C. at converter lock up clutch solenoid Converter clutch always · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the open, retarder not converter clutch solenoid
output pin, that looks like a O.C. for this available · C h e ck t h e c o n n e c t o r s f r o m
output pin OP mode : Normal converter clutch solenoid to TCU
·C a b l e i s d e fe c t i ve a n d h a s n o · Check the resistance* of converter
connection to TCU clutch solenoid
·Conver ter clutch solenoid has an * See page 3-49
internal defect
·Connector has no connection to TCU
9C S.C. to battery voltage at converter lock No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
up clutch solenoid OP mode : Normal converter clutch solenoid
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the · C h e ck t h e c o n n e c t o r s f r o m
output pin, that looks like a S.C. to battery converter clutch solenoid to TCU
voltage · Check the resistance* of converter
·Cable is defective and has no contacted clutch solenoid
to battery voltage * See page 3-49
·Conver ter clutch solenoid has an
internal defect
·Connector pin is contacted to battery
voltage
A1 S.C. to ground at difflock or axle No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
connection solenoid OP mode : Normal difflock solenoid
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the · Check the connectors from difflock
output pin, that looks like a S.C. to vehicle solenoid to TCU
ground · Check the resistance* of difflock
·Cable is defective and is contacted to solenoid
vehicle ground * See page 3-49
·Difflock solenoid has an internal defect
·Connector pin is contacted to vehicle
ground
A2 S.C. to battery voltage at difflock or axle No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
connection solenoid OP mode : Normal difflock solenoid
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the · Check the connectors from difflock
output pin, that looks like a S.C. to battery solenoid to TCU
voltage · Check the resistance* of difflock
·C a b l e i s d e fe c t i ve a n d h a s n o solenoid
connection to battery voltage * See page 3-49
·Difflock solenoid has an internal defect
·Connector pin is contacted to battery
voltage
A3 O.C. at difflock or axle connection No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
solenoid OP mode : Normal difflock solenoid
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the · Check the connectors from difflock
output pin, that looks like a O.C. for this solenoid to TCU
output pin · Check the resistance* of difflock
·C a b l e i s d e fe c t i ve a n d h a s n o solenoid
connection to TCU * See page 3-49
·Difflock solenoid has an internal defect
·Connector has no connection to TCU
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-43
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
A4 S.C. to ground at warning signal output No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the OP mode : Normal warning device
output pin, that looks like a S.C. to vehicle · Check the connectors from warning
ground device to TCU
·Cable is defective and is contacted to · Check the resistance* of warning
vehicle ground device
·Warning device has an internal defect * See page 3-49
·Connector pin is contacted to vehicle
ground
A5 O.C. voltage at warning signal output No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the OP mode : Normal warning device
output pin, that looks like a O.C. for this · Check the connectors from warning
output pin device to TCU
·C a b l e i s d e fe c t i ve a n d h a s n o · Check the resistance* of warning
connection to TCU device
·Warning device has an internal defect * See page 3-49
·Connector has no connection to TCU
A6 S.C. to battery voltage at warning signal No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
output OP mode : Normal warning device
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the · Check the connectors from warning
output pin, that looks like a S.C. to battery device to TCU
voltage · Check the resistance* of warning
·Cable is defective and has is contacted device
to battery voltage * See page 3-49
·Warning device has an internal defect
·Connector pin is contacted to battery
voltage
B1 Slippage at clutch K1 TCU shifts to neutral · Check pressure at clutch K1
TCU calculates a differential speed at OP mode : Limp home · Check main pressure in the system
closed clutch K1. If this calculated value · Check sensor gap at internal speed
If failure at another clutch
is out of range, TCU interprets this as is pending sensor
slipping clutch TCU shifts to neutral · Check sensor gap at output speed
·Low pressure at clutch K1 OP mode : TCU shutdown sensor
·Low main pressure · Check signal at internal speed
·Wrong signal at internal speed sensor sensor
·Wrong signal at output speed sensor · Check signal at output speed
·Wrong size of the sensor gap sensor
·Clutch is defective · Replace clutch
B2 Slippage at clutch K2 TCU shifts to neutral · Check pressure at clutch K2
TCU calculates a differential speed at OP mode : Limp home Check main pressure in the system
closed clutch K2. If this calculated value If failure at another clutch · Check sensor gap at internal speed
is out of range, TCU interprets this as is pending sensor
slipping clutch TCU shifts to neutral · Check sensor gap at output speed
·Low pressure at clutch K2 OP mode : TCU shutdown sensor
·Low main pressure · Check signal at internal speed
·Wrong signal at internal speed sensor sensor
·Wrong signal at output speed sensor · Check signal at output speed
·Wrong size of the sensor gap sensor
·Clutch is defective · Replace clutch
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-44
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
B3 Slippage at clutch K3 TCU shifts to neutral · Check pressure at clutch K3
TCU calculates a differential speed at OP mode : Limp home · Check main pressure in the system
closed clutch K3. If this calculated value If failure at another clutch · Check sensor gap at internal speed
is out of range, TCU interprets this as is pending sensor
slipping clutch TCU shifts to neutral · Check sensor gap at output speed
·Low pressure at clutch K3 OP mode : TCU shutdown sensor
·Low main pressure · Check signal at internal speed
·Wrong signal at internal speed sensor sensor
·Wrong signal at output speed sensor · Check signal at output speed
·Wrong size of the sensor gap sensor
·Clutch is defective Replace clutch
B4 Slippage at clutch K4 TCU shifts to neutral · Check pressure at clutch K4
TCU calculates a differential speed at OP mode : Limp home Check main pressure in the system
closed clutch K4. If this calculated value If failure at another clutch · Check sensor gap at internal speed
is out of range, TCU interprets this as is pending sensor
slipping clutch TCU shifts to neutral · Check sensor gap at turbine speed
·Low pressure at clutch K4 OP mode : TCU shutdown sensor
·Low main pressure · Check signal at internal speed
·Wrong signal at internal speed sensor sensor
·Wrong signal at turbine speed sensor · Check signal at turbine speed
·Wrong size of the sensor gap sensor
·Clutch is defective Replace clutch
B5 Slippage at clutch KV TCU shifts to neutral · Check pressure at clutch KV
TCU calculates a differential speed at OP mode : Limp home · Check main pressure in the system
closed clutch KV. If this calculated value If failure at another clutch · Check sensor gap at internal speed
is out of range, TCU interprets this as is pending sensor
slipping clutch TCU shifts to neutral · Check sensor gap at turbine speed
·Low pressure at clutch KV OP mode : TCU shutdown sensor
·Low main pressure · Check signal at internal speed
·Wrong signal at internal speed sensor sensor
·Wrong signal at turbine speed sensor · Check signal at turbine speed
·Wrong size of the sensor gap sensor
·Clutch is defective · Replace clutch
B6 Slippage at clutch KR TCU shifts to neutral · Check pressure at clutch KR
TCU calculates a differential speed at OP mode : Limp home Check main pressure in the system
closed clutch KR. If this calculated value If failure at another clutch · Check sensor gap at internal speed
is out of range, TCU interprets this as is pending sensor
slipping clutch TCU shifts to neutral · Check sensor gap at turbine speed
·Low pressure at clutch KR OP mode : TCU shutdown sensor
·Low main pressure · Check signal at internal speed
·Wrong signal at internal speed sensor sensor
·Wrong signal at turbine speed sensor · Check signal at turbine speed
·Wrong size of the sensor gap sensor
·Clutch is defective · Replace clutch
B7 Overtemp sump No reaction · Cool down machine
TCU measured a temperature in the oil OP mode : Normal · Check oil level
sump that is over the allowed threshold. · Check temperature sensor
B9 Overspend engine Retarder applies
-
OP mode : Normal
BA Differential pressure oil filter No reaction · Check oil filter
TCU measured a voltage at differential OP mode : Normal · Check wiring from TCU to
pressure switch out of the allowed range differential pressure switch
·Oil filter is polluted · C h e ck d i f fe r e n t i a l p r e s s u r e
·Cable/connector is broken or cable/ switch(Measure resistance)
connector is contacted to battery voltage
or vehicle ground
·Differential pressure switch is defective
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-45
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
BB Slippage at converter lockup clutch No reaction · Check pressure at converter lockup
TCU calculates a differential speed at OP mode : Normal clutch
closed converter lockup clutch. If this · Check main pressure in the system
calculated value is out of range, TCU · Check sensor gap at engine speed
interprets this as slipping clutch sensor
·Low pressure at converter lockup clutch · Check sensor gap at turbine speed
·Low main pressure sensor
·Wrong signal at engine speed sensor · Check signal at engine speed
·Wrong signal at turbine speed sensor sensor
·Wrong size of the sensor gap · Check signal at turbine speed
·Clutch is defective sensor
· Replace clutch
C0 Engine torque or engine power overload OP mode : Normal
TCU calculates an engine torque or
e n g i n e p o w e r a b o ve t h e d e f i n e d
thresholds
C1 Transmission output torque overload OP mode : Normal
TCU calculates an transmission output
torque above the defined threshold
C2 Transmission input torque overload programmable :
TCU calculates an transmission input No reaction or shift to
torque above the defined threshold neutral
OP mode : Normal
C3 Overtemp converter output No reaction · Cool down machine
TCU measured a oil temperature at the OP mode : Normal · Check oil level
converter output that is the allowed · Check temperature sensor
threshold
C4 S. C. t o g r o u n d a t j oy s t i ck s t a t u s No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to
indicator OP mode : Normal joystick status indicator
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the · Check the connectors from joystick
output pin, that looks like a S.C. to vehicle status indicator to TCU
ground · Check the resistance* of joystick
·Cable is defective and is contacted to status indicator
vehicle ground * See page 3-49
·Joystick status indicator has an internal
defect
·Connector pin is contacted to vehicle
ground
C5 S.C. to battery voltage at joystick status No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to
indicator OP mode : Normal joystick status indicator
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the · Check the connectors from joystick
output pin, that looks like a S.C. to battery status indicator to TCU
voltage · Check the resistance* of joystick
·Cable is defective and is contacted to status indicator
battery voltage * See page 3-49
·Joystick status indicator has an internal
defect
·Connector pin is contacted to battery
voltage
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-46
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
C6 O.C. at joystick status indicator No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to
TCU detected a wrong voltage at the OP mode : Normal joystick status indicator
output pin, that looks like a O.C. for this · Check the connectors from joystick
output pin status indicator to TCU
·C a b l e i s d e fe c t i ve a n d h a s n o · Check the resistance* of joystick
connection to TCU status indicator
·Joystick status indicator has an internal * See page 3-49
defect
·Connector pin has no connection to
TCU
D1 S.C. to battery voltage at power supply See fault codes No.21 to · Check cables and connectors to
for sensors 2C sensors, which are supplied from
TCU measures more than 6V at the pin AU1
AU1 (5V sensor supply) · Check the power supply at the pin
AU1(Should be appx. 5V)
· Fault codes No.21 to No.2C may be
reaction of this fault
D2 S.C. to ground at power supply for See fault codes No.21 to · Check cables and connectors to
sensors 2C sensors, which are supplied from
TCU measures less than 4V at the pin AU1
AU1 (5V sensor supply) · Check the power supply at the pin
AU1(Should be appx. 5V)
· Fault codes No.21 to No.2C may be
reaction of this fault
D3 Low voltage at battery Shift to neutral · Check power supply battery
Measured voltage at power supply is lower OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check cables from batteries to TCU
than 18V(24V device) · Check connectors from batteries to
TCU
D4 High voltage at battery Shift to neutral · Check power supply battery
Measured voltage at power supply is OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check cables from batteries to TCU
higher than 32.5V(24V device) · Check connectors from batteries to
TCU
D5 Error at valve power supply VPS1 Shift to neutral · Check fuse
TCU switched on VPS1 and measured OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check cables from gearbox to TCU
VPS1 is off or TCU switched off VPS1 and · Check connectors from gearbox to
measured VPS1 is still on TCU
·Cable or connectors are defect and are · Replace TCU
contacted to battery voltage
·Cable or connectors are defect and are
contacted to vehicle ground
·Permanent power supply KL30 missing
·TCU has an internal defect
D6 Error at valve power supply VPS2 Shift to neutral · Check fuse
TCU switched on VPS2 and measured OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check cables from gearbox to TCU
VPS2 is off or TCU switched off VPS2 and · Check connectors from gearbox to
measured VPS2 is still on TCU
·Cable or connectors are defect and are · Replace TCU
contacted to battery voltage
·Cable or connectors are defect and are
contacted to vehicle ground
·Permanent power supply KL30 missing
·TCU has an internal defect
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-47
Fault code Meaning of the fault code Reaction of the TCU Possible steps to repair
(Hex) possible reason for fault detection
E3 S.C. to battery voltage at display output No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU sends data to the display and OP mode : Normal display
measures always a high voltage level on · Check the connectors at the display
the connector · Change display
·Cable or connectors are defective and
are contacted to battery voltage
·Display has an internal defect
E4 S.C. to ground at display output No reaction · Check the cable from TCU to the
TCU sends data to the display and OP mode : Normal display
measures always a high voltage level on · Check the connectors at the display
the connector · Change display
·Cable or connectors are defective and
are contacted to battery voltage
·Display has an internal defect
E5 Communication failure on DeviceNet Shift to neutral · Check Omron master
OP mode : TCU shutdown · Check wire of DeviceNet-Bus
· Check cable to Omron master
F1 General EEPROM fault No reaction · Replace TCU
TCU can't read non volatile memory OP mode : Normal ※ Often shown together with fault
·TCU is defective code F2
F2 Configuration lost Transmission stay neutral · Reprogram the correct configurat-
TCU has lost the correct configuration and OP mode : TCU shutdown ion for the vehicle (e.g. with cluster
can't control the transmission controller,...)
·Interference during saving data on non
volatile memory
·TCU is brand new or from another
vehicle
F3 Application error Transmission stay neutral · Replace TCU
Something of this application is wrong OP mode : TCU shutdown ※ This fault occurs only if an test
engineer did something wrong in
the application of the vehicle
F5 Clutch failure Transmission stay neutral · Check clutch
AEB was not able to adjust clutch filling OP mode : TCU shutdown ※ TCU shows also the affected clutch
parameters on the display
·One of the AEB-Values is out of limit
F6 Clutch adjustment data lost No reaction, · Execute AEB
TCU was not able to read correct clutch Default values : 0 for AEB
adjustment parameters Offsets used
·Interference during saving data on non OP mode : Normal
volatile memory
·TCU is brand new
F7 Substitute clutch control OP mode : Substitute · Check engine retarder torque
·Transmission input torque wrong clutch control · Check speed sensors
·Engine retarder torque wrong
·Speed signal (s) defective
※ Some fault codes are not applied to this machine.
3-48
5) MEASURING OF RESISTANCE AT ACTUATOR/SENSOR AND CABLE
(1) Actuator
2 G
76043PT19
(2) Cable
UBat
P(Power supply)
TCU
1 2 Actuator/
Sensor
C(Chassis)
Ground
76043PT20
3-49
5. AXLE
1) OPERATION
· The power from the engine passes through torque converter, transmission and drive shafts, and is
then sent to the front and rear axles.
· Inside the axles, the power passes from the bevel pinion to the bevel gear and is sent at right
angles. At the same time, the speed is reduced and passes through the both differentials to the
axle shafts. The power of the axle shafts is further reduced by planetary-gear-type final drives and
is sent to the wheels.
(1) Front axle
3
2 2
3
78093PT14
4
1
3
2 2
3
78093PT15
3-50
2) DIFFERENTIAL
(1) Description 3
When the machine makes a turn, the
2 4
outside wheel must rotate faster than the
inside wheel. A differential is a device
which continuously transmits power to the
right and left wheels while allowing them
to turn a different speeds, during a turn.
The power from the drive shaft passes
through bevel pinion (1) and is transmitted
to the bevel gear (2). The bevel gear
changes the direction of the motive force
by 90 degree, and at the same time
reduces the speed. 1
It then transmits the motive force through
the differential (3) to the axle gear shaft 770-3 [3-26(1)]
(4).
770-3 [3-26(2)]
770-3 [3-26(3)]
3-51
6. TIRE AND WHEEL
7407APT10
1) The tire acts to absorb the shock from the ground surface to the machine, and at the same time
they must rotate in contact with the ground to gain the power which drives the machine.
2) Various types of tires are available to suit the purpose. Therefore it is very important to select the
correct tires for the type of work and bucket capacity.
3-52
GROUP 2 OPERATIONAL CHECKS AND TROUBLESHOOTING
Chapter 2 : Troubleshooting
Group 3 : Tests and adjustments
3-53
※ Transmission oil must be at operating temperature for these checks.
for 30 seconds.
AN AH
A
Move gear selector lever to neutral
"N" position and r un for 15
seconds.
1
4
2
3
Repeat procedure until
transmission temperature gauge
arrow points to bar above dial.
Gear selector lever and Move gear selector lever to each OK
neutral lock latch checks position. Check completed.
Engine OFF. 1
NOT OK
changes slightly as steer ing
Repair lock or replace
column is tilted.
switch.
FEEL : Lever must move freely
through all positions.
Engage neutral lock.
Apply slight effort to move lever into
forward (F) and reverse (R).
LOOK : Neutral lock must stay
engaged.
Automatic shifting check Start engine. OK
Check completed.
1
2
3
F
N
Move gear selector lever to 4th
4
R
speed.
NOT OK
Turn T/M shift mode switch to AL Go to transmission error
(auto light) mode. code group at page 3-32~
3-48.
Auotmatic sign LOOK : Automatic sign on monitor.
Repair or replace the
Move gear selector lever to forward monitor or harness.
or reverse position.
Increase engine rpm.
LOOK : Speed on monitor must
vary with machine speed.
3-54
Item Description Service action
Transmission noise Run engine at approximately 1600 OK
check 1
2
rpm. Check completed.
3
Engine running.
4
4
2
3
LOOK/FEEL : Transmission must
shift back to 2nd gear.
Shift to (3rd or 4th) gear and press
gear selector lever kick down
switch once.
LOOK/FEEL : Transmission must
not shift down.
Select T/M shift mode switch to AL
(auto light) mode.
Drive machine at approximately
90% speed of max speed in each
gear (2nd or 3rd or 4th).
Shift to (2nd or 3rd or 4th) gear in
each forward and reverse speed
and press gear selector kick down
lever switch or RCV lever switch
once.
LOOK/FEEL : It shift down quickly
from current gear to one step lower
speed and recover to original
speed quickly when push the
switch one more time. (mode 1)
3-55
Item Description Service action
LOOK/FEEL : If shifts down from
current gear to one step lower
speed when push the switch
everytime and recover when push
the switch in 1st gear. (mode 2)
Forward, reverse and 4th Park unit on level surface. OK
speed clutch pack drag 1
2
3 Check completed.
Apply service brakes.
4
check
NOT OK
※ Transmission must Move gear selector lever to neutral.
I f u n i t m ove s, r e p a i r
be warmed up for Release
Move gear selector lever to 1st. transmission.
this check.
Engine running. Release parking brake and service
P
brakes.
Run engine at low idle.
LOOK : Unit must not move in
either direction.
NOTE : If unit moves forward,
either the forward pack or the 4th
speed pack is dragging.
Transmission shift Run engine at approximately 1300 OK
modulation check 1
4
2
3 rpm. Check completed.
Engine running.
Put transmission in 1st forward, NOT OK
shift several times from forward to Go to unit shifts too fast,
reverse and reverse to forward. chapter 2 in this group.
Repeat check in 2nd gear.
LOOK : Unit must slow down and
change direction smoothly.
Torque converter check Start engine. Apply service brakes OK
1
4
2
3
and release parking brake. Check completed.
Move gear selector lever to 3rd NOT OK
speed. If stall rpm are too low or
too high, problem may be
Move gear selector control lever to
engine power or torque
forward "F" position.
converter.
Increase engine speed to high idle.
IF OK
LOOK : Torque converter stall rpm Replace transmission
must be within the following range. torque converter.
Stall rpm : 2010±70 rpm
Move gear selector control lever to
neutral "N" position and run for 15
seconds.
3-56
2. TROUBLESHOOTING
1) TRANSMISSION
※ Diagnose malfunction charts are arranged from most probable and simplest to verify, to least likely,
more difficult to verify. Remember the following steps when troubleshooting a problem :
Step 1. Operational check out procedure (See group 3 in section 1.)
Step 2. Operational checks (In this group.)
Step 3. Troubleshooting
Step 4. Tests and/or adjustments (See group 3.)
3-57
Problem Cause Remedy
Machine will not move Low oil level. Add oil.
Applied park brake. Check parking brake fuse.
Check continuity to parking brake switch.
N o p o w e r t o t r a n s m i s s i o n Check transmission controller fuse.
controller.
Malfunctioning parking brake Remove and inspect parking brake solenoid
solenoid valve. valve.
Check for power to solenoid valve.
Restricted orifice of PPC valve. Remove orifice and check for contamination
and/or plugging.
(Do not remove valve housing for this purpose.)
Excessive leakage in Do transmission element leakage test using
transmission element. system pressure.
Worn clutch disks. Repair transmission.
Low or no transmission See transmission pressure is low in this group.
pressure.
Service brake will not release. Do brake pedal operational check.
Do service and park system drag checks.
Failed torque converter. Do torque converter stall test.
If engine pulldown in normal, torque converter is
good.
Broken shafts or gears. Drain transmission to determine if large pieces
of metal contamination are present.
Broken drive shafts. Inspect drive shafts and universal joints for
external damage. Repair.
Broken ring or pinion gear. If drive shaft rotate with transmission in gear but
machine does not move, a differential failure is
indicated. Repair.
Machine does not Malfunctioning transmission Check solenoid valve.
engage in low gear control solenoid valve.
Stuck spool in transmission Remove and inspect transmission control valve
control valve. spools.
Stuck PPC valve. Remove end cover to inspect PPC valve.
Replace if necessary.
Malfunctioning transmission Check speed sensor.
speed sensor.
3-58
Problem Cause Remedy
Transmission pressure is Low oil level. Check transmission oil level and refill if
low (all gears) necessary.
Failed transmission pressure Verify transmission system pressure. Do
switch. transmission system pressure test.
Plugged suction strainer. Transmission pump may be noisy if transmission
suction screen is clogged. Drain transmission.
Remove and clean suction screen.
Also, check condition of transmission filter.
Stuck transmission pressure Remove transmission pressure regulating valve.
regulating valve or broken spring. Inspect for damage (See transmission control
valve).
Failed control valve gasket. Inspect transmission control valve for external
leakage. Remove control valve.
Inspect or replace gasket.
Stuck PPC valve. Remove end cover to inspect modulation spool
and check torque on cap screws retaining
control valve to transmission.
Tr a n s m i s s i o n s y s t e m Failed transmission pump. Do pump flow test.
pressure is low (one or
Failed transmission control valve Inspect transmission control valve for external
two gears)
gasket. leakage. Remove control valve.
Inspect or replace gasket.
Leakage in clutch piston or seal Disassemble and repair.
ring.
Transmission shifts too Low oil level (aeration of oil). Add oil.
low
Low transmission pressure. Do transmission system pressure test.
Restricted transmission pump Remove and clean screen.
suction screen.
Low transmission pump flow. Do transmission pump flow test.
Excessive transmission Do transmission element leakage test using
element leakage. system pressure.
Stuck PPC valve. Remove end cover to inspect modulation spool.
Replace if necessary.
Restricted PPC valve orifice. Remove orifice and inspect for contamination
and /or plugging.
Restricted oil passages between Remove control valve and inspect oil passage.
control valve and transmission
elements.
Incorrect transmission oil. Change oil (SAE 10W-30/15W-40)
3-59
Problem Cause Remedy
Transmission shifts too Wrong transmission controller. Check if transmission controller has been
fast changed
System pressure too high. Do transmission system pressure test.
Stuck PPC valve. Remove and inspect PPC valve.
Replace if necessary. Also remove end cover
to inspect PPC valve and control valve housing.
Replace if necessary.
Stuck or missing check valves. Inspect transmission control valve.
Missing O-r ing from end of Remove orifice and inspect port for O-ring.
modulation orifice.
Broken piston return spring. Disassemble and inspect clutch.
Incorrect transmission oil. Change oil (SAE 10W-30/15W-40).
Machine "creeps" War ped disks and plates in Check transmission.
in neutral transmission.
Transmission hydraulic High oil level. Transmission overfilled or hydraulic pump seal
system overheats leaking.
Low oil level. Add oil.
Wrong oil grade. Change oil.
Park brake dragging. Check for heat in park brake area.
Pinched, restricted or leaking lube Check cooler lines.
lines.
Machine operated in too high Operate machine in correct gear range.
gear range.
Malfunction in temperature gauge I n s t a l l t e m p e ra t u r e s e n s o r t h e ve r i f y
or sensor. temperature.
Do tachometer/temperature reader installation
procedure.
Restricted air flow through oil Do radiator air flow test.
cooler or radiator.
Failed oil cooler bypass valve (In Disassemble and inspect.
thermal bypass valve).
Failed thermal bypass valve. Remove thermal bypass valve and check to see
if machine still overheats. Do transmission oil
cooler thermal bypass valve test.
Internally restricted oil cooler. Do oil cooler restriction test.
Leakage in transmission hydraulic Do transmission system pressure, element
system. leakage test.
Malfunction in converter relief Do converter out pressure test.
valve.
Low transmission pump output. Do transmission pump flow test.
3-60
Problem Cause Remedy
Excessive transmission Too low engine low idle. Check engine low idle speed.
noise (Under load or no
Wo r n p a r t s o r d a m a g e d i n Remove transmission suction screen. Inspect
load)
transmission. for metal particles.
Repair as necessary.
Warped drive line between engine Inspect drive line.
and torque converter.
Low or no lube. Do converter-out and lube pressure test. Do
transmission pump flow test.
Foaming oil Incorrect type of oil. Change oil.
High oil level. Transmission overfilled or hydraulic pump seal
leaking.
Low oil level. Add oil.
Air leak on suction side of pump. Check oil pickup tube on side of transmission.
Oil ejected from dipstick Plugged breather. Inspect breather on top of transmission.
Replace.
Machine vibrates Aerated oil. Add oil.
Low engine speed. Check engine speed.
Fa i l e d u n i ve r s a l j o i n t s o n Check universal joints.
transmission dr ive shaft or
differential drive shafts.
Machine lacks power and Engine high idle speed set too Check high idle adjustment.
acceleration low.
Incorrect transmission oil. Change oil.
Aerated oil. Add oil.
Low transmission pressure. Do transmission system pressure test.
Warped transmission clutch. Do transmission clutch drag checks.
Torn transmission control valve Inspect gasket.
gasket.
Brake drag. Do brake drag check.
Failed torque converter. Do torque converter stall speed test.
Low engine power. Do engine power test.
Torque conver ter stall Aerated oil. Put clear hose on thermal bypass outlet port.
RPM too high Run machine to check for bubbles in oil.
Stuck open converter relief valve. Do converter-out pressure test.
Leakage in torque converter seal. Do converter-out pressure test.
Torque converter not Replace torque converter.
transferring power (Bent fins,
broken starter).
3-61
Problem Cause Remedy
Torque conver ter stall Low engine power. Do engine power test.
RPM too low
Mechanical malfunction. Remove and inspect torque converter.
Transmission pressure Low oil level. Add oil.
light comes ON when
Cold oil. Warm oil to specification.
shifting from forward to
reverse (all other gears Leak in reverse pack. Do transmission pressure, pump flow, and
OK) leakage check.
Transmission pressure Cold oil. Warm oil to specification.
light comes ON for each
No time delay in monitor. Do monitor check.
shift
Restriction in modulation orifice. Remove orifice and inspect for restriction and/or
plugging.
Stuck PPC valve. Remove and inspect.
Low transmission pressure circuit. Do transmission system pressure test.
3-62
2) DIFFERENTIAL / AXLE
Problem Cause Remedy
Differential low on oil External leakage. Inspect axle and differential for leaks.
Excessive differential Low oil level in differential. Check oil. Remove drain plug and inspect for
and/or axle noise metal particles in differential case.
Disassemble and determine cause.
Incorrect type of oil. Change oil
Dragging brakes. Do brake check.
Failed pinion bearing. Remove and inspect pinion.
Check to ensure pinion housing was indexed.
Incorrect gear mesh pattern Remove pinion gear housing and inspect ring
between ring and pinion gear. and pinion gear.
Failed differential pinion gears Remove differential housing drain plug and
and/or cross shafts. inspect for metal particles. Disassemble and
inspect.
Failed axle bearing. Do axle bearing adjustment check.
M e c h a n i c a l fa i l u r e i n a x l e Remove differential. Inspect, repair.
planetary.
Oil seeping from outer Excessive end play in axle. Do axle bearing adjustment check.
axle seal
Worn outer bearing and/or cup. Disassemble and inspect outer axle bearing,
cup, spacer, and seal. Replace, if necessary.
Overfilled differential. Check differential oil return system for
excessive internal restriction.
Axle overheats Low differential oil. Add oil.
Overfilled differential. See differential overfills with oil in this group.
Brake drag. See brakes drag in this group.
3) DRIVE LINE
Problem Cause Remedy
E x c e s s i v e d r i v e l i n e Yokes not in line on drive shafts. Inspect. Align drive shaft yokes.
vibration or noise
Worn front drive line support Inspect, repair.
bearing.
Bent drive shaft. Inspect all drive shafts. Replace.
Loose yoke retaining nuts (drive Inspect. Replace.
shafts wobble at high speed).
Rear axle oscillating support. Inspect, repair.
Lack of lubrication. Lubricate with proper grade of grease.
3-63
GROUP 3 TESTS AND ADJUSTMENTS
55 60 56 53 58
52 63
57
10 D C
E B
F A 65
29 K
H
51
15
VIEW B
49 33 28
VIEW A 7809S3PT17
3 - 64
2) DELIVERY RATES
Port Description Size
10 Breather M10×1.0
15 Connection to the oil cooler -
16 Connection from the oil cooler -
27 Connection to the filter M42×2.0
28 Connection from the filter M42×2.0
29 Connection from the filter bypass M42×2.0
33 Connection oil filler plug M42×2.0
49 Plug connection on the electro-hydraulic control unit -
3-65
GROUP 4 DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
1. CONTROL VALVE
1) DISASSEMBLY
(1) Loosen the cap screws and take off the
gear shift housing.
※ Special tool
Socket spanner TX-27 5873 042 002
Figure 1001
Figure 1002
Figure 1003
Figure 1004
3-66
(5) Remove the retaining clamp
Figure 1005
Figure 1006
Figure 1007
Figure 1008
3-67
(9) Loosen two cap screws and fasten the
housing preliminarily by means of
adjusting screws (housing is preloaded).
Then loosen the remaining cap screws.
※ Special tool
Adjusting screws 5870 204 036
Figure 1009
Figure 1010
Figure 1011
Figure 1012
3-68
2) ASSEMBLY
※ All single components are to be checked for
damage and replaced, if required.
Prior to installation check the mobile parts
in the housing for functionality.
Pistons can be replaced individually.
Oil the single components pr ior to
installation.
Place the orifices, with the concave side
showing upwards, until contact.
※ Installation position, see arrows. Figure 1013
Figure 1014
Figure 1015
Figure 1016
3-69
Figure 1017
Figure 1018
Figure 1019
Figure 1020
3-70
Preassemble the opposite side :
(7) The opposite figure shows the following
single components :
1 Main pressure valve
(1EA, piston & comp spring)
2 Follow-on slide
(3EA, piston & comp spring) 3 1
3 Vibration damper 3
(3EA, piston & comp spring)
2 2
Figure1021
3-71
(10) Assemble the wiring harness and connect
the pressure controllers (6EA).
※ Pay attention to the installation position of
the wiring harness, also see markings
(figure 1003).
Figure1024
Figure1025
Figure 1026
Figure1027
3-72
(14) Install two adjusting screws.
Place the intermediate sheet with the
screens showing upwards.
※ Sepcial tool
Adjusting screws 5870 204 063
Figure1028
Figure1029
Figure1030
Figure1031
3-73
Installation of the Hydraulic Control Unit
(HCU-94)(figure1032~1036) :
(18) Provide the screw plug with a new O-ring
and install it.
·Torque limit
M26×1.5 : 8.16 kgf·m (59.0 lbf·ft)
Figure 1032
Figure 1033
Figure 1034
Figure 1035
3-74
(22) Fasten the complete valve block equally
by means of cap screws (6pcs. M6×100 &
17pcs. M6×76 mm).
Observe position of the cap screws
(M6×100),
(M6 100), see arrow.
·Torque limit : 1.22 kgf·m (8.85 lbf·ft)
※ Special tool
Socket spanner TX-27 5873 042 002
Torque spanner slipper 5870 203 043
Figure 1036
3-75
2. TRANSMISSION
1) DISASSEMBLY
(1) Fasten the complete transmission to the
assembly truck.
※ Special tool
Assembly truck 5870 350 000
Holding fixture 5870 350 071
Figure 1
Figure 2
Figure 3
Converter drive
(1) By means of the lifting tackle separate the
torque converter from the transmission.
※ Special tool
Eybolts assortment 5870 204 002
Lifting chain 5870 281 047
Figure 4
3-76
(2) Loosen the bolt connection and by means
of the forcing screws (3EA) separate the
cover from the converter bell.
※ Special tool
Forcing screws 5870 204 005
Figure 5
Figure 6
Figure 7
Figure 8
3-77
(6) Remove the rectangular ring (arrow).
Figure 9
Figure10
Figure11
Figure 12
3-78
(10) Remove the inductive transmitter.
9 = n - Engine
Figure 13
Figure 21
Figure 22
Figure 23
3-79
(4) Snap out the rectangular ring (arrow 1)
and remove both shims (arrow 2).
1 2
Figure 24
Transmission pump
(1) Loosen the cap and hexagon screws
(depending on the version) respectively
and separate the pump flange from the
housing.
Figure 25
Figure 27
3-80
Remove the ball bearing and the driver
(1st power take-off, figure 28~29)
(4) Snap out the retaining ring.
Figure 28
Figure 29
3-81
3rd/and 4th power take-off
(7) Remove the screw-in sleeve (arrow).
Figure 31
Figure 32
Figure 33
Figure 34
3-82
(10) Loosen the hexagon screws and remove
the cover.
Figure 35
Figure 36
Figure 37
3-83
Layshaft
(1) Remove the sealing cover and loosen the
hexagon screw.
Figure 38
Figure 39
Figure 40
13
Figure 41
3-84
Output
Converter side :
Remove the lock plate. Loosen hexagon
screws and take off the output flange.
Rotate the housing by 180˚ and remove
the output flange on the housing rearside.
Figure 42
Transmission rearside
For working on the brake system observe
the instructions and specifications of the
brake manufacturer.
(1) Unscrew the screw cap.
Figure 43
Figure 44
Figure 45
3-85
Removal of the clutches and layshaft
(1) Loosen the hexagon screws and expel the
bearing cover KV/K1 by means of the
striker from the housing bore.
Remove the bearing cover KR/K2 (arrow)
analogously.
※ Mark the installation location of the
bearing cover.
※ Special tool Figure 46
Figure 47
Figure 48
※ Special tool
Internal hex spanner, size 8 5870 290 003
Forcing screws 5870 204 005
Lifting tackle 5870 281 061
Figure 49
3-86
(5) Expel the output shaft from the output
gear.
Figure 50
Figure 51
Figure 52
Figure 53
3-87
Remove the multi-disc clutches
※ For removal of the single clutches observe
the following sequence :
K4/K3 → KR/K2 → KV/K1.
For removal of clutch K4/K3, lift the clutch
KR/K2 slightly and move it in direction of
the arrow, see figure.
※ Special tool
Eyebolts assortment 5870 204 002
Figure 54
K3 K2 K1
K4 KR KV
Figure 55
Figure 56
3-88
Dismantling of the Multi-Disc Clutch K3/K4
(1) By means of clamping ring (S) fasten the
clutch to the assembly truck.
※ Special tool
Clamping ring 5870 654 033
Figure 62
Figure 63
Figure 64
Figure 65
3-89
(5) Squeeze out the snap ring.
Remove the end shim and disc set K3.
Figure 66
Figure 67
Figure 68
Figure 69
3-90
(9) Remove the ring.
Figure 70
Figure 71
Figure 72
Figure 73
3-91
(13) Separate both pistons by means of
compressed air from the disc carrier.
Figure 74
Figure 75
Figure 76
Figure 77
3-92
(4) Press off the spur gear K2 from the disc
carrier.
Pay attention to released disc carrier.
Figure 78
Figure 79
Figure 80
Figure 81
3-93
(8) Pull off the taper roller bearing from the
disc carrier.
※ Special tool
Gripping insert 5873 002 044
Basic tool 5873 002 001
Figure 82
Figure 84
Figure 85
3-94
(12) Pull off the taper roller bearing from the
disc carrier.
※ Special tool
Gripping insert 5873 012 013
Basic tool 5873 002 001
Remove both piston (like described in
figure 73 and 74)
Figure 86
Figure 87
Figure 88
Figure 89
3-95
(4) Pull off spur gear K1 from the disc carrier.
※ Special tool
Three-armed puller 5870 971 003
Figure 90
Figure 91
Figure 92
Figure 93
3-96
Figure 94
Figure 95
Figure 96
Figure 97
3-97
(11) Pull off spur gear KV from the disc carrier.
※ Special tool
Three-armed puller 5870 971 003
Figure 98
Figure 99
3-98
2) ASSEMBLY
2
3rd/4th
3rd/4th power take-off 1
1 = Ball bearing 3
6
2 = Spur gear
3 = Driver
4
4 = Ball bearing
7
5 = Pump flange 5
6 = Cover
7 = Intermediate gear 11 9
8 = Shim
9 = Pin
10 = Sealing cover 10
11 = Orifice 8
Figure 109
Figure 110
Figure 111
3-99
(3) Heat the ball bearing (inner ring) and bore
of the gear respectively.
Figure 112
Figure 113
Figure 114
Figure 115
3-100
(7) Check the axial play by means of feeler
gauge.
※ If different from the required axial play =
0.2~0.3 mm this is tobe corrected with the
corresponding shim.
Feeler gauge 5870 200 112
Figure 116
Figure 117
Figure 118
Converter side
(10) Place the O-Ring (arrow) with assembly
grease in the recess ofthe housing bore.
Figure 119
3-101
(11) Fasten the cover (6) with hexagon screws.
Tightening torque (M14/8.8) : 12.7 kgf·m
(92.2 lbf·ft)
Provide the orifice (arrow) with a new
sealing ring (CU) andinstall it.
Figure 120
Figure 121
Figure 122
3-102
(15) Install the corresponding shim (8) e.g. s =
1.20 mm (arrow).
※ Install shim on the converter side
Figure 124
Figure 125
Figure 126
3-103
Assembly of the multi-disc clutch K4/K3
The following sketch shows the clutch sectioning
1
3
2
K4 K3
5 4 4 5
Figure 127
※ Observe the installation position of the single components for the following assembly.
3-104
(1) Lift the disc carrier with the K4-side
showing downwards into the clamping
ring (S) and fasten it.
Rotate disc carrier by 180˚.
※ Special tool
Clamping ring 5870 654 033
To install new disc carriers the finished
bores have to be sealed with plugs.
I n s t a l l a t i o n p o s i t i o n , s e e a r r o w,
Figure 128
figure128 and 129.
※ Special tool
Hand inserting tool 5870 320 014
Ratchet spanner 5870 320 018
Figure 129
Figure 130
Figure 131
3-105
(4) Oil the O-rings and the piston contact
surface.
Install K3 piston equally until contact.
※ Observe the installation position of the
piston, see figure.
Figure 132
Figure 133
Figure 134
Figure 136
※ Install the outer clutch discs position 3 with uncoated side showing to the piston and end shim
respectively. The respective clutch side can be seen on the length of the disc carrier, see sketch.
K4 Dimension X (short disc carrier side)
K3 Dimension Y (long disc carrier side)
3-107
Check disc clearance K4=2.2~2.4 mm
(figure 137~139)
※ In order to ensure a perfect measuring
result, the disc set is first of all to be
installed without oil.
(1) Install disc set according to sketch or
table.
Figure137
Figure138
3-108
Preassemble and install spur gear K4
(figure 140~144) :
4 1
(1) Opposite figure shows the single 2
components of spur gear K4. 1 2 3
1 Bearing inner ring
2 Bearing outer ring
3 Ring
4 Spur gear
Locate both bearing outer rings (2) until
Figure140
contact.
Figure141
Figure142
Figure143
3-109
(5) Heat the bearing inner ring (spur gear
bearing) and locate it until contact.
Use safety gloves.
Figure144
Figure145
3-110
Clutch Components K3
※ Below sketch or table shows the standard version as to the installation position of the single
components. Obligatory is the respective spare parts list.
Figure146
※ Install the outer clutch discs position 3 with uncoated side showing to the piston and end shim
respectively. The respective clutch side can be seen on the length of the disc carrier, see sketch.
K3 Dimension Y (long disc carrier side)
K4 Dimension X (short disc carrier side)
3-111
Check disc clearance K3=2.6~2.8 mm
(figure 147~149)
※ In order to ensure a perfect measuring
result, the disc set is first of all to be
installed without oil.
(1) Install disc set according to sketch or table.
Figure 147
Figure 148
3-112
(4) Heat the bearing inner ring and install it
until contace.
Use safety gloves.
Figure 150
3-113
(7) Install the bearing outer ring into spur
gear K3 until contact.
Figure 153
Figure 154
Figure 155
Figure 156
3-114
(11) Check function of the clutches K3 and K4
by means of compressed air.
※ Closing or opening of the clutches is
clearly audible when the single parts have
been installed adequately.
Figure 157
Figure 158
3-115
Assembly of the multi-disc clutch KR/K2
The following sketch shows the clutch sectioning.
2 1 3
KR K2
5 4 4 5
Figure159
※ Observe the installation position of the single components for the following assembly.
3-116
(1) Lift the disc carrier with the KR-side
showing downwards into the clamping
ring and fasten it.
Then rotate disc carrier by 180˚.
To install new disc carriers the finished
bores have to be sealed with plugs.
Installation position, see arrow, figure
160~161.
※ Special tool
Figure 160
Clamping ring 5870 654 033
Hand mounting tool 5870 320 014
Ratchet 5870 320 018
Figure 161
Figure 162
Figure 163
3-117
(4) Oil the O-rings and the piston contact
surface.
Install K2 piston equally until contact.
※ Observe the installation position of the
piston, see figure.
Figure 164
Figure 165
Figure 166
3-118
Disc Components KR
※ Below sketch or table shows the standard version as to the installation position of the single
components. Obligatory is the respective spare parts list.
Figure 168
※ Install the outer clutch discs position 3 with uncoated side showing to the piston and end shim
respectively. The respective clutch side can be seen on the length of the disc carrier, see sketch.
KR Dimension X (long disc carrier side)
K2 Dimension Y (short disc carrier side)
3-119
Check disc clearance KR=2.8~3.0 mm
(figure 169~171)
※ In order to ensure a perfect measuring
result, the disc set is first of all to be
installed without oil.
(1) Install disc set according to sketch or table.
Figure 169
Figure 170
3-120
Preassemble and install spur gear KR
(figure 172~176) :
3
(1) Opposite figure shows the single 4
1
components of spur gear KR. 2
1 Bearing inner ring (75×37 mm)
2 Ring
3 Spur gear
4 Bearing inner ring (75×41 mm)
Figure 172
Figure 173
Figure 174
Figure 175
3-121
(5) Heat the bearing inner ring (75×41 mm)
and locate it until contact.
Use safety gloves.
Figure 176
Figure 177
3-122
Disc Components K2
※ Below sketch or table shows the standard version as to the installation position of the single
components. Obligatory is the respective spare parts list.
Figure 178
3-123
Check disc clearance K2=2.6~2.8 mm
(figure 179~181)
※ In order to ensure a perfect measuring
result, the disc set is first of all to be
installed without oil.
(1) Install disc set according to sketch or table.
Figure 179
Figure 180
3-124
Preassemble and install spur gear K2
(figure182~186) :
(1) Undercool gear 1 (approx -80˚C) and heat
1 2
gear 2 (approx 120˚C).
Engage the snap ring(arrow), preload it
and join both components by means of
hydraulic press until the snap ring engag-
es into the annular groove of gear 2.
Figure 182
3
2
Figure 183
Figure 184
Figure 185
3-125
(5) Heat the bearing inner ring (spur gear
bearing) and install it until contact.
Use safety gloves.
Figure 186
Figure 187
3-126
(8) Lift the disc carrier into the clamping ring
and fasten it.
Rotate disc carrier by 90˚.
K2-side :
Install the slotted nut.
※ Observe installation position of the slotted
nut. Chamfer must show to the bearing
inner ring, also see sketch (Figure 159).
Oil the thread.
Figure 189
·Torque limit : 56.1 kgf·m (406 lbf·ft)
※ Special tool
Clamping ring 5870 654 033
Slotted nut wrench 5870 401 099
KR-side :
Install the slotted nut.
※ Observe installation position of the slotted
nut. Collar (Ø76 mm) must show to the
bearing inner ring, also see sketch/page
3-113. Oil the thread.
·Torque limit : 56.1 kgf·m (406 lbf·ft)
※ Special tool
Slotted nut wrench 5870 401 099 Figure 190
Figure 191
3-127
Assembly of the multi-disc clutch KV/K2
The following sketch shows the clutch sectioning
2 1
KV K1
7
5 4 4 5
Figure 192
※ Observe the installation position of the single components for the following assembly.
3-128
(1) Lift the disc carrier with the KV-side
showing downwards into the clamping
ring(S) and fasten it.
Then rotate disc carrier by 180˚.
To install new disc carriers the finished
bores have to be sealed with plugs.
I n s t a l l a t i o n p o s i t i o n , s e e a r r o w,
figure193~194.
※ Special tool
Figure 193
Hand mounting tool 5870 320 014
Ratchet spanner 5870 320 018
Figure 194
Figure 195
Figure 196
3-129
(4) Oil the O-rings and the piston contact
surface.
Install K1 piston equally until contact.
※ Observe the installation position of the
piston, see figure.
Figure 197
Figure 198
Figure 199
3-130
Disc Components KV
※ Below sketch or table shows the standard version as to the installation position of the single
components. Obligatory is the respective spare parts list.
Figure 201
1 Disc carrier 1
2 Piston 1
3 Outer clutch disc 2 1.85 Coated on one side
4 Outer clutch disc 11 2.5 Coated on both sides
5 Inner clutch disc 9 3.5
6 Inner clutch disc 1 4.0
7 Inner clutch disc 2 2.5~4.0 Optional
8 Snap ring 1 2.10~3.10 Optional
9 End shim 1
Number of friction surfaces : 24
Disc clearance : 2.8 ~ 3.0 mm
※ Install the outer clutch discs position 3 with uncoated side showing to the piston and end shim
respectively. The respective clutch side can be seen on the length and Ø of the disc carrier resp-
ectively, see sketch.
KV Dimension Y (long disc carrier side and large Ørespectively)
K1 Dimension X (short disc carrier side and small Ørespectively)
3-131
Check disc clearance KV=2.8~3.0 mm
(figure 202~204)
※ In order to ensure a perfect measuring
result, the disc set is first of all to be
installed without oil.
(1) Install disc set according to sketch or table.
Figure 202
Figure 203
3-132
Preassemble and install spur gear KV
(figure 205~209) :
(1) Opposite figure shows the single
components of spur gear KV.
1 Bearing inner ring
2 Bearing outer ring
2 1
3 Ring
3 4
4 Spur gear 1 2
contact.
Figure 206
Figure 207
Figure 208
3-133
(5) Heat the bearing inner ring (spur gear
bearing) and locate it until contact.
Use safety gloves.
Figure 209
Figure 210
3-134
Disc Components K1
※ Below sketch or table shows the standard version as to the installation position of the single
components. Obligatory is the respective spare parts list.
Figure 211
1 Disc carrier 1
2 Piston 1
3 Outer clutch disc 2 1.85 Coated on one side
4 Outer clutch disc 8 2.5 Coated on both sides
5 Inner clutch disc 7 2.5
6 Inner clutch disc 2 2.5~4.0 Optional
7 Snap ring 1 2.1~2.5 Optional
8 End shim 1
Number of friction surfaces : 18
Disc clearance : 2.6 ~ 2.8 mm
※ Install the outer clutch discs position 3 with uncoated side showing to the piston and end shim
respectively. The respective clutch side can be seen on the length andØof the disc carrier resp-
ectively, see sketch.
K1 Dimension X (short disc carrier side and small Ørespectively)
KV Dimension Y (long disc carrier side and large Ørespectively)
3-135
Check disc clearance KV=2.6~2.8 mm
(figure 212~214)
※ In order to ensure a perfect measuring
result, the disc set is first of all to be
installed without oil.
(1) Install disc set according to sketch or table.
Figure 212
Figure 213
3-136
Preassemble and install spur gear K1
(figure 215~222) :
1
(1) Opposite figure shows the single
components of spur gear K1.
1 Ball bearing (assy)
2 Snap ring
3 Spur gear 3
2
※ Prior to installation of the single com-
ponents, align the disc set by means of Figure 215
Figure 216
Figure 217
Figure 218
3-137
(4) Press in the ball bearing until contact.
※ Install the ball bearing with the lubricating
groove (arrow) showing downwards.
Put the press-in tool only to te bearing
outer ring.
Figure 219
Figure 220
Figure 221
Figure 222
3-138
(8) Install shim s = 1.20 mm
Figure 223
Figure 224
3-139
(11) Lift the disc carrier into the clamping ring
(S). Rotate disc carrier by 90˚.
Install the slotted nut.
※ Observe installation position of the slotted
nut. Collar (Ø60 mm) must show to the
taper roller bearing also see sketch
(Figure 192). Oil the thread.
·Torque limit : 56.1 kgf·m (406 lbf·ft)
※ Special tool Figure 226
Figure 227
Figure 228
3-140
Installation of layshaft gear, multi-disc
clutches and output gear 3
1
(1) Opposite figure shows the single compon- 1 2
ents of the layshaft gear bearing.
1 Bearing inner ring (2EA)
2 Ring
3 Layshaft gear
Figure 229
Figure 230
Figure 231
Figure 232
3-141
(5) Position clutch KR/K2.
※ Special tool
Eyebolts assortment 5870 204 002
Figure 233
Figure 234
Figure 236
3-142
(9) Insert the bearing outer ring into the
housing bore until contact.
Figure 237
Figure 238
Figure 239
Figure 240
3-143
(13) Position upper oil baffle and fasten both
plates by means of hexagon screws (4EA).
※ Install washers.
Secure hexagon screws with loctite (type
No.243).
·Torque limit : 2.35 kgf·m (16.7 lbf·ft)
Figure 241
Figure 243
Figure 244
3-144
(4) Install both cylindrical pins (arrow 1 and 2)
and the slotted pin (arrow 3). 2
Then fasten the housing cover by means
of hexagon and cap screws.
·Torque limit M10/8.8 :
4.69 kgf·m (33.9 lbf·ft)
3 1
Figure 245
Figure 247
3-145
Housing dimension :
(1) Press on equally the bearing inner ring
and detemine Dimension I, from the
mounting face to the bearing inner ring.
Dimension I e.g ----------------------- 43.65 mm
※ Take several measuring points and
determine the mean value.
Then remove the bearing inner ring again.
※ Special tool Figure 248
Cover dimension :
(2) Determine Dimension II, from the mount-
ing face until contact/bearing inner ring.
Dimension II e.g ------------------------ 42.12 mm
※ Special tool
Straightedge 5870 200 022
Gauge blocks 5870 200 067
Digital depth gauge 5870 200 072
Figure 249
Example :
Dimension I ----------------------------- 43.65 mm
Dimension II ---------------------------- - 42.12 mm
Difference ------------------------------- = 1.53 mm
Bearing preload --------------- e.g. + 0.02 mm
Resulting shim(s) ------------- s = 1.55 mm
(3) Put on the shim.
Figure 250
Figure 251
3-146
(5) Grease the rectangular rings (3EA,
arrows) and centrally align them.
Figure 252
Figure 253
Figure 255
3-147
Adjust the bearing preload of clutch KR/K2
= 0.0~0.05 mm (figure 258~262)
※ For installation of a new bearing cover, 1
both finished bores have to be sealed by
means of a plug. 2
Finished bores are located opposite (18˚)
to each other, also see arrow/Figure 256 (S)
and 257.
1 Bearing cover-KR/K2
Figure 256
2 Plug
(S) Special tool
※ Special tool
Hand mounting tool 5870 320 014 1
Ratchet spanner 5870 320 018
2
(S)
Figure 257
Figure 258
Figure 259
3-148
Housing dimension :
(3) Determine Dimension I, from the bearing
outer ring to the mounting face.
Dimension I e.g ------------------------- 16.13 mm
Figure 260
Cover dimension :
(4) Determine Dimension II, from the contact/
bearing outer ring to the mounting face.
Dimension II e.g ------------------------ 17.75 mm
※ Special tool
Digital depth gauge 5870 200 072
Figure 261
Example :
Dimension II ---------------------------- 17.75 mm
Dimension I ---------------------------- - 16.13 mm
Difference ------------------------------- = 1.62 mm
Bearing preload --------------- e.g. + 0.03 mm
Resulting shim (s) ------------- s = 1.65 mm
(5) Fix the shim with assembly grease into
the cover. Install the O-ring (arrow).
Figure 262
Figure 263
3-149
(7) Pull the bearing cover equally until
contact.
·Torque limit (M10/8.8) :
4.69 kgf·m (33.9 lbf·ft)
Figure 264
Figure 265
3-150
Adjust the bearing preload of clutch KV/K1
= 0.0~0.05 mm (figure 267~270) 1
※ For installation of a new bearing cover,
both finished bores have to be sealed by
means of a plug.
Installation position, see arrows/Figure 2
266.
(S)
1 Bearing cover-KV/K1
2 Plug
Figure 266
(S) Special tool
※ Special tool
Hand mounting tool 5870 320 014
Ratchet spanner 5870 320 018
Figure 268
3-151
Cover dimension :
(3) Determine Dimension II, from the mount-
ing face to the ring.
Dimension II e.g ------------------------ 50.75 mm
※ Special tool
Digital depth gauge 5870 200 072
Gauge blocks 5870 200 067
Figure 269
Example :
Dimension I ----------------------------- 52.67 mm
Dimension II --------------------------- - 50.75 mm
Difference --------------------------- e.g. 1.92 mm
Bearing preload ---------------------- + 0.03 mm
Resulting shim (s) ------------- s = 1.95 mm
(4) Put in the shim.
Figure 270
Figure 271
Figure 272
3-152
(7) Heat the bearing bore.
※ Special tool
Hot-air blower 230V 5870 221 500
Hot-air blower 115V 5870 221 501
Figure 273
Figure 274
Figure 275
3-153
Output
Installation of the output shaft
(1) Heat the inner diameter of the output gear.
※ Special tool
Hot-air blower 230V 5870 221 500
Hot-air blower 115V 5870 221 501
Figure 276
Figure 277
※ Special tool
Mounting tool 5870 048 265
Then rotate the transmission housing
Figure 278
back again (90˚).
Figure 279
3-154
Adjust the axial play of the output bearing
= 0.3~0.5 mm (figure 280~282)
(4) Determine Dimension I, from plane face/
housing to end face/output shaft.
Dimension I e.g ------------------------- 66.90 mm
※ Special tool
Digital depth gauge 5870 200 072
Figure 280
Figure 282
Figure 283
3-155
Figure 284
Figure 285
3-156
Adjust gap size X = 0.3~0.8 mm
2
(figure 289~292) :
X Gap size
1 Shim
1
2 O-ring.
Figure 289
Figure 290
3-157
(3) Place the O-ring (arrow) into the space
between output flange and shaft (see also
figure 289) and put on the shim.
Figure 292
Figure 293
Figure 294
3-158
Output flange - parking brake
(1) Press on the screen sheet (arrow) until
contact.
※ The installation position of the screen
sheet is identical with the output flange.
Pressing bush 5870 506 138
Figure 295
Figure 296
Figure 298
3-159
Adjust the nominal clearance = 2.0 mm (figure
299~301)
(5) Make the pressure connection and apply
the required release pressure = 150 bar to
the brake (cup spring set preloaded).
Fasten the adjusting screw in clockwise
direction until both brake lining carriers
contact the brake disc (turning of the
adjusting screw is then not possible or
admissible any more without a higher Figure 299
application of force).
Then turn back the adjusting screw by 4/5
turns in counterclockwise direction. 4/5
turns is equal to a nominal clearance of
2.0 mm.
Figure 300
Figure 301
3-160
Output Flange (converter side)
(1) Install the shaft seal (arrow) with the
sealing lip showing to the oil sump.
※ Using of the specified mounting tool,
results in the exact installation position
(with retaining ring = 7.0 mm).
Grease the sealing lip.
※ Special tool
Mounting tool 5870 048 265 Figure 302
Figure 303
1 Screen sheet
2 Output flange
1
Figure 304
3-161
(2) Install the output flange until contact.
※ Setting of the gap size as well as fixing of
the output flange is identical with the
installation of the output flange at the
transmission rearside.
Figure 305
Figure 306
Figure 307
Figure 308
3-162
(4) Remove the adjusting screw and fasten
the axle by means of hexagon screw.
※ Wet the thread of the hexagon screw with
Loctite (type No. 243).
·Torque limit (M10/8.8) :
4.69 kgf·m (33.9 lbf·ft)
Figure 309
Figure 310
Transmission pump
(with 2nd/3rd or 4th power take-off)
(1) Press the needle sleeve (arrow), with the
reinforced coating towards the press-in
tool until contact.
Mounting tool 5870 058 041
Handle 5870 260 002
Figure 311
Figure 312
3-163
(3) Install the O-Ring (arrow) and grease it.
Figure 313
Figure 314
Figure 315
Figure 316
3-164
(7) Fasten the pump flange and pump
respectively by means of cap screws.
※ Wet thread of both cap screws (position,
see arrows) with loctite, Type No. 574
(through holes).
※ Tightening torque (M12/8.8) : 8.06 kgf·m
(58.3 lbf·ft)
Figure 317
Figure 318
Figure 319
Figure 320
3-165
(11) Install the driver by means of clamping
plate until contact and fasten it by means
of cap screw.
※ Tightening torque M10/8.8, DIN 6912) :
3.26 kgf·m (23.6 lbf·ft)
※ Wet thread of the cap screw with loctite
(Type No. 243).
Figure 321
Figure 322
Figure 323
Figure 324
3-166
(15) Install the preassembled input shaft until
contact.
※ Pay attention to align the key to the
keyway.
Figure 325
Figure 327
Example :
Dim I ....................................... 128.50 mm
Dim II ...................................... - 127.46 mm
Difference ............................... = 1.04 mm
Axial play ................................ - 0.04 mm
resulting shim(s) s = 1.00 mm
Put in the shim and locate the bearing
inner ring until contact.
Figure 328
3-167
Transmission pump
(with 1st power take-off)
(1) Press the needle sleeve (arrow), with the
reinforced coating towards the press-in
tool until contact.
※ Special tool
Mounting tool 5870 058 041
Handle 5870 260 002
Figure 329
Figure 330
Figure 331
Figure 332
3-168
(5) Fasten the ball bearing by means of
retaining ring.
※ Special tool
Set of internal pliers 5870 900 013
Figure 333
Figure 334
Figure 335
Figure 336
3-169
(9) Put the O-ring (arrow) into the annular
groove of the pump flange.
※ Depending on the transmission version,
differences as regards the version and
fastening of the pump flange are possible.
Obligatory is the respective parts list.
Figure 337
Figure 339
Figure 340
3-170
(13) Heat the bevel bearing inner ring.
※ Special tool
Hot-air blower 230V 5870 221 500
Hot-air blower 115V 5870 221 501
Figure 341
Figure 342
Figure 343
3-171
Input-Converter Bell
※ To install a new converter bell the finished
bores (3EA) have to be sealed with plugs.
Installation position, see arrow, figure 344.
※ Special tool
Lever riveting tongs 5870 320 016
Figure 344
Figure 345
Figure 346
Figure 347
3-172
(4) Install the input shaft until contact.
Figure 348
Figure 349
Figure 350
Figure 351
3-173
(8) Install the converter safety valve (arrow 1)
and fasten it by means of slotted pin
(arrow 2).
※ Flush-mount slotted pin to recess.
1
Put the O-ring (arrow 3) into the annular
groove.
3 2
Figure 352
Figure 353
Figure 354
3-174
(12) Install two adjusting screws and put in the
oil supply flange until contact.
※ Observe the radial installation position.
※ Special tool
Adjusting screws 5870 204 007
Figure 356
Figure 357
Figure 358
3-175
Converter pressure back-up valve
(figure 360~361)
(1) Install the slotted pin (6×50 mm) until
contact.
Figure 360
Figure 361
Figure 362
Figure 363
3-176
(5) Install the converter bell by means of
lifting tackle until contact.
※ Slight rotary motions of the input shaft
facilitate the installation (protect teeth from
damage). Observe the radial installation
position.
※ Special tool
Lifting tackle 5870 281 047
Eyebolts assortment 5870 204 002
Figure 364
Figure 365
Figure 366
Figure 367
3-177
(9) Assemble converter by means of lifting
tackle until contact (figure 368).
※ At a control dimension < 43 mm, the exact
installation position of the converter is
ensured, see Figure 369.
※ Special tool
Eyebolts assortment 5870 204 002
Lifting chain 5870 281 047
Figure 368
Figure 369
Figure 370
3-178
Coarse Filter
(1) Install filter (assy) into the housing bore.
※ Oil the sealing (arrow).
Figure 371
Figure 372
13
Figure 373
3-179
※ The following figures describe the
installation and setting respectively of the
inductive transmitter n-Engine (9).
Installation of the inductive transmitter
n-Turbine (14) and n-internal speed input
"S"
"A"
I
(5) is to be made analogously.
Observe the different setting dimens-
X
ions "X" :
Inductive transmitter n-Engine (9)
Figure 375
X = 0.5+0.3 mm
Inductive transmitter n-Turbine (14)
X = 0.5+0.3 mm
Induct. transmitter n-int. speed input (5)
X = 0.3
0.3±0.10.1 mm
Figure 376
※ Special tool
Plug gauge 5870 200 104
II
Figure 378
3-180
(3) Turn out the plug gauge and determine
Dimension II (also see figure 378).
Dimension II e.g ------------------------- 30.10 mm
Figure 379
Example "A1" :
Dimension II 30.10 mm
Dimension X (0.5+0.3 mm) - 0.60 mm
Results in installation dimension A
= 29.50 mm
Example "A2" :
Dimension I 30.00 mm
Installation dimension A - 29.50 mm
Results in shim ring (s) s = 0.50 mm
Figure 380
3-181
Install speed transmitter n-Output/Speedo
X
(13) (figure 382~387)
2
1 Housing 13
2 Spur gear K3 1
3 Disc carrier
13 Speed transmitter (hall sensor) 3
X Setting dimension "X" =1.0+0.5 mm
Figure 382
Figure 383
Figure 384
Figure 385
3-182
Example "B1" :
Dimension I 39.70 mm
Dimension X(1.0 +0.5 mm) - 1.20 mm
Results in installation dimension
= 38.50 mm
Example "B2" :
Dimension II 40.00 mm
Installation dimension A - 38.50 mm
Results in shim(s) s = 1.50 mm Figure 386
Figure 387
3-183
3. AXLE
1) DISASSEMBLY
(1) Disassembly output and brake
① Fix axle to assembly truck.
Assembly truck 5870 350 000
Fixtures 5870 350 077
Clamping brackets 5870 350 075
Support 5870 350 125
7809AX01
※ Before clamping the axle fully turn in the
support.
Position axle first onto the two fixtures,
secure with clamping brackets and then
unbolt the support until contact with the
axle is obtained.
7809AX02
7809AX03
3-184
③ Remove the breather valve (see arrow).
※ To avoid any damage, the breather valve
must be removed when separating the
output.
7809AX04
7809AX05
7809AX06
7809AX07
3-185
⑦ Use a lever to remove the cover from the
output shaft.
7809AX08
7809AX09
7809AX70
3-186
⑪ Disengage retaining ring.
7809AX71
7809AX72
7809AX73
7809AX12
3-187
⑮ Loosen hexagon screws, remove
releasing disk and cup spring.
7809AX13
7809AX14
7809AX15
3-188
Legend to sketch :
1 = Brake housing 1
2 = Guide ring
3 = Back-up ring
4 = Grooved ring
5 = Grooved ring
6 = Back-up ring 2
3
7 = Slide ring seal 4
8 = Output shaft 5
6
7809AX16
7809AX17
7809AX18
3-189
20 Use a lever to remove the slide ring seal
from the output shaft.
Resetting device 5870 400 001
7809AX74
7809AX75
3-190
(2) Disassembly axle housing
① Secure axle housing with the lifting
device and loosen the hexagon screws.
Then separate the axle housing from the
axle drive housing.
7809AX19
7809AX20
7809AX21
7809AX22
3-191
② Fix axle drive housing to the assembly
truck.
Assembly truck 5870 350 000
Fixtures (2EA) 5870 350 113
7809AX76
7809AX77
7809AX78
7809AX79
3-192
⑥ Lift differential out of the axle drive
housing with the lifting device.
Inner extractor 5870 300 008
Eye nut AA00 680 376
7809AX80
7809AX81
7809AX82
7809AX83
3-193
⑩ Pull input flange from the input pinion
and use a lever to lift the shaft seal ring
behind out of the axle drive housing.
7809AX84
7809AX85
7809AX86
7809AX87
3-194
⑭ If necessary pull the internal bearing
outer ring out of the axle drive housing
and remove the shim behind.
Assembly device AA00 696 770
Counter support 5870 300 020
7809AX88
7809AX89
3-195
(4) Disassembly
isassembly differentials
Disassembly
isassembly multi-disk differential lock
① Remove axial roller cage (arrow).
7809AX90
7809AX92
7809AX93
3-196
⑤ Preload the compression spring by
means of the press and disengage the
retaining ring.
Then pull the sliding sleeve out of the
differential cover and remove the
releasing compression springs.
7809AX94
7809AX95
7809AX96
7809AX97
3-197
⑨ Force out slotted pins (4EA).
7809AX98
7809AX99
7809AX100
7809AX101
3-198
2) ASSEHBY
(1) Assembly differentials
Assembly multi-disk differential lock
① Mount two adjusting screws and press
the heated crown wheel onto the
differential housing until contact is
obtained.
Adjusting screws 5871 204 040
7809AX102
7809AX103
7809AX104
3-199
⑤ Fix spider shafts with slotted pins (2
pieces / hole).
※ Press the slotted pins with 180° offset
openings into flush position.
7809AX106
7809AX107
7809AX108
3-200
Setting of disk package
⑧ Premount single parts according to the
adjacent sketch.
1 = Differential cover
2 = Pressure piece
3 = Disk
4 = Cage
5 = Lever (15EA)
6 = End plate
7809AX109
7 = Outer disks (optional)
8 = Inner disks
Legend to sketch:
A = Setting dimension = 15.5 -0.2 mm
7809AX111
7809AX112
3-201
⑪ Insert the premounted disk carrier onto
the axle bevel gear.
7809AX113
7809AX114
7809AX115
7809AX116
3-202
⑮ Insert pressure piece (see arrow) and
install disk.
7809AX117
7809AX118
7809AX119
7809AX120
3-203
19 Mount two adjusting screws and insert
the differential cover by means of the
lifting device.
Adjusting screws 5870 204 040
Inner extractor 5870 300 008
Eye nut AA00 680 376
7809AX121
7809AX122
7809AX123
7809AX124
3-204
(2) Assembly axle drive housing
※ If crown wheel or input pinion are
damaged, both parts must be jointly
replaced.
In case of a new installation of a
complete bevel gear set pay attention to
an identical mating number of input
pinion and crown wheel.
Determination
etermination of shim thickness to
obtain a correct contact pattern
※ The following measuring procedures
must be carr ied out with utmost
accuracy.
Inaccurate measurements lead to an
incorrect contact pattern requiring an
additional disassembly and reassembly
of input pinion and differential.
7809AX125
7809AX126
3-205
③ Determine dimension III (bearing width).
Dimension III e.g. . . . . . . . . . . . . 63.60 mm
Calculation example A :
Dimension I . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331.25 mm
Dimension II . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - 265.00 mm
Dimension III . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - 63.60 mm
Difference = shim s = 2.60 mm
7809AX127
7809AX128
7809AX129
7809AX130
3-206
④ Heat the tapered roller bearing and
insert it into the input pinion until contact
is obtained.
7809AX131
7809AX133
7809AX134
3-207
⑧ Insert input flange and fix it by means of
disk and slotted nut.
ᆞTightening torque :
122 kgf·m (885 lbf·ft)
Wrench 5870 401 093
Fixing device AA00 695 905
Clamping device 870 240 002
※ Preliminarily mount slotted nut without
Loctite. 7809AX135
7809AX137
3-208
⑪ Mount oil tube.
ᆞTightening torque :
10.2 kgf·m (73.8 lbf·ft)
7809AX138
7809AX139
7809AX140
3-209
Determination
etermination of shims for setting of
bearing rolling torque (differential
housing) and backlash (bevel gear set)
※ Determine the required shims on the basis
of the read value (deviation/test dimension)
and the corresponding specifications of the
table below: (KRS – SET – RIGHT) (KRS =
bevel gear set):
① Deviation see crown wheel rear side.
7809AX141
3-210
② Insert the determined shim (e.g. s = 1.4
mm) into the hole of the axle drive
housing and reset until contact with the
bearing outer ring is obtained.
7809AX143
7809AX144
7809AX145
7809AX146
3-211
⑥ Fix the bearing housing by means of
cylindrical screws (3EA).
ᆞTightening torque (M12/10.9) :
5.1 kgf·m (36.9 lbf·ft)
7809AX147
7809AX148
7809AX150
3-212
Reassembly of shaft seal ring (figure
AX151~153)
⑩ Loosen slotted nut and pull the input
flange from the input pinion.
Wrench 5870 401 093
Fixing device AA00 695 905
Clamping device 5870 240 002
7809AX151
7809AX154
3-213
⑭ Insert the bearing housing by means of
the lifting device and finally tighten it with
cylindrical screws.
·Tightening torque (M12/10.9) :
5.1 kgf·m (36.9 lbf·ft)
7809AX155
7809AX156
3-214
(3) Assembly axle housing
7809AX158
7809AX159
3-215
(4) Aeassembly output and brake
① Pull in wheel stud into the output shaft
until contact is obtained.
Wheel stud puller - basic tool
5870 610 001
Insert (M22x1.5) 5870 610 002
※ Special tool may only be used for repair
solution when exchanging individual
wheel studs with mounted output shaft. 7809AX28
7809AX29
7809AX31
3-216
③ Insert the premounted brake housing by
means of the lifting device over the
output shaft until contact is obtained.
※ Before clamping the seal rings to
installation dimension, clean the sliding
surfaces and apply an oil film. We
recommend to use a leather cloth
soaked with oil.
7809AX31
7809AX32
3-217
Legend to sketch:
1 = Brake housing 1
2 = Guide ring
3 = Back-up ring
4 = Grooved ring
5 = Grooved ring
2
6 = Back-up ring 3
7 = Slide ring seal 4
5
8 = Output shaft
6
7809AX34
7809AX35
7809AX36
3-218
⑧ Inser t disk and fix it by means of
hexagon screws.
·Tightening torque (M8/10.9) :
3.47 kgf·m (25.1 lbf·ft)
7809AX37
7809AX38
7809AX39
parts manual).
3-219
⑫ Press stop bolt into the cover until
contact is obtained.
Then insert the premounted cover into
the planetary carrier until contact is
obtained.
Legend to sketch:
1 = Stop bolt
2 = Cover
3 = Planetary carrier
7809AX161
7809AX164
3-220
16 Wet front face (contact face bearing
inner ring, arrow 1) and profile (teeth,
arrow 1) in the output shaft with anti-
1
corrosive agent. 2
7809AX41
3-221
19 Install O-ring (see arrow) to the cover.
7809AX44
7809AX45
7809AX47
3-222
22 Insert the sun gear shaft until contact is
obtained.
7809AX48
7809AX50
7809AX51
3-223
26 Fix O-ring (see arrow) with grease into
the countersink of the brake housing.
7809AX52
7809AX53
7809AX55
3-224
30 Check brake hydraulics for leakages.
Lock off:
When rotating the input flange one side
holds or has the opposite direction of
rotation.
※ Prior to putting the axle into operation, fill
it with oil according to the related
lubrication and maintenance instructions.
3-225
SECTION 4 BRAKE SYSTEM
1. OUTLINE
※ The brakes are operated by a pressure compensated, closed center hydraulic system.
Flow is supplied by a fixed displacement, gear type brake pump.
BRAKE SYSTEM
The fixed displacement brake pump supplies flow to the cut-off valve for service brake circuit and
park brake circuits. It flows to three accumulator. The accumulator has a gas precharge and an
inlet check valve to maintain a pressurized volume of oil for reserve brake applications.
Oil through the accumulator flows to the brake valves. The brake valve is a closed center design,
dual circuit operated by a pedal.
The front and rear brakes will operate simultaneously with only one brake pedal depressed.
The differential contains annular brake piston and double sided disk.
Brake pump flow also goes to the parking brake solenoid valve in cut-off valve.
The brake system contains the following components:
·Brake pump
·Parking brake solenoid valve in cut-off valve
·Cut-off valve
·Brake valve
·Accumulators
·Pressure switches
4-1
FULL POWER HYDRAULIC BRAKE
SYSTEM
ADVANTAGES - The full power hydraulic Response time
brake system has several advantages over Full power brake actuation VS
Air/Hydraulic brake actuation
traditional brake actuation systems. These
systems are capable of supplying fluid to a 1000
range of very small and large volume
service brakes with actuation that is faster 900
than air brake systems. Figure represents 800
a time comparison between a typical air/ Brake pressure
700 (Full power)
Brake torque(lb·in)
hydraulic and full power hydraulic brake
actuation system. 600
Brake pressure
Full power systems can supply significantly 500 (Air/hydraulic)
higher brake pressures with relatively low Brake torque
400
reactive pedal forces. The reactive pedal (Air/hydraulic)
force felt by the operator will be proportional 300
Brake torque
to the brake line pressure being generated. 200 (Full power)
This is referred to as brake pressure
modulation. 100
Another key design feature of full power
0 1 2 3 4
systems is the ability to control maximum
brake line pressure. In addition, because Time(seconds)
these systems operate with hydraulic oil,
filtration can be utilized to provide long
component life and low maintenance
operation.
Because these systems are closed center,
by using a properly sized accumulator,
emergency power-off braking that is
identical to power-on braking can be
achieved. These systems can be either
dedicated, where the brake system pump
supplies only the demands of the brake
system or non-dedicated, where the pump
supplies the demands of the brake system
as well as some secondary down stream
hydraulic device.
Another important note is that all seals
within these system must be compatible
with the fluid medium being used.
4-2
2. HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT
FRONT 39 REAR
18 PS
T1 P1 T2 P2
40
T/M
16 17
16 7 B1 A1 B2 A2
A3
PS
PS
T1
19
B
PS1
PS
19
P T Return line
Parking brake MCV
solenoid
20 Steering RCV lever
system
Fan drive motor
23
Return line
24 Return line
25 21
26
7809S4BS01
4-3
1) SERVICE BRAKE RELEASED
FRONT 39 REAR
18 PS
T1 P1 T2 P2
40
T/M
16 17
16 7 B1 A1 B2 A2
A3
PS
PS
T1
19
B
PS1
PS
19
P T Return line MCV
23
Return line
24 Return line
25 21
26
7809S4BS02
When the pedal of brake valve (8) is released, the operating force is eliminated by the force of the
spring, and the spool is returned.
When the spool removes up, the drain port is opened and the hydraulic oil in the piston of axles
return to the tank (24).
Therefore, the service brake is kept released.
4-4
2) SERVICE BRAKE OPERATED
FRONT 39 REAR
18 PS
BL1 BR1 BL2 BR2
8
T1 P1 T2 P2
40
T/M
16 17
16 7 B1 A1 B2 A2
A3
PS
PS
T1
19
B
PS1
PS
19
P T Return line MCV
23
Return line
24 Return line
25 21
26
7809S4BS03
When the pedal of brake valve (8) is depressed, the operating force overcomes the force of the
spring, and is transmitted to the spool. When the spool moves down, the inlet port is opened, and
at the same time the hydraulic oil controlled the pressure level by the cut-off valve (7) enters the
piston in the front and rear axles. Therefore, the service brake is applied.
4-5
3) PARKING BRAKE RELEASED
FRONT 39 REAR
18 PS
T1 P1 T2 P2
40
B
T/M
16 17 A
P
16 7 B1 A1 B2 A2
Parking brake switch
A3
PS
PS
T1
19 B
PS1
PS
19
P T Return line MCV
Parking brake
solenoid
20 Steering RCV lever
system
Fan drive motor
23
Return line
24 Return line
25 21
26
7809S4BS04
When the parking brake switch is pressed A position, the solenoid valve is energized and the
hydraulic oil controlled the pressure level by the cut-off valve (7) enters the parking brake. It
overcomes the force of the spring and pushes the piston rod. This releases the brake.
Therefore, the hydraulic oil pressure is applied to the parking brake piston through the solenoid
valve and the parking brake is kept released.
4-6
4) PARKING BRAKE OPERATED
FRONT 39 REAR
18 PS
T1 P1 T2 P2
40
B
T/M
16 17 A
P
16 7 B1 A1 B2 A2
Parking brake switch
A3
PS
PS
T1
19
B
PS1
PS
19
Parking brake
P T Return line MCV
solenoid
20 Steering RCV lever
system
Fan drive motor
23
Return line
24 Return line
25 21
26
7809S4BS05
When the parking brake switch is pressed B position, the solenoid valve is deenergized and the
valve open the drain port.
At the same time, the hydraulic oil in the parking brake return to the tank through the solenoid
valve. When the piston rod is returned by the force of the spring, the parking brake is applied.
4-7
3. BRAKE PUMP
1) STRUCTURE
2 4-12 4-11 4-13 4-8
2) OPERATION
The pumping operation of this unit(each cartridge) is obtained by providing a fixed interior cam
surface and a rotating inner member(rotor) containing vanes which held in contact with the inner
cam surface. As the rotor is rotated by the drive shaft, the vanes are urged outward against the
outward sloping cam surface, forming a cavity at the inlet ports of the port plates. Atmospheric
pressure and suction created by the expanding cavity between the rotating vanes fill the inlet cavity
with fluid.
As the rotation continues and the vanes that had previously moved outward and now have fluid
trapped between them and the port plates, follow the inward slope of the cam which decreases the
cavity containing the trapped fluid and discharges the fluid at system pressure through the
pressure port openings in the port plates.
The rotating portion of the unitized cartridges feature the use of pressure actuated vanes which are
urged against the cam ring by pins located in the bottom of each rotor vane slot. Initial force to
bring the vanes in contact with the cam ring contour during start up is provided by centrifugal force.
When pumping operation starts and pressure is established, fluid under pressure fills the pin cavity
through the feed holes.
The feed holes open to the pressure port twice every revolution. All other times they are closed off
by the port plate. This pressure under the pin provides the force necessary to keep the vanes in
contact with the cam countour.
3) DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY : SEE page 6-56.
4-8
4. BRAKE VALVE
1) STRUCTURE
17-2
18
17-3,17-4
17-1,17
19
23 22
24
21
2
33
20 8,31,32
9
25 29
25
16 14
15 7
5 13
30
12 6
10
26
11
3
1 4
7607B4BS07
4-9
2) OPERATION
T1 P1 T2 P2
Hydraulic circuit
P2
BR2
7607B4BS08
4-10
(1) Purpose
The purpose of the brake valve is to sensitively increase and decrease the braking pressure
when the brake pedal is actuated.
(2)
2) Ready position
When the braking system is ready for operation, its accumulator pressure acts directly on ports
(P1, P2) of the brake valve. A connection is established between ports (BR1, BR2) and ports (T1,
T2) so that the wheel brakes ports (BR1, BR2) are pressureless via the returns ports (T1, T2).
(3) Partial braking
(3
When the brake valve is actuated, an amount of hydraulic pressure is output as a ratio of the foot
force applied.
The spring assembly (8) beneath pedal plate (16) is designed in such a way that the braking
pressure changes depending on the angle. In the lower braking pressure range, the machine can
be slowed sensitively.
When the braking process is commenced, the upper spool is mechanically actuated via spring
assembly (8), and the lower spool is actuated hydraulically by spool. As spools (3) move
downward, they will first close returns (T1, T2) via the control edges, thus establishing a
connection between accumulator ports (P1, P2) and ports (BR1, BR2) for the wheel brake
cylinders. The foot force applied now determines the output braking pressure. The control spools
(3) are held in the control position by the force applied (spring assembly above the spools and the
hydraulic pressure below the spool (balance of forces).
After output of the braking pressure, spools (3) are in a partial braking position, causing ports (P1,
P2) and ports (T1, T2) to close and holding the pressure in ports (BR1, BR2).
(4) Full braking position
(4
When pedal is fully actuated, end position of the brakes is reached and a connection established
between accumulator ports (P1, P2) and brake cylinder ports (BR1, BR2). Returns (T1, T2) are
closed at this point.
When the braking process is ended, a connection is once again established between brake
cylinder ports (BR1, BR2) and return ports (T1, T2), closing accumulator ports (P1, P2).
The arrangement of spools in the valve ensures that even if one braking circuit fails the other
remains fully operational. This is achieved by means of the mechanical actuation of both spools
and requires slightly more pedal travel.
(5) Limiting the braking pressure
Pedal restriction bolt (23) on pedal plate (16) is used to limit the braking pressure.
(6) Failure of a circuit
In the event of the lower circuit failing, the upper circuit will remain operational. Spring assembly
(8) will mechanically actuate spool. In the event of the upper circuit failing, the lower circuit will
remain operational since the lower spool (3) is mechanically actuated by spring assembly (8) and
spool (3).
(7) Installation requirements
Return lines (T1, T2) must be connected directly to the tank.
The connecting lines must be installed is such a way as to permit proper bleeding.
4-11
(8) Maintenance of the brake valve
No special maintenance beyond the legal requirements is necessary.
When using high-pressure cleaners on the machine, please make sure that the water jet is not
aimed directly at the brake valve (to prevent damaging the bellows).
For safety reasons the whole of the brake valve must be replaced if parts other than those
listed above are damaged.
(9) Repair work
(9
When working on the braking system, always make sure that there is absolutely no pressure
in the system. Even when the engine is switched off there will be some residual pressure in
the system.
※ When doing repair work, make sure your environment is very clean.
Immediately close all open ports on the components and on pipes using plugs.
(10) Replacing the complete actuating mechanism
Carefully clamp the unit vertically in a fixture. The actuating mechanism can be removed by taking
out the three bolts. Make sure that spring assembly (8) does not fall out. When installing the new
actuating mechanism, make sure that spring assembly (8) is fitted in the right order. Tighten the
four bolts (25).
(11) Replacing the pedal cover
Pedal cover (18) is simply pulled of by hand. The new pedal cover is pushed over pedal (17) and
tightened manually. Fasten the bellows with the strap retainers.
(12) Replacing the bellows
To change bellows (19) it is advisable to remove pedal (17). For this purpose, loosen snap ring
(22) and knock out pin (20) using a mandrill. When knocking out the bolt, make sure that the
mandrill is applied to the side of the bolt without a knurl. Remove pedal (17) and bellows (19).
Now fit the new bellows and proceed in reverse order as described above. The upper portion of
bellows is fastened to piston, its lower portion to pedal plate (16) secure the bellows using clamps.
4-12
5. CUT-OFF VALVE
1) STRUCTURE
3 C B
1
7
D D
2
P PS1
A A
C B
SECTION A - A SECTION B - B
B1 A1 B2 A2
6
A1 A2
A3
PS
T1
PS T1
B
B1 B2
4 PS1
A3
B
P T
2) OPERATION
When the pump works, the oil under the pressure flows into P port.
The oil in P port is stored in the accumulator on A3 port.
As the pressure on P line rises to 150bar, the cut off valve (6) starts cut-offing and the oil in the P
port is unloaded. The pressure on P line goes down 120 bar by the minute leakage from valve and
other factors.
At this pressure, the cut-off valve starts cut-ining.
This process is repeated in the regular period of 30~40 seconds.
4-13
6. BRAKE ACCUMULATOR
1) STRUCTURE
81L1-0003 81L1-0004
Item
(A1, A2 port) (A3 port)
Diameter 136 mm 121 mm
Mounting height 160 mm 146 mm
Norminal volume 1.0ℓ 0.75ℓ
Priming pressure 50 kgf/cm2 50 kgf/cm2
B Operating medium Oil Oil
Operating pressure Max 200 kgf/cm2 Max 210 kgf/cm2
A Thread M18×1.5 M22×1.5
Priming gas Nitrogen Nitrogen
C
A Fluid portion C Diaphragm
B Gas portion D Valve disk
D
75794BS09
2) OPERATION
(1) Purpose
Fluids are practically incompressible and are thus incapable of accumulating pressure energy. In
hydropneumatic accumulators, the compressibility of a gas is utilized to accumulate fluid. The
compressible medium used in the accumulators is nitrogen.
In braking systems, the purpose of the accumulators is to store the energy supplied by the
hydraulic pump. They are also used as an energy reserve when the pump is not working, as a
compensator for any losses through leakage, and as oscillation dampers.
(2) Operation
(2
The accumulator consists of a fluid portion (A) and a gas portion (B) with a diaphragm (C) as a
gas-tight dividing element. The fluid portion (A) is connected to the hydraulic circuit, causing the
diaphragm accumulator to be filled and the gas volume to be compressed as the pressure rises.
When the pressure falls, the compressed gas volume will expand, thus displacing the
accumulated pressure fluid into the circuit.
The diaphragm bottom contains a valve disk (D) which, if the diaphragm accumulator is
completely empty, closes the hydraulic outlet, thus preventing damage to the diaphragm.
3) Installation requirements
(3)
The accumulators can be fitted in the hydraulic circuit, directly on a component or in blocks on
suitable consoles.
They should be fitted in as cool a location as possible.
Installation can be in any position.
4-14
(4) Maintenance of the accumulator
No special maintenance beyond the legal requirements is necessary.
The accumulator should be checked annually. It should be replaced if the initial gas pressure has
fallen by more than 30% (please refer to Performance testing and checking of the accumulator).
(5) Disposal of the accumulator
Before the accumulator is scrapped, its gas filling pressure must be reduced. For this purpose,
drill a hole through gas chamber (B) using a drill approx. 3mm in diameter. The gas chamber is
located on the side opposite the threaded port above the welding seam around the center of the
accumulator.
※ Wear safety goggles when doing this job.
(6) Performance testing and checking of the accumulator
The accumulator is gradually pressurized via the test pump; until the initial gas pressure is
reached, the hydraulic pressure in the accumulator will rise abruptly. This is apparent from gauge
M. If the initial gas pressure is more than 30% below the prescribed value, the accumulator needs
to be replaced. If the measuring process needs to be repeated, wait for intervals of 3 minutes
between the individual tests. Any accumulator whose initial gas pressure is insufficient must be
scrapped following the instructions under Disposal of the accumulator
accumulator.
The amount of initial gas pressure can also be checked from the vehicle. Start the vehicle's
engine. The pump will now supply oil to the accumulators. Until the initial gas pressure is
reached, the hydraulic pressure in the accumulator will rise abruptly. This is apparent from the
gauge in the cab. If the initial gas pressure is more than 30% below the prescribed value, that
initial pressure lies outside the permissible range for at least one of the accumulators fitted in the
vehicle. This accumulator can be traced only by using the method described above, i.e. all
accumulators have to be individually tested. The accumulator whose initial gas pressure is
insufficient must be replaced and scrapped following the instruction under Disposal of the
accumulator.
accumulator
Accumulator
Pressure gauge(M)
4-15
7. PRESSURE SENSORS
1) STRUCTURE
Connector
Connector
H1
H1
H2 H2
G G
PARKING, CHARGING BRAKE STOP & CLUTCH CUT OFF
7579S4BS15
2) TECHNICAL DATA
H1 H2 Adjusting range Actuating pressure Voltage
Item Medium G
mm mm kgf/cm2 kgf/cm2 V
Parking pressure
Oil PF 1/4" 46.5 11 0 ~ 200 100 ± 5 Max 30
sensor
Charging pressure
Oil PF 1/4" 46.5 11 0 ~ 200 100 ± 5 Max 30
sensor
Brake stop & clutch cut
Oil PF 1/4" 46.5 11 1 ~ 100 5±1 Max 30
off pressure sensor
4-16
3) OPERATION
(1) Purpose
The pressure switches are used to visually or audibly warn the driver of the pressure within the
system.
(2) Make contact / circuit closer
The pressure switch can be fitted in the braking system or directly on one of its components.
The system pressure acts on an absorption area within the switch, making an electrical contact
as the pressure on that area is increased. The resulting current is used to activate a warning
facility, for instance.
(3) Break contact / circuit breaker
The pressure switch can be fitted in the braking system or directly on one of its components.
The system pressure acts on a absorption area within the switch, breaking an electrical contact
as the pressure on that area is increased. The current is now broken, e.g. to deactivate a warning
facility.
(4) Installation requirements
No special measures need to be taken.
(5) Maintenance of the pressure switch
No special maintenance beyond the legal requirements is necessary.
When using high-pressure cleaners on the vehicle, please make sure that the water jet is not
directed at the pressure switch (corrosion of contacts).
(6) Repair work
When working on the braking system, always make sure that there is absolutely no
pressure in the system. Even when the engine is switched off there will be some residual
pressure in the system.
※ When doing repair work, make sure your environment is very clean.
Immediately close all open ports on the components and on pipes using plugs.
※ For safety reasons the pressure switch needs to be replaced as a whole if damaged.
4-17
8. PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
1) STRUCTURE
2
9
4
8
7
3
6
78094BS21
2) OPERATION
The two identical brake pads and slide freely on the guide bolt, which is fastened in the housing.
The guide bolts are guided in an additional brake anchor plate which in turn is screwed onto the
vehicle, i.e. its axle.
On actuation, the brake generates a clamping force at the brake lining pads, which cause a
tangential force/braking moment to be generated at the brake disk, the extent of which depends on
the coefficients of friction generated by the linings.
The clamping force is generated by the bank of cup springs, during which the piston is moved
together with the adjusting screw, the thrust bolt and the brake pad towards the brake disk.
When the brake pad comes into contact with the brake disk, the reaction force shifts the housing
onto the guide bolts until the brake pad is also pressed against the brake disk.
The brake is released by complete pre-tensioning of the bank of cup springs. During this process,
through application of the necessary release pressure after overcoming the cup spring force, the
piston must move back until it comes to rest against the pressure ring.
The clamping force diminishes with wear of the brake lining and brake disk. The brake must be
adjusted at the latest at the times indicated by the adjusting specification followings.
4-18
3) MOUNTING AND BASIC SETTING REGULATIONS
Basic brake setting is required after mounting new brake lining plates or brake disks, as well as
during all repair stages and in the event of insufficient braking performance.
6
2
1
3
4
P
5
S
100D7BS112
※ All mounting and basic setting work must be carried out on the brake when cold.
4-19
(2) Basic setting regulation
① Turn the adjusting screw manually clockwise until both brake pads make contact with the brake
disk. Then it is not longer possible to turn the adjusting screw without exerting a major amount
of force.
② Turn the adjusting screw anticlockwise in order to set the following rated clearances.
③ Hold the adjusting screw in position with a hexagonal socket wrench and lock with lock nut.
④ Mount the screw cap and tighten as far as possible manually.
⑤
Mount the pressure connection in accordance with the instructions of the axle.
※ For bleeding the piston chamber use the socket spanner size 13 for the bleeding valve.
4-20
4) EMERGENCY RELEASE OF THE PARKING BRAKE
After the failure of the pressure release the parking brake by using following manual procedure.
2
1
P
S 4
5 3
100D7BS117
4-21
5) MAINTENANCE AND REPAIR WORK
(1) Maintenance and exchange of brake pads
The brake pads themselves are maintenance free. All that is required here is a check for
damaged parts, as well as inspection to ensure that the brake disk remains easy running.
The thickness of the brake lining must be subjected to a visual inspection at regular intervals,
which depend on vehicle usage, but every six months at the latest. In the event of a minimal
residual lining thickness, these intervals must be reduced accordingly in order to avoid major
damage to the brake or disk.
Min. residual thickness 2.0 mm per lining pad (8 mm carrier plate thickness).
1
2
S1 2
4
P
3
S
100D7BS113
※ Only original spare lining plates may be used. If any other spare parts are used, no warranty
claims will be accepted either for the brakes or their functional characteristics.
① Stand the vehicle on an even surface and secure against rolling away.
② Release the parking brake by applying the required release pressure.
③ Release the screw cap and unscrew.
④ Release the lock nut (size 24 or 30) and turn the adjusting screw with socket wrench size 8 or 10
manually clockwise until it lies flush with the inside of the piston.
⑤ Press back the thrust bolt using a suitable screwdriver until it has contact with the piston.
4-22
6b
6a
1
4
5
3 2
100D7BS114
⑥ Depending on the free space available, release one of the two guide bolts, removing the safety
splint, unscrewing the castellated nut and pulling the guide bolt out of the brake anchor plate.
Now, the brake lining pads can be removed tangentially to the brake disk.
※ In the event of minimal clearance, i.e. it is not possible for space reasons to exchange the brake
lining plate in accordance with these instructions, the brake must be removed completely. To do
this, pull both guide bolts out of the brake anchor plate.
Check the pressure hose. If the pressure hose is to short, it must be unscrewed to remove
the brake. Before the pressure hose can be released the brake must be emergency
released.
⑦ Exchange the brake pads and insert the guide bolts into the brake anchor plate. If you have
removed the complete brake you have to amount the brake on both guide bolt again, now.
⑧ Check both permanent magnets if they still have sufficient magnetic force to hold the brake lining
plates. Should this not be the case, the permanent magnets must also be changed by using a
suitable screw driver.
⑨ Secure the guide bolt with the castellated nut and the safety splint respective safety clip.
After mounting new brake lining plates or their repair, the brake must be correctly set in
accordance with the instructions "Adjusting regulations".
4-23
(2) Changing the seal
A
B
3
1 2
8
9 4
7
6
5
DETAIL A DETAIL B
100D7BS115
4-24
⑨ Change all seals and mount the parts of the brake in other way round order. By mounting the
piston, the sliding and sealing surfaces must be greased lightly using lubricating grease to DIN
51825. The dust protection cap is fitted with a vulcanized-in steel ring which is used to press it
through the locating hole. For exchanging, "lever out" the ring using a suitable tool. The new
dust protection cap must be pressed in with the aid of a suitable mounting ring and screw
clamps or a lever press.
(2) General
Any discovered defects or damage to parts not listed here must naturally be repaired or replaced
using original parts.
For any other information not contained in these instructions or for more detailed instructions,
please contact Hyundai dealer.
4-25
GROUP 2 OPERATIONAL CHECKS AND TROUBLESHOOTING
1. OPERATIONAL CHECKS
This procedure is designed so the mechanic can make a quick check of the system using a minimum
amount of diagnostic equipment. If you need additional information, read structure and function
function,
Group 1.
A location will be required which is level and has adequate space to complete the checks.
The engine and all other major components must be at operating temperature for some checks.
Locate system check in the left column and read completely, following the sequence from left to right.
Read each check completely before performing.
At the end of each check, if no problem is found (OK), that check is complete or an additional check is
needed. If problem is indicated (NOT OK), you will be given repair required and group location.
If verification is needed, you will be given next best source of information:
Chapter 2 : Troubleshooting
Group 3 : Tests and adjustments
4-26
※Hydraulic oil must be at operating temperature for these checks (refer to page 6-45).
engaged at 8 km/hr.
Transmission must shift to neutral.
Parking brake Turn parking brake to ON. OK
transmission lockout Check completed.
Place transmission in 1st forward.
check
P
NOT OK
Engine running. Slowly increase engine speed to
Go to transmission control
high idle.
circuit in section 3.
LOOK : Machine must not move.
4-27
Item Description Service action
Service brake pump flow Stop engine. OK
check Check completed.
Operate brake pedal approximately
※ Hydraulic oil must be at
20 times. NOT OK
operating temperature
Start engine and run at low idle. Check for brake circuit
for the check.
leakage.
Engine OFF. Record number of seconds
required for low brake pressure Go to next page.
indicator lamp to go out.
IF OK
LOOK : Indicator lamp must go out I n s t a l l a c a p o n l i n e
in less than 4 seconds from time connected to inlet of brake
engine starts. valve and repeat pump
flow check.
NOTE : Indicator will not come on
approximately 1 second after If time does not decrease,
starting engine. check for wor n brake
pump.
Service brake capacity Turn clutch cut-off mode switch OK
check OFF. Check completed.
OFF
Engine running.
Apply service brakes, release park NOT OK
L
M H
brake and put transmission in 2nd Check brake pressure.
forward.
IF OK
Increase engine speed to high idle. Inspect brake disk.
LOOK : Machine may not move or
P
4-28
Item Description Service action
Brake accumulator S t a r t a n d r u n e n g i n e fo r 3 0 OK
precharge check seconds. Check completed.
※The axles and hydraulic
Stop engine and turn start switch to NOT OK
oil must be at operating
ON and wait 5 seconds. Make sure brake pedal is
temperature for this
not binding and keeping
check. NOTE : Engine oil pressure lamp
brakes partially engaged.
will be on due to no engine oil
pressure. Bleed brakes in group 3.
Count the number of times the C h e c k b r a k e s y s t e m
brake pedal can be fully depressed pressure.
before the low brake pressure
NOT OK
warning lamp comes ON.
If light comes ON with
LOOK : Warning lamp must come e n g i n e r u n n i n g ,
ON in 1~5 applications. accumulator has lost it's
charge. Inspect and
Start engine and operate at low
recharge accumulator.
idle.
Observe cluster while applying
brake pedal with maximum force.
LOOK/LISTEN : Brake pressure
indicator must not come ON.
Brake system leakage Start engine and wait 30 seconds. OK
check Check completed.
Stop engine.
NOT OK
Wait 2 minutes.
If brake leakage is
Turn start switch to ON and wait 5 indicated with brakes
seconds. released, check leakage at
accumulator inlet check
LOOK : Brake oil pressure warning
valve and brake valve. If
lamp must not come ON within 2
brake leakage is indicated
minutes after stopping engine.
with brakes applied, check
for leakage at brake valve
and brake pistons.
Check individual
component leakage.
4-29
Item Description Service action
S e r v i c e b ra ke p e d a l Slowly depress brake pedal. OK
check Check completed.
Listen for a hissing noise that
indicates oil is flowing to brake NOT OK
pistons. Inspect for debris under
brake pedal.
LISTEN/FEEL : A hissing noise
must be heard when pedal is
depressed.
Service and parking Position machine on gradual slope. OK
brake system drag Check completed.
Lower bucket approximately 50 mm
checks
(2 in) from ground.
Engine running NOT OK
Release parking and ser vice Adjust park brake.
brakes.
NOT OK
LOOK : Machine must move or
Check floor mat interfer-
coast.
P
M H
4-30
2. TROUBLESHOOTING
1) SERVICE BRAKE
Diagnose malfunction charts are arranged from most probable and simplest to verify, to least likely,
more difficult to verify. Remember the following steps when troubleshooting a problem :
Step 1. Operational check out procedure (see section 1)
Step 2. Operational checks (in this group)
Step 3. Troubleshooting
Step 4. Tests and adjustments (see group 3)
4-31
Problem Cause Remedy
Brakes chatter Air in brake system. Do brake bleed procedure.
Worn brake surface material. Inspect brake surface material.
Wrong oil in differential. Drain.Refill.
H i s s i n g n o i s e w h e n Leakage in brake valve, or brake Do brake system leakage test.
brake pedal is held with piston.
engine stopped
Brake pressure warning M a l f u n c t i o n i n b r a k e l o w Replace switch.
light will not go out or pressure warning switch.
stays on excessively long
Brake accumulator pressure too Recharge accumulator.
after start-up
low.
L ow b r a ke p u m p s t a n d by Do brake pump standby pressure test.
pressure setting.
Leakage in pressure reducing Do pressure reducing valve manifold leakage
manifold block. test.
Leakage in brake system. Do brake system components leakage tests.
Worn brake pump. Do brake pump flow test.
Leakage in par king brake Do parking brake pressure test.
solenoid.
4-32
GROUP 3 TESTS AND ADJUSTMENTS
2) MEASURING PROCEDURE
(1) Start the engine and drive the machine
straight up a 1/5 gradient with the bucket
unloaded.
(2) Depress the service brake, place the gear
selector lever in neutral, then stop the
engine.
20%
(3) Turn the parking brake switch ON, then gradient
11 20'
slowly release the service brake pedal
and the machine must be kept stopped.
※ The measurement must be made with
the machine facing either up or down
78094BS18
the slope.
Adjust nut
75794BS22
4-33
3. HYDRAULIC BRAKE BLEEDING PROCEDURE
Escaping fluid under pressure can
penetrate the skin causing serious injury.
Avoid the hazard by relieving pressure
before disconnecting hydraulic or other
lines. Tighten all connections before
applying pressure.
Search for leaks with a piece of cardboard.
Protect hands and body from high Air breather
pressure fluids.
※ If an accident occurs, see a doctor
immediately. Any fluid injected into the skin
must be surgically removed within a few Breather vent
hours or gangrene may result.
Doctors unfamiliar with this type of injury
should reference a knowledgeable medical
source.
Two people are required to bleed brake
system oil, one to operate brake valve and
other to open and close bleed screws.
A
1) Install frame locking bar. Engage parking
brake.
2) Put a clear plastic tube on bleed screw to
route low to hydraulic oil tank filler tube or
container (A).
3) Start engine and run at low idle.
4) Push and hold brake pedal down until
brake bleeding procedure is complete.
※ If bubbles continue for more than 2 Front
frame
minutes, stop bleeding procedure.
Check for and correct problem, then
continue.
Lock bar
lock position
5) Open on bleed screw on differential and
axle assembly until hydraulic oil starts to
flow. Close bleed screw when oil is free of
air. Release brake pedal.
6) Repeat steps 1)~5) for each bleed screw.
7) Push either brake pedal and hold down.
78094BS19
8) Check hydraulic oil level.
4-34
SECTION 5 STEERING SYSTEM
1. OUTLINE
The steering system of this machine consists of a variable displacement piston pump supplying a load
sensing steering system and a closed center loader system.
This system offers faster response from the priority valve of flow amplifier and the pump. Also if offers
advantages in connection with cold start up and improvements in system stability.
The components of the steering system are :
·Steering pump
·Flow amplifier
·Steering unit
·Steering cylinders
The flow amplifier contain a directional valve, an amplification stage, a priority valve, a pilot pressure
relief valve and shock and suction valve.
The steering pump draws hydraulic oil from the hydraulic tank.
Outlet flow from the pump flows to the priority valve of flow amplifier. The priority valve of flow amplifier
preferentially supplies flow, on demand, to the steering unit. When the machine is steered, the steering
unit routes flow to the steering cylinders to articulate the machine.
When the machine is not being steered, or if pump flow is greater than steering flow, the priority valve
supplies flow to the loader system.
That is, output flow from the steering pump enters into the main control valve for the operation of the
attachment.
5-1
2. HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT
10
L.H R.H
6 CL CR
L R
T
PP
HP LS HT
L R
5
MCV
P T LS
RCV lever
Brake system Fan drive motor
2
Return line
34
PS
23
28 M1 Return line
A
P1
29 24 Return line
M2
PS
25 21
P2
26
27
M
7809S5SE01
5-2
1) NEUTRAL
10
L.H R.H
6 CL CR
L R
T
PP
D
HP LS HT
L R
5
G
MCV
P T LS
RCV lever
Brake system Fan drive motor
2
Return line
23
Return line
24 Return line
25 21
26
7809S5SE02
· The steering wheel is not being operated so control spool (G) does not move.
· The oil from the steering pump enters port HP of the priority valve of flow amplifier and the inlet pres-
sure oil moves the spool (D) to the right.
· Almost all of pump flow goes to the loader system (main control valve) through the EF port and partly
flows into the hydraulic tank (24) through the control spool (G).
This small flow is useful to prevent the thermal shock problem of the steering unit (5).
5-3
2) LEFT TURN
10
L.H R.H
6 CL CR
L R
J
M
Priority valve spool
EF
T
PP
D K
HP LS HT
L R
5
G
MCV
P T LS
RCV lever
Brake system Fan drive motor
2
Return line
23
Return line
24 Return line
25 21
26
7809S5SE03
· When the steering wheel is turned to the left, the spool (G) within steering unit (5) connected with
steering column shaft is pushed to the right direction.
· The oil discharged from the pump flows into HP port of flow amplifier (6).
· The delivered oil passes through the main orifice of steering unit (5), through the priority valve spool
(D) of flow amplifier (6). The position of priority spool (D) is determined when the pressure difference
between front and rear of main orifice is balanced with control spring (K) force.
· The oil supplied through the directional spool (J) from the steering unit (5) is combined with the direct
oil from the priority valve spool (D) in the amplifier spool (M). The amplified oil flows into the small
chamber of the left steering cylinder and large chamber of the right steering cylinder respectively.
· Oil returned from left and right cylinder returns to hydraulic tank through directional spool (J) of flow
amplifier (6).
· When the above operation is completed, the machine turns to the left.
5-4
3) RIGHT TURN
10
L.H R.H
6 CL CR
L R
J
M
Priority valve spool
EF
T
PP
D K
HP LS HT
L R
5
G
MCV
P T LS
RCV lever
Brake system Fan drive motor
2
Return line
23
Return line
24 Return line
25 21
26
7809S5SE04
· When the steering wheel is turned to the right, the spool (G) within steering unit (5) connected with
steering column shaft is pushed to the right direction.
· The oil discharged from the pump flows into HP port of flow amplifier (6).
· The delivered oil passes through the main orifice of steering unit (5), through the priority valve spool
(D) of flow amplifier (6). The position of priority spool (D) is determined when the pressure difference
between front and rear of main orifice is balanced with control spring (K) force.
· The oil supplied through the directional spool (J) from the steering unit (5) is combined with the direct
oil from the priority valve spool (D) in the amplifier spool (M). The amplified oil flows into the small
chamber of the right steering cylinder and large chamber of the left steering cylinder respectively.
· Oil returned from left and right cylinder returns to hydraulic tank through directional spool (J) of flow
amplifier (6).
· When the above operation is completed, the machine turns to the right.
5-5
3. STEERING PUMP (+FAN PUMP)
1) STRUCTURE (1/2)
35 36 37 39
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 19
33 34 32 31 30 29 28 25 24 27 26 23 22 21 20
7807AWE09
5-6
2) DESCRIPTION
The main vane pump consist of six basic components : end cap (2), P2 section unitlzed cartridge
(4) consisting of ; rotor, vanes, vane holdout pins, cam ring, port plate, and pressure plate, center,
housing (5), P1 section unitlzed cartridge (6) consisting of ; rotor, vanes, vane holdout pins, cam
ring, port plate, pressure plate, shaft (11) and bearing and mounting cap (14).
The main vane pump features the use of unitized pumping cartridge for both the P1 and P2 pump
section.
The unitized cartridge assemblies are pretested and provide for ease of disassembly and assem-
bly in the event it becomes necessary or desirable to make repairs, overhaul or revise the flow
delivery.
P1 section
P2 section
14
11
6
5
4
2
7707WE10
3) OPERATION
The pumping operation of this unit(each cartridge) is obtained by providing a fixed interior cam sur-
face and a rotating inner member(rotor) containing vanes which held in contact with the inner cam
surface. As the rotor is rotated by the drive shaft, the vanes are urged outward against the outward
sloping cam surface, forming a cavity at the inlet ports of the port plates. Atmospheric pressure
and suction created by the expanding cavity between the rotating vanes fill the inlet cavity with fluid.
As the rotation continues and the vanes that had previously moved outward and now have fluid
trapped between them and the port plates, follow the inward slope of the cam which decreases the
cavity containing the trapped fluid and discharges the fluid at system pressure through the pres-
sure port openings in the port plates.
The rotating portion of the unitized cartridges feature the use of pressure actuated vanes which are
urged against the cam ring by pins located in the bottom of each rotor vane slot. Initial force to
bring the vanes in contact with the cam ring contour during start up is provided by centrifugal force.
When pumping operation starts and pressure is established, fluid under pressure fills the pin cavity
through the feed holes.
The feed holes open to the pressure port twice every revolution. All other times they are closed off
by the port plate. This pressure under the pin provides the force necessary to keep the vanes in
contact with the cam contour.
※ When operating the pump at the maximum outlet pressure, the pump shaft rotation should not be
allowed to fall below 600rpm in order to maintain proper vane to cam ring contact. The inlet or suc-
tion flow for both the P1 cartridge and P2 cartridge feeds through a common 3 port in the center
housing, through the large ports of each port plate for each cartridge and through the center hole
in the suction zone of each cam ring.
5-7
4. FLOW AMPLIFIER
1) STRUCTURE
21 7 38 4 9C 21
16
T
HT
2 2
24
28
CR CL
34 34
23
L HP R
1 P 29
9A 1
27 13,14
1 1
8 41
40 35
10
11,12
37
22
P
9B HP EF 30
LS
15 PP 16
2
2
31
42 6 19 20 5 36
(770-7) 5-6
5-8
2) OPERATION
(1) Introduction
The flow amplifier contain a directional valve, an amplification stage, a priority valve, a pilot pres-
sure relief valve and shock and suction valves.
The flow amplifier amplifies the oil flow from the steering unit cylinder ports L or R by an amplifi-
cation factor of 8. The amplified oil flow is directed from the flow amplifier ports CL or CR to the
steering cylinder. The amplified flow is proportional to the rate of the steering wheel rotation. If
the oil flow from the pump fails, the flow amplifier cuts off the amplification.
(2) Priority valve
(2
The priority valve is used in load sensing systems where the same pump supplies oil to both
steering system and working hydraulics.
The steering system always has first priority.
The pressure on the LS connection is almost zero during measuring (steering unit in neutral posi-
tion).
(3) Shock valves
(3
The shock valves protect the flow amplifier against shock from external forces on the steering cyl-
inders. The shock valves in flow amplifier limit the maximum pressure drop from CL to HT and
from CR to HT.
(4) HP-HT ports characteristic
(4
The pilot pressure relief valve protects the steering unit against excess pressure. The pilot pres-
sure relief valve together with the priority valve limit the maximum steering pressure HP-HT.
5-9
(5) Neutral
9C
T
HT
CR CL
L HP R
P
HP EF LS
PP
42 9B 30
CL CR
L R
L R 9C
Steering unit
P
LS
9A
EF TO MCV
42 T
P T PP
9B 30
HP LS HT
7707A5SE100
5-10
In neutral position, the oil passes from the pump across the integrated priority valve (9B) in the flow
amplifier for discharge through the EF port. With the steering unit in neutral, flow through it is blocked
and all flow through the priority valve (9B) in flow amplifier is directed out the EF port to the loader
control valve.
With the engine off, the priority valve spool (9B) is pushed to the left by the spring (30). The passage
to the EF port is blocked while the passage to the P port is open.
When the machine is first started, all pump flow is routed to the steering unit which blocks the flow.
With the flow blocked, the pressure increases.
Steering inlet pressure is supplied through the dynamic orifice (42) in the spool. This causes the priori-
ty valve spool (9B) to shift to the right against the spring (30) and open the EF port.
As long as the steering unit is in neutral, just enough pressure is maintained at the steering unit to
keep the priority valve spool (9B) shifted to the right.
The operating pressure in the loader system has no effect on the operation of the priority valve (9B) of
flow amplifier. With the loader actuated in relief, the priority valve (9B) will not shift until the machine
is steered.
Flow through the priority valve spool (9B) passes from the P port through the orifice (42) and into the
LS port. It flows through the steering unit LS passage which is routed to return when the steering unit
is in neutral. This provides a warm-up circuit for the steering unit to prevent binding of the steering
unit due to oil temperature extremes.
In neutral position, also the directional valve (9C) is in its center position.
This means that knock and impacts from the cylinder are not transmitted to the steering unit. The flow
amplifier is thus of the non-reaction type.
5-11
(6) Mid-turn
9C
T
HT
CR CL
L HP R
P
S
C
N
A
M
HP EF LS
PP
9B 9A
CL CR
L R
L R 9C
Steering unit
P
LS
9A
EF
T
P T PP
9B
HP LS HT
7707A5SE101
5-12
If the steering wheel is turned to the left, a LS signal is passed to the priority valve (9B). The priority
valve (9B) is reversed so that more oil is passed across the P port to the steering unit for discharge
through the L port of the flow amplifier.
The directional valve (9C) is reversed through the pressure being transmitted across the boring in the
spool whereby the spool is moved the right.
The opening shall allow connection between the pilot flow and the pressure control/amplifier valve
(9A).
The pilot pressure from the orifice in chamber C moves the valve to the left and passage for the pilot
flow therefore is possible out of hole F.
The main flow passes from the priority valve (9B) to the circular channel M. As the amplifier spool is
moved to the left, the passage will now be open across the holes N to the chamber S.
The spool goes to a position so that the pressure in chamber S equals the pressure in chamber C.
The passage is now open for the main flow through the priority valve (9B) across the holes A.
The main flow and pilot flow merge and is passed across the directional valve (9C) to the steering cyl-
inder through CL port.
The return oil passes across the directional valve (9C) to the hydraulic tank.
5-13
(7) Full turm
T
HT
CR CL
L HP R
P
HP EF LS
PP
9B T 30
CL CR
L R
L R 9C
Steering unit
P
LS
EF
TO MCV
T
P T PP
D
HP LS HT
7707A5SE102
5-14
When the machine is steered to a full turn, the frames bottom against the steering stops. To limit
steering system pressure, a relief system is built into the priority valve assembly (9B).
When the frames bottom is stopped, the pressure in the steering cylinders increases. This pressure
is sensed at the LS port. When the pressure in the LS port increases enough to push priority valve
spool (9B) off its seat, oil in the load sensing circuit flows to return through the T port. Load sensing
pressure is limited to the pressure setting of the relief valve.
Pressure to the steering unit (pilot pressure), which is sensed at the left end of the priority valve spool
(9B) in flow amplifier, continues to increase until it can move the spool to the right against the load
sensing pressure plus spring (30) force. At this time, all oil flows out of the EF port to the loader con-
trol valve.
If the loader attachment is being operated while steering, the loader function will slow until the
machine reaches the steering stops. At that time, the loader cycle speed will increase until the
machine is steered again.
5-15
5. STEERING UNIT
1) STRUCTURE
1 7
2 8
3 9
4 10
A A
5
11
6
12
SECTION A - A
7607SE17
2) OPERATION
The steering unit consists of a rotary valve and a rotary meter.
Via a steering column the steering unit is connected to the steering wheel of the machine.
When the steering wheel is turned, oil is directed from the steering system pump via the rotary
valve (spool and sleeve) and rotary meter (gear wheel set) to the cylinder ports L or R, depending
on the direction of turn. The rotary meter meters the oil flow to the steering cylinder in proportion to
the angular rotation of the steering wheel.
Spool (9) is connected directly to the drive shaft of steering wheel. It is connected to sleeve (7) by
cross pin (3) (not in contact with the spool when the steering wheel is at neutral) and neutral posi-
tion spring (2).
Cardan shaft(8) is meshed at the top with cross pin (3) and forms one unit with sleeve (7).
At the same time, it is meshed with gear rim (5) of the gerotor set by spline.
There are four ports in valve body. They are connected to the pump circuit, tank circuit, and the
head, and left and right steering cylinder. In addition, the pump port and tank port are connected
inside the body by the check valve. Therefore, if there is any failure in the pump of engine, oil can
be sucked in directly from the tank through the check valve.
5-16
6. STEERING CYLINDER
1) STRUCTURE
21
28,27 23 20
7809S5SE05
2) OPERATION
This machine use to cross connected cylinder for steering operation.
The steering cylinder use a gland (3) to remove piston and sealed seals. Dust wiper (8) located on
the in side of the rod cover protects cylinder inner parts from dust. The piston (13) is fastened to the
rod (2).
The piston uses a single wear ring (17) with a piston seal (16) to seal between the piston and tube.
The gland seals against the tube with two O-rings. The rod is sealed against the gland with a rod
seal (5).
5-17
GROUP 2 OPERATIONAL CHECKS AND TROUBLESHOOTING
1. OPERATIONAL CHECKS
This procedure is designed so the service man can make a quick check of the steering system using
a minimum amount of diagnostic equipment. If you need additional information, prefer to structure
and function in group 1.
A location will be required which is level and has adequate space to complete the checks.
The engine and all other major components must be at operating temperature for some checks.
Locate system check in the left column and read completely, following this sequence from left to right.
Read each check completely before performing.
At the end of each check, if no problem is found (OK), that check is complete or an additional check
is needed. If problem is indicated (NOT OK), you will be give repair required and group location. If
verification is needed, you will be give next best source of information :
·Chapter 2 : Troubleshooting
·Group 3 : Tests and adjustments
5-18
※Hydraulic oil must be at operating temperature for these checks (refer to page 6-45).
Item Description Service action
Steering unit check Run engine at low idle. OK
Check completed.
A
Turn steering wheel until frames are
at maximum right (A) and then left NOT OK
B
(B) positions. Go to next check.
L O O K : Fra m e s mu s t m ove
smoothly in both directions.
When steering wheel is stopped,
frames must stop.
FEEL : Excessive effort must not be
required to turn steering wheel.
NOTE : It is normal for steering to
drift from stops when steering
wheel is released.
Steering system leakage Turn steering wheel rapidly until OK
check frames are against stop. Check completed.
Heat hydraulic oil to Left Right
Hold approximately 2 kg on steer- NOT OK
operating temperature.
ing wheel. Do steering system leakage
Run engine at high idle.
test in group 3 to isolate the
Count steering wheel revolutions
leakage.
for 1 minute.
Repeat test in opposite direction.
LOOK : Steering wheel should
rotate less than 7 rpm.
NOTE : Use good judgment;
Excessive steering wheel rpm does
not mean steering will be affected.
Priority valve (in flow Park machine on a hard surface. OK
amplifier) low pressure Check completed.
Hold brake pedal down.
check
NOT OK
Run engine at high idle.
Do flow amplifier pressure
Steer machine to the right and left test in group 3.
as far as possible.
LOOK : Machine must turn at least
half way to the right and left stops.
Priority valve (in flow Steer to steering stop and release OK
amplifier) high pressure steering wheel. Check completed.
check
Roll bucket back and hold over NOT OK
relief and observe engine rpm. Priority pressure is set too
Run engine at high idle.
high. Do flow amplifier pres-
Turn steering wheel to steering
sure test in group 3.
stop and hold, observe engine rpm.
LOOK : Steering stall engine rpm
must be higher than hydraulic stall
rpm.
5-19
2. TROUBLESHOOTING
※ Diagnose malfunction charts are arranged from most probable and simplest to verify, to least
likely, more difficult to verify. Remember the following steps when troubleshooting a problem :
Step 1. Operational check out procedure (see group 3 in section 1)
Step 2. Operational checks (in this group)
Step 3. Troubleshooting
Step 4. Tests and adjustments (see group 3)
5-20
Problem Cause Remedy
Slow or hard steering Too much friction in the mechanical parts of Lubricate bearings and joints of steering
the machine. column or repair if necessary.
Check steering column installation.
Cold oil. Warm the hydraulic oil.
Low priority valve pressure setting. Do priority valve pressure test.
Clean or replace cartridge in flow amplifier.
Worn hydraulic pump. Do hydraulic pump performance check .
Sticking priority valve spool. Remove and inspect.
Broken priority valve spring. Remove and inspect.
C o n s t a n t s t e e r i n g t o Air in system. Check for foamy oil.
maintain straight travel
Leakage in steering system. Do steering system leakage check.
Worn steering unit. Do steering system leakage check.
Do steering unit neutral leakage test in
group 3.
Leaf spring without spring force or broken. Replace leaf springs.
Spring in double shock valve broken. Replace shock valve.
Gear wheel set worn. Replace gear wheel set.
Cylinder seized or piston seals worn. Replace defects parts.
S l o w s t e e r i n g w h e e l Leakage in steering unit gerotor. Do steering system leakage check.
movement will not cause
Worn steering unit gerotor. Do steering leakage check.
any frame movement
Steering wheel can be Leakage in steering system. Do steering system leakage check.
turned with frames
against steering stop
Steering wheel turns with Broken steering column or splined cou- Remove and inspect.
n o r e s i s t a n c e a n d pling.
causes no frame move-
Lack of oil in steering unit. Start engine and check steering operation.
ment
Leakage in steering system. Do steering system leakage test in group 3.
5-21
Problem Cause Remedy
Erratic steering Air in oil. Check for foamy oil.
Low oil level. Add recommended oil.
Sticking priority valve spool. Remove and inspect spool.
Loose cylinder piston. Remove rod to inspect piston.
Damaged steering unit. Remove and inspect.
Spongy or soft steering Air in oil. Check for foamy oil.
Low oil level. Add recommended oil.
Free play at steer ing Loose steering wheel nut. Tighten.
wheel
Worn or damaged splines on steering col- Inspect.
umn or unit.
Steering unit binding or Binding in steering column or misalignment Inspect.
steering wheel does not of column.
immediately retur n to
High return pressure. Check for a pinched or damaged return
neutral when released
line.
Contamination in steering unit. Inspect hydraulic filter for contamination.
Repair cause of contamination. Flush
hydraulic system.
Large particles of contamination in steering Inspect hydraulic filter for contamination.
unit. Repair cause of contamination. Flush
hydraulic system.
Steering unit locks up ★ Thermal shock Do priority valve LS port flow test in group
5. This oil flow provides a warm -up flow to
steering unit when not using the steering.
Worn or damaged steering unit. Repair or replace steering unit.
Abrupt steering wheel Improperly timed gerotor gear in steering Time gerotor gear.
oscillation unit.
Steering wheel turns by Lines connected to wrong port. Reconnect lines.
itself
Vibration in steering sys- High priority valve setting. Do priority valve pressure test.
tem or hoses jump
Neutral position of steer- Steering column and steering unit out of Align the steering column with steering unit.
ing wheel cannot be line.
obtained, i.e. there is a
Too little or no play between steering col- Adjust the play and, if necessary, shorten
tendency towards
umn and steering unit input shaft. the splines journal.
"motoring"
Pinching between inner and outer spools. Contact the nearest service shop.
★ Thermal shock is caused by a large temperature differential(Approx. 30˚C, 50˚F) between the steering
valve and hydraulic oil. If the steering is not operated for a long period of time and the orifice in the bottom
of the priority valve spool is plugged, the steering valve may bind up when the steering is operated if the
hydraulic oil is hot enough.
5-22
Problem Cause Remedy
"Motoring" effect. Leaf springs are stuck or broken and have Replace leaf springs.
The steering wheel can therefore reduced spring force.
turn on its own.
Inner and outer spools pinch, possibly due Clean steering unit or contact the nearest
to dirt. service shop.
Return pressure in connection with the Reduce return pressure.
reaction between differential cylinder and
steering unit too high.
Oil is needed in the tank. Fill with clean oil and bleed the system.
Steering cylinder worn. Replace or repair cylinder.
Gear wheel set worn. Replace gear wheel set.
Spacer across cardan shaft forgotten. Install spacer.
5-23
Problem Cause Remedy
Backlash Cardan shaft fork worn or broken. Replace cardan shaft.
Leaf springs without spring force or broken. Replace leaf springs.
Worn splines on the steering column. Replace steering column.
"Shimmy" effect. The Air in the steering cylinder. Bleed cylinder.
steered wheels vibrate. Find and remove the reason for air collec-
(Rough tread on tires tion.
gives vibrations)
Mechanical connections or wheel bearings Replace worn parts.
worn.
High priority valve setting pressure. Set pressure as regular value.
Steering wheel can be One or both shock valves are leaky or are Clean or replace defective of missing
turned slowly in one or missing in steering valve. valves.
both directions without
the steered wheels turn-
ing.
Steering is too slow and Insufficient oil supply to steering unit, pump Replace pump or increase number of revo-
heavy when trying to turn defective or number of revolutions too low. lutions.
quickly.
Relief valve setting too low. Adjust valve to correct setting.
Relief valve sticking owing to dirt. Clean the valve.
Spool in priority valve sticking owing to dirt. Clean the valve, check that spool moves
easily without spring.
Too weak spring in priority valve. Replace spring by a stronger.
"Kick back" in steering Fault in the system. Contact authorized man or shop.
wheel from system. Kicks
from wheels.
5-24
Problem Cause Remedy
Heavy kick-back in steer- Wrong setting of cardan shaft and gear- Correct setting as shown in this manual.
ing wheel in both direc- wheel set.
tions.
urning the steering wheel Hydraulic hoses for the steering cylinders Connect lines to correct ports.
activates the steered have been switched around.
wheels opposite.
Hard point when starting Spring force in priority valve too weak. Replace spring by a stronger.
to turn the steering wheel
Oil is too thick (cold). Let motor run until oil is warm.
Too little steering force Pump pressure too low. Correct pump pressure.
(possibly to one side
Too little steering cylinder. Fit a larger cylinder.
only).
Piston rod area of the differential cylinder Fit cylinder with thinner piston rod or 2 dif-
too large compared with piston diameter. ferential cylinders.
Leakage at either input Shaft defective. Replace shaft seal.
shaft, end cover, gear-
Screws loose. Tighten screws.
wheel set, housing or top
part. Washers or O-rings defective. Replace.
5-25
GROUP 3 TESTS AND ADJUSTMENTS
5-26
5) Start the filter caddy. Check to be sure oil
is flowing through the filters.
Operate filter caddy approximately 10 min-
utes so oil in hydraulic oil tank is circulated
through filter a minimum of four times.
※ Hydraulic oil tank capacity 203ℓ(53.6 U.S.
gal).
Leave filter caddy operating for the next
steps.
6) Start the engine and run it at high idle.
※ For the most effective results, cleaning pro-
cedure must start with the smallest capacity
circuit then proceed to the next largest
capacity circuit.
7) Operate all functions, one at a time, through
a complete cycle in the following order:
clam, steering, bucket, and boom. Also
include all auxiliary hydraulic functions.
Repeat procedure until the total system
capacity has circulated through filter caddy
seven times, approximately 30 minutes.
Each function must go through a minimum
of three complete cycles for a through
cleaning for oil.
※ Filtering time for machines with auxiliary
hydraulic functions must be increased
because system capacity is larger.
8) Stop the engine. Remove the filter caddy.
9) Install a new return filter element.
10) Check oil level in hydraulic oil tank ; Add oil
if necessary.
5-27
2. TEST TOOLS
1) CLAMP-ON ELECTRONIC TACHOMET-
ER INSTALLATION
· Service equipment and tools
Tachometer
A : Clamp on tachometer.
Remove paint using emery cloth and B
connect to a straight section of injec- D
tion line within 100 mm (4in) of pump. C
Finger tighten only-do not over tighten.
B : Black clip (-). Connect to main frame.
C : Red clip (+). Connect to transducer. A
D : Tachometer readout. Install cable.
(770-3ATM) 5-30
(770-3ATM) 5-30
7579S5SE35
5-28
3. STEERING SYSTEM RESTRICTION TEST
· SPECIFICATION
Oil temperature 45±5˚C (113±9˚F)
Engine speed High idle
Maximum pressure 2.1MPa (21 bar, 300psi)
at flow amplifier
· GAUGE AND TOOL
Gauge 0~7 MPa (0~70 bar, 0~1000 psi) 2EA
· This test will check for restrictions in the Steering pump
steering system which can cause overheat-
ing of hydraulic oil.
1) Install temperature reader.
(see temperature reader installation proce- HP EF
5-29
4. STEERING UNIT LEAKAGE TEST
· SPECIFICATION
Oil temperature 45±5˚C (113±9˚F)
Engine speed High idle
Maximum leakage 7.5ℓ/min (2 gpm) Cap fitting
· GAUGE AND TOOL
Temperature reader T
L
R
Measuring container (approx. 20ℓ)
Stop watch
1) Install frame locking bar to prevent machine
from turning.
2) Install temperature reader.
(see temperature reader installation proce-
dure in this group).
3) Heat hydraulic oil to specifications.
(see hydraulic oil warm up procedure at
page 6-45).
4) Disconnect return hose from fitting.
Install cap fitting.
5) Run engine at specifications. Rotate
steering wheel against locking bar using
approximately 1.2 kgf·m of force. Front
frame
Measure oil flow from return hose for 1
minute.
6) Leakage is greater than specifications, Lock bar
lock position
repair or replace steering unit.
78095SE11
5-30
5. FLOW AMPLIFIER PRESSURE TEST
· SPECIFICATION
Oil temperature 45±5˚C (113±9˚F)
Engine speed High idle
Oil pressure 20.1~21.1 MPa
(205~215 bar, 2900~3100 psi) Relief valve
Temperature reader CL
5-31
6. FLOW AMPLIFIER LS PORT FLOW TEST
· SPECIFICATION
Oil temperature 45±5˚C (113±9˚F)
Engine speed Low idle
LS port flow (approx.) 45±5˚C (113±9˚F)
· GAU
GAUGEGE AND TOOL
Temperature reader
Measuring container
Stop watch
5-32
7. FLOW AMPLIFIER RELIEF CARTRIDGE
LEAKAGE TEST
· SPEC
SPECIFICATION
IFICATION
Oil temperature 45±5˚C (113±9˚F)
Engine speed High idle
Maximum leakage 1 mℓ/min (16 drops per
min) A
5-33
GROUP 4 DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
P2 CARTRIDGE
27
34 39
35 1
20 26
17 21 22
16 21
P1 CARTRIDGE 19
7807WE28
5-34
STRUCTURE (2/2)
37
8
36 28
29
7
9
11
6
10
32
25
30
24
31
12
33
5 11
23
4
3
13
2
14
15
P2 CARTRIDGE P1 CARTRIDGE
7807AWE29
※Disassembly
Disassembly and assembly : See page 6-56.
5-35
2) TROUBLESHOOTING
5-36
Problem Cause Remedy
Noisy or erratic operation Air leak at pump inlet or suction lines, or Check for air leaks by pouring system
at shaft seal due to misalignment. fluid around joints and listen for change
in sound level. Tighten as required.
Check for shaft misalignment.
Housing and mounting cap separation. Check bolts for poor torque.
Restricted or clogged inlet line or Provide larger inlet line or strainer.
strainer. Clean strainer.
Provide power source that does not exc-
Excessive pump RPM (cavitation). eed maximum pump RPM recommen-
dations.
Check for air bubbles in the tank correct
Aeration in the fluid. this situation with return flow.
Disassemble per overhaul instructions
Worn vanes, cam ring or port plates. and replace worn parts.
Disassemble and replace.
Worn bearings.
Seal Failure Excesive inlet pressure. Decrease inlet pressure. Inlet pressure
must not exceed 0.7 bar (14 psi)*.
* Except for pump with S5 or HP seals. These must not exceed 7 bar [142 psi] inlet pressure.
5-37
2. FLOW AMPLIFIER
1) STRUCTURE
20
5
19
38
4
6
9 A
36
21
7 25
2
26
16 23
27 31
14 29
13 21 28
24
3 34
1 41 7
12
11 9C
35 15 11
2 12
34
24
28
9A 29
23
8 22
13
14
30
10
40 1
9B
42
A 37 7707ASE09
5-38
2) TOOLS
· Guide screws : M8×1.0
· Hook : Wire
(770-3ATM) FA001
3) DISASSEMBLY
(1) Disassembly counter pressure valve
① Unscrew plug with O-ring (hexagon
socket for 8 mm internal hexagon).
(770-3ATM) FA003
(770-3ATM) FA004
5-39
③ Take out ball (magnetic rod).
(770-3ATM) FA005
(770-3ATM) FA006
(770-3ATM) FA007
(770-3ATM) FA008
5-40
⑦ Counter pressure valve with orifice
shown disassembled.
(770-3ATM) FA009
(770-3ATM) FA010
(770-3ATM) FA011
(770-3ATM) FA012
5-41
(3) Disassembly pressure relief valve
① Hold cartridge (multigrip pliers) and
screw the adjustment screw out (5 mm
hexagon key).
(770-3ATM) FA013
(770-3ATM) FA014
(770-3ATM) FA015
(770-3ATM) FA016
5-42
③ Remove stop and 2 springs.
(770-3ATM) FA017
④ Remove spring.
(770-3ATM) FA018
(770-3ATM) FA019
(770-3ATM) FA020
5-43
(5) Removing end cover at LS-connection
① Unscrew screws with spring washer
using hexagon socket for 13 mm external
hexagon and 10 mm internal hexagon.
(770-3ATM) FA021
(770-3ATM) FA022
(770-3ATM) FA023
(770-3ATM) FA024
5-44
⑤ Remove plate and 4 O-rings.
(770-3ATM) FA025
(770-3ATM) FA026
(770-3ATM) FA027
(770-3ATM) FA028
5-45
③ Remove priority valve spool.
(770-3ATM) FA029
(770-3ATM) FA030
② U n s c r ew t h r o t t l e c h e ck va l ve i n
PP-connection with 6mm hexagon key.
(770-3ATM) FA031
(770-3ATM) FA032
5-46
(8) Removing shock valves
① Remove shock valve with screwdriver
and hexagon key.
(770-3ATM) FA033
(770-3ATM) FA034
(770-3ATM) FA035
(770-3ATM) FA036
5-47
② Directional spool shown disassembled.
(770-3ATM) FA037
(770-3ATM) FA038
(770-3ATM) FA039
(770-3ATM) FA040
5-48
(12) Disassembly of amplifier spool
① Carefully remove the spring ring from the
recess with 3mm screwdriver.
※ Avoid damage to the spring ring.
(770-3ATM) FA041
(770-3ATM) FA042
(770-3ATM) FA043
(770-3ATM) FA044
5-49
⑤ Take out plug.
(770-3ATM) FA045
(770-3ATM) FA046
(770-3ATM) FA047
(770-3ATM) FA048
5-50
⑨ Unscrew check valve with hexagon
socket for 17 mm external hexagon and
mandrel in the pin hole.
※ Avoid damaging the spool surface.
(770-3ATM) FA049
(770-3ATM) FA050
(770-3ATM) FA051
(770-3ATM) FA052
5-51
② Check valve shown disassembled.
(770-3ATM) FA053
(770-3ATM) FA054
(770-3ATM) FA055
(770-3ATM) FA056
5-52
④ Unscrew pilot valve with hexagon socket
for 19 mm external hexagon. Use a
mandrel.
(770-3ATM) FA057
(770-3ATM) FA058
(770-3ATM) FA059
(770-3ATM) FA060
5-53
⑧ Shock valve / suction valve shown
disassembled.
(770-3ATM) FA061
※ Cleaning
Clean all parts carefully with low aromatic
kerosene.
※ Inspection and replacement
Replace all gaskets and sealing washers.
Check all other parts carefully and
replace if necessary.
※ Lubrication
Before assembly, lubricate all parts with
hydraulic oil.
5-54
4) ASSEMBLY
(1) Assembly of shock valve / suction
valve
① Guide spring with cone into housing.
(770-3ATM) FA062
(770-3ATM) FA063
③ Fit spool.
(770-3ATM) FA064
④ Fit spring.
(770-3ATM) FA065
5-55
⑤ Fit pilot valve.
Remember O-ring.
(770-3ATM) FA066
(770-3ATM) FA067
⑦ Fit housing.
(770-3ATM) FA068
⑧ Fit spring.
(770-3ATM) FA069
5-56
⑨ Fit disc.
(770-3ATM) FA070
⑩ Fit locknut.
·Tightening torque : 1.5±0.2 kgf·m
(10.8±1.4 lbf·ft)
(770-3ATM) FA071
(770-3ATM) FA072
(770-3ATM) FA073
5-57
② Fit check valve.
·Tightening torque : 2±0.3 kgf·m
(14.5±2.2lbf·ft)
※ Avoid damaging spool surface.
Remember O-ring.
(770-3ATM) FA074
(770-3ATM) FA075
(770-3ATM) FA076
⑤ Fit pin.
(770-3ATM) FA077
5-58
⑥ Push spring ring into position. Place
spring ring into the recess with ends
facing away from pin holes.
(770-3ATM) FA078
⑦ Fit spring.
(770-3ATM) FA079
⑧ Fit plug.
(770-3ATM) FA080
⑨ Fit pin.
(770-3ATM) FA081
5-59
⑩ Push spring ring into position. Place
spring ring into the recess with ends
facing away from pin holes.
(770-3ATM) FA082
(770-3ATM) FA083
(770-3ATM) FA084
(770-3ATM) FA085
5-60
② Fit orifice in LS - connection.
·Tightening torque : 1±0.3 kgf·m
(7.2±2.2 lbf·ft)
(770-3ATM) FA086
③ F i t t h r o t t l e c h e ck va l ve i n P P -
connection.
·Tightening torque : 1±0.3 kgf·m
(7.2±2.2 lbf·ft)
(770-3ATM) FA087
(770-3ATM) FA088
5-61
(8) Assembly of pressure relief valve
① Guide adjustment screw, spring and
cone up into the cartridge.
(770-3ATM) FA089
(770-3ATM) FA090
(770-3ATM) FA091
(770-3ATM) FA092
5-62
③ Fit plug with washer.
·Tightening torque : 6±0.5 kgf·m
(44.1±3.6 lbf·ft)
(770-3ATM) FA093
(770-3ATM) FA094
(770-3ATM) FA095
(770-3ATM) FA096
5-63
(11) Installation of spools
① Fit directional spool.
Fit priority valve spool.
※ Spring control must be placed in correct
position against LS - connection.
(770-3ATM) FA097
② Fit spring.
※ Spring must be by the LS - connection.
(770-3ATM) FA098
(770-3ATM) FA099
(12) I n s t a l l a t i o n o f e n d c ove r a t P P -
connection
① Fit spring with vaseline on amplifier
※ spool.
The spring must be fitted at the PP -
connection.
(770-3ATM) FA100
5-64
② Fit spring guide with vaseline.
(770-3ATM) FA101
(770-3ATM) FA102
(770-3ATM) FA103
(770-3ATM) FA104
5-65
⑥ Guide plate in.
(770-3ATM) FA105
(770-3ATM) FA106
(770-3ATM) FA107
(770-3ATM) FA108
5-66
⑩ Fit screws with spring washer.
·Tightening torque : 2.6±0.5 kgf·m
(18.8±3.6 lbf·ft)
·Tightening torque : 8.2±1 kgf·m
for large screw (59.3±7.2 lbf·ft)
(770-3ATM) FA109
(13) I n s t a l l a t i o n o f e n d c ove r a t L S -
connection
① Fit guide screws.
Fit remote control with vaseline.
(770-3ATM) FA110
(770-3ATM) FA111
(770-3ATM) FA112
5-67
④ Fit stop for priority valve spool (thickness
: 8 mm) with vaseline.
(770-3ATM) FA113
(770-3ATM) FA114
(770-3ATM) FA115
(770-3ATM) FA116
5-68
⑧ Fit screws with spring washers.
·Tightening torque : 2.6±0.5 kgf·m
(18.8±3.6 lbf·ft)
·Tightening torque : 8.2±1 kgf·m
for large screw (59.3±7.2 lbf·ft)
(770-3ATM) FA117
(770-3ATM) FA118
5-69
3. STEERING UNIT
1) STRUCTURE
7707SE21
5-70
2) TOOLS
(1) Holding tool.
(770-3ATM) 5-69(1)
(770-3ATM) 5-69(2)
(770-3ATM) 5-69(3)
(770-3ATM) 5-69(4)
5-71
(5) Assembly tool for dust seal.
(770-3ATM) 5-70(1)
5-72
3) TIGHTENING TORQUE AND HYDRAULIC CONNECTIONS
(1) Hydraulic connections
L: Left port
R: Right port
T: Tank
TLPR P: Pump
(770-3ATM) 5-71
5-73
4) DISASSEMBLY
(1) Disassemble steering column from
steering unit and place the steering unit in
the holding tool.
Screw out the screws in the end cover(6-
off plus one special screw).
(770-3ATM) 5-72(1)
(770-3ATM) 5-72(2)
(770-3ATM) 5-72(3)
(770-3ATM) 5-72(4)
5-74
(5) Remove distributor plate.
(770-3ATM) 5-73(1)
(770-3ATM) 5-73(2)
(770-3ATM) 5-73(3)
(770-3ATM) 5-73(4)
5-75
(9) Take ring, bearing races and needle
bearing from sleeve and spool. The outer
(Thin) bearing race can sometimes "stick"
in the housing, therefore check that it has
come out.
(770-3ATM) 5-74(1)
(770-3ATM) 5-74(2)
(770-3ATM) 5-74(3)
(770-3ATM) 5-74(4)
5-76
(12) Press the neutral position springs out of
their slots in the spool.
(770-3ATM) 5-75(1)
(770-3ATM) 5-75(2)
(770-3ATM) 5-75(3)
※ Cleaning
Clean all parts carefully in Shellsol K or
the like.
※ Inspection and replacement
Replace all seals and washers. Check all
par ts carefully and make any
replacements necessary.
※ Lubrication
Before assembly, lubricate all parts with
hydraulic oil.
5-77
5) ASSEMBLY
(1) Assemble spool and sleeve.
※ When assembling spool and sleeve only
one of two possible ways of positioning
the spring slots is correct. There are
three slots in the spool and three holes in
the sleeve in the end of the spool / sleeve
opposite to the end with spring slots.
Place the slots and holes opposite each (770-3ATM) 5-76(1)
(770-3ATM) 5-76(2)
※ Assembly pattern.
· Weak springs (blue)
2 - off flat, blue : Part no. 150-0748
2 - off curved, blue : Part no. 150-0749
· Blue set
Spare set : Part no. 150-4265
(770-3ATM) 5-76(3)
(770-3ATM) 5-76(4)
5-78
(4) Guide the spool into the sleeve. Make
sure that spool and sleeve are placed
correctly in relation to each other (see
page 3-76, No.(1)).
(770-3ATM) 5-77(1)
(770-3ATM) 5-77(2)
(770-3ATM) 5-77(3)
(770-3ATM) 5-77(4)
5-79
(8) Fit the cross pin into the spool / sleeve.
(770-3ATM) 5-78(1)
(770-3ATM) 5-78(2)
5
(770-3ATM) 5-78(3)
(770-3ATM) 5-78(4)
5-80
(11) Grease O-ring with hydraulic oil and place
them on the tool.
(770-3ATM) 5-79(1)
(770-3ATM) 5-79(2)
(770-3ATM) 5-79(3)
(770-3ATM) 5-79(4)
5-81
(14) Draw the inner and outer parts of the
assembly tool out of the steering unit
bore, leaving the guide from the inner part
in the bore.
(770-3ATM) 5-80(1)
(770-3ATM) 5-80(2)
(770-3ATM) 5-80(3)
(770-3ATM) 5-80(4)
5-82
(17) Press and turn the lip seal into place in
the housing.
(770-3ATM) 5-81(1)
(770-3ATM) 5-81(2)
(770-3ATM) 5-81(3)
(770-3ATM) 5-81(4)
5-83
(21) Screw the threaded bush lightly into the
check valve bore. The top of the bush
must lie just below the surface of the
housing.
(770-3ATM) 5-82(1)
(770-3ATM) 5-82(2)
(770-3ATM) 5-82(3)
(770-3ATM) 5-82(4)
5-84
(25) Place the cardan shaft as shown - so that
it is held in position by the mounting fork.
(770-3ATM) 5-83(1)
(770-3ATM) 5-83(2)
(27) Important
Fit the gearwheel (rotor) and cardan shaft
so that a tooth base in the rotor is
positioned in relation to the shaft slot as
shown.
Turn the gear rim so that the seven
through holes match the holes in the
housing.
(770-3ATM) 5-83(3)
(770-3ATM) 5-83(4)
5-85
(29) Place the end cover in position.
(770-3ATM) 5-84(1)
(770-3ATM) 5-84(2)
(770-3ATM) 5-84(3)
(770-3ATM) 5-84(4)
5-86
(33) Fit the dust seal ring in the housing.
(770-3ATM) 5-85(1)
(770-3ATM) 5-85(2)
5-87
4. STEERING CYLINDER
1) STRUCTURE
21
28,27 23 20
7809S5SE05
5-88
2) TOOLS AND TIGHTENING TORQUE
(1) Tools
Tool name B Remark
B
L-wrench 5
Spanner 70
5-89
3) DISASSEMBLY
(1) Remove cylinder head and piston rod
① Hold the clevis section of the tube in a
vise.
※ Use mouth pieces so as not to damage
the machined surface of the cylinder
tube. Do not make use of the outside
piping as a locking means.
5-88(1)
3
2
5-88(2)
5-90
※ Note that the plated surface of piston rod
(2) is to be lifted. For this reason, do not
use a wire sling and others that may
damage it, but use a strong cloth belt or
a rope.
Wooden block
5-89(1)
78095SE09
5-91
(3) Disassemble the piston assembly
① Remove wear ring (17) and piston seal 15,14 16 17
(16).
Remove back up ring (15) and O-ring
(14).
※ Exercise care in this operation not to
damage the grooves.
78095SE22
5-92
4) ASSEMBLY
(1) Assemble gland assembly
※ Check for scratches or rough surfaces if
found smooth with an oil stone.
① Coat the inner face of gland (3) with
hydraulic oil.
78095SE34
78095SE24
7577ASE42
78095SE43
5-93
⑤ Fit back up ring (12) to gland (3).
※ Put the backup ring in the warm water of 10 12,11 4
30~50˚C.
⑥ Fit O-ring (11, 10) to gland (3). 3
⑦ Fit bushing (4) to gland (3).
78095SE25
5-92(2)
5-92(3)
5-92(4)
5-94
(3) Install piston and gland assembly
① Fix the piston rod assembly to the work
bench. Gland assembly Piston rod
② Apply hydraulic oil to the outer surface of
piston rod (2), the inner surface of piston
and gland.
③ Insert gland assembly to piston rod (2).
78095SE29
18 78095SE30
Wrench
Gland
5-94(2)
5-95
5. CENTER PIVOT PIN
1) CONSTRUCTION
Figure shows the construction of the center pivot pin assembly. This assembly serves to connect
the front frame with the rear frame; two sets of assemblies are provided, one each for the upper
and lower parts. The numbers in parentheses following the parts name denote the item numbers
shown in the figure in the disassembly and assembly procedures.
24 23 6,20 26 8 7 32
21
22 19,20
12
2
20,25
17
4,5 4,5
31
31
1
3 18
16
9
28 13,14,15
10
32 11 29,30 6,20
UPPER LOWER
78095SE13
5-96
2) DISASSEMBLY
After supporting the front frame and the
rear frame as horizontally as possible using
wood blocks and jacks, disassemble as
fo l l o w s : I n o r d e r t o fa c i l i t a t e t h e
disassembly/assembly of the center pivot
pins, remove the drive shaft, hydraulic line
and steering cylinder first.
(1) Maintain the horizontal level of front frame
(31) and rear frame (32), and then UPPER
remove hexagon bolt (6, 23, 29), washer 24 23 6,20 26
(20, 24) and plate (26, 28).
(2) Take out upper pin (11) to the downside
using a metal punch.
31
28
32 11 29,30
78095SE14
5-97
(8) Remove bolt (25), washer (20) and then
UPPER
take out cover (2) and shims (4, 5).
20,25 21 2
(9) Take out dust seal (21) from the cover (2).
(10) Remove the bearing (1), and dust seal 4,5
(21). 31
21 1
78095SE16
1 12 18
78095SE17
3) INSPECTION
(1) Check the bearing sliding surface for excessive wear, scorching or scratches; replace if
necessary.
(2) Replace all dust seals (12, 21) with new ones.
(3) Grind any pins (7, 11) dented with an oilstone or replace any pins abrasive excessively.
(4) Check inside cover (2, 3, 17, 18) and collar (8, 9) for dents or scratches; if any damage is found,
correct with a grinder or replace.
(5) The serviceable limit of pins and bushings is shown in the table below. Unit : mm
5-98
4) ASSEMBLY
24 23 6,20 26 8 7 32
21
22 19,20
12
2
20,25
17
4,5 4,5
Clearance A 31
1 31
3 18
16
9
28 13,14,15
Clearance B
32 11 29,30 10 6,20
UPPER LOWER
78095SE19
Assemble the center pivot group by reversing the order of disassembly while paying close attention
to the following.
(1) Put the dust seal (12,21) into cover (2, 3, 17, 18).
※ Apply grease to the lip of the dust seal. Insert the dust seal so that the dust seal lip faces out and
punch four places on the outer circumference of the seal to lock it.
(2) Lower the temperature of the lower bearing cup to -75±5˚C (-103±9˚F ) and install it to front
frame until it contacts the bottom of the frame.
(3) Place the cover (3, 18).
(4) Coat lightly with oil and install lower bearing in bore in front frame. Coat lightly with oil and install
upper bearing in bore in upper front frame.
(5) Place the cover (2, 17) and hold in place with bolt (19, 25). At this time, adjust shims (4, 5) to
press the shoulder of bearing (1) against retainer.
ㆍ Adjustment method of clearance A
① Install bearing (1) and cover (2, 17) without shim (4, 5)
Install four of bolt (19, 25) so that each bolt is separated by 90 degrees.
ㆍTightening torque : 1.5~1.7 kgfㆍm (10.8~12.3 lbfㆍft)
② Adjust shims (4, 5) in order to control the clearance A.
ㆍClearance A : Below 0.1 mm
ㆍShim thickness : 0.1 mm, 0.5 mm
5-99
(5) Apply grease to lower collar (8) and insert it to the lower of roller bearing.
(6) After setting the bearing so that its upper surface is horizontal, tighten the all the bolt (19, 25).
After tightening, confirm that tapered roller bearing moves lightly ; if does not move smoothly, add
shims (4, 5).
ㆍ Tightening Torque : 35~43 kgfㆍm (253~311 lbfㆍft)
ㆍ Apply loctite #243.
(7) Move the front frame and join it to the rear frame so that match the pin hole at the center.
(8) Apply grease to pin (11), bushing (22) and insert it into tapered roller bearing (1).
(9) Apply grease to lower collar (9) and insert it to the lower of roller bearing through rear frame (32).
(10) Apply grease to pin (7) and insert it into tapered roller bearing (1).
(11) Before tightening bolt (6), adjust shims (13, 14, 15) in order to control the clearance between the
plate (21) and rear frame (32).
ㆍAdjustment
Adjustment method of clearance B
① Install pin (7) and plate (10) without shim (13, 14, 15).
Install four of bolt (6) so that each bolt is separated by 90 degrees.
ㆍTightening torque : 1.5~1.7 kgfㆍm (10.8~12.3 lbfㆍft)
② Adjust shims in order to control the clearance B.
ㆍClearance B : 0.1~0.2 mm
ㆍShim thickness : 0.1 mm, 0.5 mm, 2.0 mm
(12) Tighten the all the bolts (6).
ㆍTightening Torque : 35~43 kgfㆍm (253~311 lbfㆍft)
ㆍApply loctite #243.
5) TROUBLESHOOTING
Trouble Probable cause Remedy
Capscrew for fixing steering valve is loose Retighten
Faulty center pivot pin mounting bolts Retighten
Shock is felt when steering
Center pivot pins have worn out Readjust or replace
Faulty hydraulic system See hydraulic system
Fault fixing of connecting capscrews Retighten
Center pins have worn out Readjust or replace
Shock is felt when moving
Bearings of support unit have worn out Retighten
backward or forward
Drive shaft damaged See drive system
Faulty transmission See transmission system
5-100
SECTION 6 WORK EQUIPMENT
Flow from the steering pump not used by the steering system leaves the flow amplifier EF port.
It flows to the inlet port plate of two section or three section block type main control valve.
The main control valve is load pressure independent flow distribution system which routes flow to the
boom, bucket or auxiliary cylinders (not shown) when the respective spools are shifted.
Flow from the loader pump is routed to the main control valve where pump outlet pressure is
reduced to pilot circuit pressure. The main control valve flow to the remote control valve.
The remote control valve routed flow to either end of each spool valve section in the main control
valve to control spool stroke.
A accumulator mounted on safety valve supplies a secondary pressure source to operated remote
control valve so the boom can be lowered if the engine is off.
The return circuit for the main hydraulic system have return filter inside the hydraulic tank. The return
filter uses a filter element and a bypass valve. The bypass valve is located in the upside of filter.
6-1
2. HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT
FRONT 39 REAR 10 11 12 30 31 32
B T
A X1
X2 T P
L.H R.H L.H R.H
4 B.D/F B.U IN OUT
MX
18 PS 6 CL CR
T1 P1 T2 P2
L R 3 L1 L2 T
40 P
T/M
16 17
3B
EF
3A BOOM UP BOOM DOWN
15 B
T
PP P3A P3B
16 7 B1 A1 B2 A2
A
HP LS HT 2B
14
PS
PS T1
1B
19 1A
B
P1A P1B F1
PS
PS1
19 13 U
P T
P
P T LS
20 T
P1 P2
1 2
34
PS
28 M1 23
A
P1
29 M2 24 T P
PS
P2
25 26 21 C
27 22
M
7809S6WE01
6-2
3. WORK EQUIPMENT HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT
11 12 4 T P
L.H R.H
1 3 4 2 1.1 2.1
3 L1 L2 T
3B
3A BOOM UP
BOOM
DOWN
15 B
P3A P3B
2B
1A AUX
P1A P1B F1
13 U
T
Flow amplifier EF port
P1 P2
Steering system
Brake system
1 2
Return line
23
24 T P
21 C
25 26 22
7809S6WE02
6-3
1) WHEN THE RCV LEVER IS IN THE RAISE POSITION
11 12 4 T P
L.H R.H
1 3 4 2 1.1 2.1
3 L1 L2 T
3B
P3A P3B
2B
1A AUX.
P1A P1B F1
13 U
T
Flow amplifier EF port
P1 P2
Steering system
Brake system
1 2
Return line
23
24 T P
21 C
25 26 22
7809S6WE03
· When the RCV lever (4) is pulled back, the boom spool is moved to raise position by pilot oil
pressure from port 3 of RCV.
· The oil from main pump (1) flows into main control valve (3) and then goes to the large chamber of
boom cylinder (12) by pushing the load check valve of the boom spool through center bypass
· circuit of the bucket spool.
The oil from the small chamber of boom cylinder (12) returns to hydraulic oil tank (24) through the
· boom spool at the same time.
When this happens, the boom goes up.
6-4
2) WHEN THE RCV LEVER IS IN THE LOWER POSITION
11 12 4 T P
L.H R.H
1 3 4 2 1.1 2.1
3 L1 L2 T
3B
P3A P3B
2B
1A AUX.
P1A P1B F1
13 U
T
Flow amplifier EF port
P1 P2
Steering system
Brake system
1 2
Return line
23
24 T P
21 C
25 26 22
7809S6WE04
· When the RCV lever (4) is pushed forward, the boom spool is moved to lower position by pilot
pressure from port 1 of RCV.
· The oil from main pump (1) flows into main control valve and then goes to small chamber of boom
cylinder (12) by pushing the load check valve of the boom spool through center bypass circuit of
the bucket spool.
· The oil returned from large chamber of boom cylinder (12) returns to hydraulic tank (24) through
the boom spool at the same time.
· When the lowering speed of boom is faster, the return oil from the large chamber of boom cylinder
combines with the oil from the pump, and flows into the small chamber of the cylinder.
This prevents cylinder cavitation by the negative pressure when the pump flow cannot match the
boom down speed.
6-5
3) WHEN THE RCV LEVER IS IN THE FLOAT POSITION
11 12 4 T P
L.H R.H
1 3 4 2 1.1 2.1
3 L1 L2 T
A A
3B
P3A P3B
2B
1A AUX.
P1A P1B F1
13 U
T
Flow amplifier EF port
P1 P2
Steering system
Brake system
1 2
Return line
23
24 T P
21 C
25 26 22
7809S6WE05
Float is achieved by opening 2 large capacity check valves (A) fitted into the bolt on float check
block. These check valves connect each of the boom service ports (3A, 3B) to the tank gallery.
Opening of these valves is controlled by pilot pressure from the hydraulic pilot control valve (4).
As the hydraulic control lever is selected in the power down direction the pressure at the spool pilot
end can on the main valve increases and at some point the spool starts to move progressively
through its stroke. This pilot pressure is also connected, internally within the valve, onto a separate
pilot spool which controls the opening and closing of the pilot check valves (A). As the pilot
pressure operates the main spool up to its maximum stroke the pilot spool then selects at some
pressure beyond that and the check valves open, operating a separate connection between the
large chamber and small chamber ports and tank.
6-6
Subsequent deselection of the control lever allows the pilot spool to deselect, the check valves
close, followed by the main spool returning to neutral, all with minimal hysteresis.
On a four position spool, when selecting the spool in one direction, it has to control both power
down and float. This means that the spool stroke for the power down part of the stroke is limited
and so the metering length is shortened, giving limited control on the service.
Because float is achieved by separate check valves, the whole of the spool selection in that
direction can be used for power down and so the metering performance can be maximized.
Because the float is achieved by opening two large capacity check valves, the ability of the valve to
'make up' any cavitation during power down is greatly improved over that of a standard 4 position
spool. The original benchmark of no dead time(cavitation in the boom cylinder small chamber)
while floating down from full lift height at mid engine speed, has been surpassed. The achievement
that has been measured with this product is that there is less than 1 second dead time when
floating down from full height at low idle.
6-7
4) WHEN THE RCV LEVER IS IN THE DUMP POSITION
11 12 4 T P
L.H R.H
1 3 4 2 1.1 2.1
3 L1 L2 T
3B
P3A P3B
2B
1A AUX.
P1A P1B F1
13 U
T
Flow amplifier EF port
P1 P2
Steering system
Brake system
1 2
Return line
23
24 T P
21 C
25 26 22
7809S6WE06
· If the RCV lever (4) is pushed right, the bucket spool is moved to dump position by pilot oil pressure
from port 2 of RCV.
· The oil from main pump (1) flows into main control valve (3) and then goes to the small chamber of
bucket cylinder (11) by pushing the load check valve of the bucket spool.
· The oil at the large chamber of bucket cylinder (11) returns to hydraulic tank (24) through the
bucket spool.
· When this happens, the bucket is dumped.
· When the dumping speed of bucket is faster, the oil returned from the large chamber of bucket
cylinder combines with the oil from the pump, and flows into the small chamber of the cylinder.
This prevents cylinder cavitation by the negative pressure when the pump flow cannot match the
bucket dump speed.
6-8
5) WHEN THE RCV LEVER IS IN THE ROLL BACK (retract) POSITION
11 12 4 T P
L.H R.H
1 3 4 2 1.1 2.1
3 L1 L2 T
3B
P3A P3B
2B
1A AUX.
P1A P1B F1
13 U
T
Flow amplifier EF port
P1 P2
Steering system
Brake system
1 2
Return line
23
24 T P
21 C
25 26 22
7809S6WE07
· If the RCV lever (4) is pulled left, the bucket spool is moved to roll back position by pilot oil pressure
from port 4 of RCV.
· The oil from main pump (1) flows into main control valve (3) and then goes to the large chamber of
bucket cylinder by pushing the load check valve of the bucket spool.
· The oil at the chamber of bucket cylinder (11) returns to hydraulic tank (24) through the bucket
spool.
· When this happens, the bucket roll back.
· When the rolling speed of bucket is faster, the return oil from the small chamber of bucket cylinder
combines with the oil from the pump, and flows into the large chamber of the cylinder.
This prevents cylinder cavitation by the negative pressure when the pump flow cannot match the
bucket rolling speed.
6-9
4. MAIN PUMP (+BRAKE PUMP)
1) STRUCTURE (1/2)
35 36 37 39
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 19
33 34 32 31 30 29 28 25 24 27 26 23 22 21 20
7807AWE09
6-10
2) DESCRIPTION
The main vane pump consist of six basic components : end cap (2), P2 section unitlzed cartridge
(4) consisting of ; rotor, vanes, vane holdout pins, cam ring, port plate, and pressure plate, center,
housing (5), P1 section unitlzed cartridge (6) consisting of ; rotor, vanes, vane holdout pins, cam
ring, port plate, pressure plate, shaft (11) and bearing and mounting cap (14).
The main vane pump features the use of unitized pumping cartridge for both the P1 and P2 pump
section.
The unitized cartridge assemblies are pretested and provide for ease of disassembly and assem-
bly in the event it becomes necessary or desirable to make repairs, overhaul or revise the flow
delivery.
P1 section
P2 section
14
11
6
5
4
2
7707WE10
3) OPERATION
The pumping operation of this unit(each cartridge) is obtained by providing a fixed interior cam sur-
face and a rotating inner member(rotor) containing vanes which held in contact with the inner cam
surface. As the rotor is rotated by the drive shaft, the vanes are urged outward against the outward
sloping cam surface, forming a cavity at the inlet ports of the port plates. Atmospheric pressure
and suction created by the expanding cavity between the rotating vanes fill the inlet cavity with fluid.
As the rotation continues and the vanes that had previously moved outward and now have fluid
trapped between them and the port plates, follow the inward slope of the cam which decreases the
cavity containing the trapped fluid and discharges the fluid at system pressure through the pres-
sure port openings in the port plates.
The rotating portion of the unitized cartridges feature the use of pressure actuated vanes which are
urged against the cam ring by pins located in the bottom of each rotor vane slot. Initial force to
bring the vanes in contact with the cam ring contour during start up is provided by centrifugal force.
When pumping operation starts and pressure is established, fluid under pressure fills the pin cavity
through the feed holes.
The feed holes open to the pressure port twice every revolution. All other times they are closed off
by the port plate. This pressure under the pin provides the force necessary to keep the vanes in
contact with the cam contour.
※ When operating the pump at the maximum outlet pressure, the pump shaft rotation should not be
allowed to fall below 600rpm in order to maintain proper vane to cam ring contact. The inlet or suc-
tion flow for both the P1 cartridge and P2 cartridge feeds through a common 3 port in the center
housing, through the large ports of each port plate for each cartridge and through the center hole
in the suction zone of each cam ring.
6-11
5. REMOTE CONTROL VALVE
1) STRUCTURE
38
37
36
33
32
34
35
23
27
26 28
25 30
24 29
19 31
21 20
22 18
17
8
5 16
9 14
12
15
11
10 13
4
PF 1/4
7
Tightening torque : 3.7 0.2 kgf.m
6
3
49
2
UNF 11/16 47
1,46
48
39,40,41,42
45
7809S6WE28
41,42,43,44
1 Body 14 Rod seal 27 Nut 40 Rear holder
2 O-ring 15 O-ring 28 Plug 41 Terminal
3 Plug 16 Push rod 29 Nut 42 Seal wire
4 Spring 17 Plate 30 Set screw 43 Housing
5 Spring seat 18 Rod stopper 31 Nut 44 Rear holder
6 Spool 19 Bushing 32 Nut 45 Clip band
7 Spring seat 20 Rod 33 Handle bar 46 Plug
8 Stopper 21 Magnet 34 Nut 47 Connector
9 Spring 22 Plate 35 Boot 48 O-ring
10 Spring seat 23 Joint assy 36 Handle assy 49 O-ring
11 Spring 24 Joint assy 37 Nut
12 Spring seat 25 Plate 38 Spring washer
13 Plug 26 Washer 39 Housing
6-12
2) OPERATION
T P
1 34 2
HYDRAULIC CIRCUIT
(3 Electromagnetic locks) 36
38
35
24 20
21
6-13
(2) End position lock
Only those control ports, for which it is necessary to hold the handle in a deflected position are
equipped with end position locks.
Electromagnetic lock
When this threshold is overcome, a joint assy (24) contacts the magnet (21); if the magnet (21) is
energized, then handle (36) is held in its end position by magnetic force.
This lock is released automatically when the solenoid is deenergized.
6-14
6. MAIN CONTROL VALVE
1) STRUCTURE
10 17
7 9
7
11
12
16
13
10
6
14
17
5
7
8
2 15
1 4
6
2
5 12
7707WE30
6-15
STRUCTURE
P3A 3A 3B P3B
P2A 2A 2B P2B
L1 L2 T
3B
3A
P3A P3B
Boom up Boom down
2B 24MPa
2A
P2A P2B
Dump Roll back
1B 24MPa 24MPa
1A
P1A P1B
24MPa 24MPa
21MPa
P
7707WE71
6-16
2) BOOM SECTION OPERATION
(1) Spool in neutral
L1 L2 T
LH RH
3B
3A
P3B
P3A
Boom up Boom down
2B 24MPa
2A
P2B
P2A
Dump Roll back
24MPa 24MPa
3A 3B Boom spool
P3A P3B
7707WE72
If the remote control valve is not operated, the oil supplied from the pump port passes through the
neutral passage to the low pressure passage at the outlet section, and then returns to the tank
port.
6-17
(2) Boom raise position
L1 L2 T
LH RH
3B
3A
P3A P3B
Boom up
2B 24MPa
2A
P2B
P2A
Dump Roll back
24MPa 24MPa
3A 3B
P3A P3B
7707WE73
When the pilot pressure from remote control valve is supplied to the pilot port (P3A), the spool
moves to the right and the neutral passage is closed.
The oil supplied from the pump flow into boom cylinder port (3A).
The pump pressure reaches proportionally the load of cylinder and fine control finished by shut
off of the neutral passage.
The return oil from cylinder port (3B) flows into the tank via the low pressure passage.
6-18
(3) Boom lower position
L1 L2 T
LH RH
3B
3A
P3B
P3A
Boom down
2B 24MPa
2A
P2B
P2A
Dump Roll back
24MPa 24MPa
3A 3B
P3A P3B
7707WE74
When the pilot pressure from remote control valve is supplied to the pilot port (P3B), the spool
moves to the left and the neutral passage is closed.
The oil supplied from the pump flow into boom cylinder port (3B).
The pump pressure reaches proportionally the load of cylinder and fine control finished by shut
off of the neutral passage.
The return oil from cylinder port (3A) flows into the tank via the low pressure passage.
※Boom
Boom float position : Refer to page 6-6.
6-19
3) BUCKET SECTION OPERATION
(1) Spool in neutral
L1 L2 T
3B
3A
P3B
P3A
Boom up Boom down
2B 24MPa
2A
P2B
P2A
Dump Roll back
24MPa 24MPa
P2A P2B
Bucket spool
If the remote control valve is not operated, the oil supplied from the pump port passage through
the neutral passage to the low pressure passage at the outlet section, and then return to the tank
port.
6-20
(2) Retract (Roll back) position
L1 L2 T
3B
3A
P3B
P3A
Boom up Boom down
2B 24MPa
2A
P2B
P2A
Roll back
24MPa 24MPa
P2A P2B
2A 2B
7707WE77
When the pilot pressure from remote control valve is supplied to the pilot port(P2B), the spool
moves to the left and the neutral passage is closed.
The oil supplied from the pump flow into bucket cylinder port(2B).
The pump pressure reaches proportionally the load of cylinder and fine control finished by shut
off of the neutral passage.
The return oil from cylinder port(2A) flows into the tank via the low pressure passage.
6-21
(3) Dump position
L1 L2 T
3B
3A
P3A P3B
Boom up Boom down
2B 24MPa
2A
P2A
P2B
Dump
24MPa 24MPa
P2A P2B
2A 2B
7707WE76
When the pilot pressure from remote control valve is supplied to the pilot port (P2A), the spool
moves to the right and the neutral passage is closed.
The oil supplied from the flow into boom cylinder port (2A).
The pump pressure reaches proportionally the load of cylinder and fine control finished by shut
off of the neutral passage.
The return oil from cylinder port (2B) flows into the tank via the low pressure passage.
6-22
7. PILOT OIL SUPPLY UNIT
1) STRUCTURE
5
1
P
2
U
T
6
P2 2
7607B6WE46
3MPa
Port Port name Port size
U
P1 From steering pump 3/4-16UNF
(2) OPERATION
The pilot supply manifold reduces the pressure from the high pressure circuit to a low pressure
circuit in order to supply the remote control valve.
The accumulator satisfies short term peak power demands and is a source of emergency power
in case of main circuit pressure failures.
The unit consists of the housing, the accumulator(4), the relief valve (6), the check valve and the
reducing valve (2).
The flow path is from the high pressure circuit through port P2 to the pressure reducing valve (2).
The pressure is reduced in the reducing valve (2) and oil passes the check valve into the
accumulator (4) and to the port U, which is connected with the remote control valve.
The pressure relief valve (6) protects the pilot circuit in case of the reducing valve (2) failures or
external increase of pressure.
6-23
8. BOOM AND BUCKET CYLINDER
The boom cylinders and the bucket cylinders are two unit. They use a bolt on rod guide.
The piston (12) threads on to the rod (2) and is retained by a nut (18) and set screw (19).
The piston seals against the tube (1) with piston seal (15). Two wear rings (16) are located on each
side of the piston seal.
The gland (3, the rod guide) seals against the tube with an O-ring (10). The cylinder thread seals
against the rod with a lip type buffer ring (7) and a rod seal (5). A dust wiper (8) cleans the rod when
it is retracted.
1) BOOM CYLINDER
20 1 21 12 28,29 78036CY02
6-24
2) BUCKET CYLINDER
30,32 31,33
20
7807AWE13
6-25
9. HYDRAULIC OIL TANK
1) STRUCTURE
· The oil from the hydraulic tank is sent from the pump through main control valve to the cylinders.
In the return circuit, the oil from various parts merges.
· A part of oil is cooled in the oil cooler, passes through the hydraulic filter and returns to the
hydraulic tank (1).
· If the hydraulic return oil filter becomes clogged, return filter bypass valve (7) acts to allow the oil
to return directly to the hydraulic tank (1). This prevents damage to the hydraulic filter (6). The
bypass valve (7) is also actuated when negative pressure is generated in the circuit.
1 Hydraulic tank
5
2 Cover
3 3 Cover
4 O-ring
4
5 Bolt
8 6 Return filter
7 7 Bypass valve
8 Spring
6 9 Sight gauge
10
10 Air breather
12 11 Strainer
11
12 Retaining ring
3
4
5
2
5
7809S6WE22
6-26
2) RETURN OIL FILTER BYPASS VALVE
(1) When the filter is clogged
Bypass valve (1) is opened and the oil
1
returns directly to the tank without
passing through the filter.
·Bypass valve set pressure : 1.36 kg/cm2
(19.3 psi)
From MCV
770-3ATM (6-33)
6-27
3) AIR BREATHER
The air breather is equipped with the
capacity to perform three functions
simultaneously-as an air filter, breathing
valve, and as a lubrication opening.
(1) Preventing negative pressure inside the
tank
The tank is a pressurized sealed type, so
negative pressure is formed inside the
hydraulic tank when the oil level drops
during operations. When this happens,
the difference in pressure between the
tank and the outside atmospheric
pressure opens the poppet in the
breather, and air from the outside is let
into the tank or prevent negative pressure.
(2) Preventing excessive pressure inside
the tank
When the hydraulic cylinder is being
used, the oil level in the hydraulic system
increases and as temperature rises. If
the hydraulic pressure rises above the set
pressure, breather is actuated to release
the hydraulic pressure inside the tank. 7809S6WE30
6-28
10. ACCUMULATOR
The accumulator is installed at the safety
valve. When the boom is left the raised
position, and the control levers are operated
with the engine stopped the pressure of the
compressed nitrogen gas inside the
accumulator sends pilot pressure to the
control valve to actuate it and allow the boom
1
and bucket to come down under their own 2
weight.
3
Type of gas Nitrogen gas (N2)
Volume of gas 0.75ℓ(0.2 U.S.gal)
Charging pressure of gas 16 kg/cm2 (228 psi)
Max actuating pressure 128 kg/m2 (1820 psi)
1 Diaphragm
2 Steel pressure vessel
3 Closure button
7803AWE56
6-29
GROUP 2 OPERATIONAL CHECKS AND TROUBLESHOOTING
1. OPERATIONAL CHECKS
This procedure is designed so the mechanic can make a quick check of the system using a minimum
amount of diagnostic equipment. If you need additional information, read structure and function,
Group 1.
A location will be required which is level and has adequate space to complete the checks.
The engine and all other major components must be at operating temperature for some checks.
Locate system check in the left column and read completely, following the sequence from left to right.
Read each check completely before performing.
At the end of each check, if no problem is found (OK), that check is complete or an additional check is
needed. If problem is indicated (NOT OK), you will be given repair required and group location.
If verification is needed, you will be given next best source of information:
·Chapter 2 : Troubleshooting
·Group 3 : Tests and adjustments
6-30
※Hydraulic oil must be at operating temperature for these checks (refer to page 6-45).
6-31
Item Description Service action
Bucket rollback circuit relief Position bucket at a 45˚ angle OK
valve check against an immovable object. Check complete.
Engage transmission in 3rd speed NOT OK
forward. Replace boom lower
check valve.
LOOK : Bucket angle must not
change.
Bucket dump circuit relief Raise front of machine which OK
valve low pressure check bucket at 45˚ angle. Go to next check.
Backdrag with bucket while NOT OK
observing bucket angle. Do loader system and
circuit relief valve test at
LOOK : Bucket must not rollback
page 6-57.
Pilot control valve float With the bucket partially dumped, OK
check lower boom to raise front of Check complete.
machine.
Run engine at low idle. NOT OK
Push control lever to the float
Do pilot control valve
detent position and release lever.
pressure test in group 3.
LOOK : Front of machine lower to
the ground and valve must remain
in float position when lever is
released.
6-32
Item Description Service action
Boom cylinder leakage Dump bucket until teeth or cutting OK
check edge is per pendicular to the Drift is approximately the
ground. same between first and
Heat hydraulic oil to
second measurement.
operating temperature. Raise boom until cutting edge is
about 1 m (3 ft) above ground.
Repair loader control valve
Stop engine. Measure drift from or circuit relief valve.
tooth or cutting edge to ground for
1 minute. NOT OK
If drift is considerably less
Wait 10 minutes.
on second measurement,
Measure drift from tooth or cutting repair cylinder.
edge to ground for 1 minute.
LOOK : Compare the drift rate
between the first measurement
and the second measurement.
Bucket cylinder leakage Raise bucket about 1 m (3 ft) off OK
check ground with bucket level. Drift is approximately the
same between first and
Heat hydraulic oil to Stop engine. Place a support
second measurement.
operating temperature. under boom.
Measure drift from tooth or cutting Repair loader control valve
edge to ground for 1 minute. or circuit relief valve at
page 6-57.
Wait 10 minutes.
Measure drift from tooth or cutting NOT OK
edge to ground for 1 minute. Drift is considerably less
on second measurement.
LOOK : Compare the drift rates
between the first measurement
Repair cylinder.
and the second measurement.
Check valve of safety Put bucket level and position about OK
valve leakage check 1.2 m (4 ft) above ground. Check complete.
Heat hydraulic oil to Place a piece of tape on cylinder
NOT OK
operating temperature. rod at least 51 mm (2 in) from rod
Check or replace safety
guide.
valve.
Run engine at low idle in safety-
release position.
LOOK : Bucket must not drift up.
Pilot control valve Stop engine. Turn key switch to OK
OFF position. Check completed.
(RCV lever) check
Move control lever to all positions
NOT OK
and then release.
Repair pilot control valve.
LOOK : Lever must return to
neutral when released from all
positions.
6-33
Item Description Service action
Bucket leveler Position bucket fully dumped just OK
(positioner) check above ground level. Check complete.
Run engine at low idle. Move control lever to bucket NOT OK
leveler detent position and release. Do bucket leveler checks.
LOOK : Bucket must rollback to
the level position and control lever
must return to neutral.
If bucket is in a rolled back position
when key is turned ON, control
lever must be returned to neutral
manually if placed in the bucket
leveler detent position.
After bucket is dumped once,
bucket leveler will work normally.
Boom height kickout Position bucket flat on ground. OK
check Check complete.
Move control lever to boom raise
Run engine at low idle. detent position and release. NOT OK
Do boom height kickout
LOOK : Boom must raise to the
check.
set height and stop.
Control lever must return to
neutral.
Cycle time check Function Operating condition. Maximum cycle time
H e a t hy d r a u l i c o i l t o Boom raise Bucket flat on ground to full height. 6.7sec
operating temperature.
Boom lower Full height to level ground. 3.0sec
Run engine at high idle.
Bucket dump Boom at full height. 1.4sec
Bucket rollback Boom at full height. 1.9sec
Steering [No. of Frame stop to frame stop. 3.9 turns
turns]
OK
Check complete.
NOT OK
Go to slow hydraulic
functions in group 2.
6-34
※MEASURING BOOM AND BUCKET CYCLE TIME
1) MEASUREMENT CONDITION
·Coolant temperature : Inside operating range
·Steering position : Neutral
·Hydraulic temperature : 40~50˚C
·Bucket : Unloaded
·Engine speed : High idling
2) MEASURING TOOL
· Stop watch (1EA)
3) MEASURING PROCEDURE
(1) LIFTING TIME OF BOOM Lifting time of boom
Set the bucket near the maximum tilt back
position and at the lowest position on the
ground. Raise the bucket and measure
the time taken for bucket to reach the
maximum height of the boom.
78096WE25
78096WE26
6-35
2. TROUBLESHOOTING
※ Diagnose malfunction charts are arranged from most probable and simplest to verify, to least
likely, more difficult to verify. Remember the following steps when troubleshooting a problem :
Faulty pilot control valve (RCV). Do pilot control valve (RCV) pressure
test in group 3.
Binding loader control valve (MCV) Inspect valve.
spool.
Faulty flow amplifier. Check priority valve, orifice of flow
amplifier specification.
6-36
Problem Cause Remedy
No steering or hydraulic Low oil level. Add recommended oil.
function
Failed hydraulic pump. Remove and inspect return filter for
metal pump particles.
No hydraulic functions Failed hydraulic pump. Remove and inspect return filter for
steering normal metal pump particles, or replace the
pump.
Failed line filter. Remove and inspect line filter for RCV.
Faulty safety valve. Safety valve leakage test or ON, OFF
function test.
Stuck open port relief valve. Replace relief valve.
Boom float function Low pilot control pressure. Do pressure reducing valve pressure
does not work test in group 3.
Faulty pilot control valve (RCV). Replace relief valve.
Loader control valve (MCV) spool Do pressure reducing valve pressure
binding in bore. test in group 3.
One hydraulic function Faulty pilot control valve (RCV). Do pilot control valve pressure test.
does not work. Inspect and repair valve.
Stuck open port relief valve. Replace relief valve.
Oil leaking past cylinder packings. Do boom and bucket cylinder leakage
test in group 3.
Blockage in oil lines or valve. Inspect lines for damage.
Disconnect and inspect lines for internal
blockage.
Loader control valve (MCV) spool stuck Inspect and repair valve.
in bore.
Low hydraulic power Leakage within work circuit. Do cylinder drift check in group 2.
Low system relief valve (main relief Do loader system and port relief valve
valve) setting. pressure test in group 3.
Low port relief valve setting. Do loader system and port relief valve
pressure test in group 3.
6-37
Problem Cause Remedy
Function drifts down Leaking cylinders. Do cylinder leakage checks in group 3.
Leaking seals in circuit relief valve (port Inspect seals. Replace relief valve.
relief valve) or valve stuck open.
Leaking loader control valve (MCV). Repair or replace valve section.
Boom drifts up Leakage in boom down spool. Remove and inspect boom down spool.
Boom down does not Safety valve not operated. Operate valve.
work (engine off)
Stuck pilot control valve. Inspect.
Faulty line filter. Remove and inspect filter.
Accumulation not operated. Inspect.
MCV spool stuck. Inspect and repair valve.
Oil overheats Low oil viscosity in hot weather. Use recommended oil.
Excessive load. Reduce load.
Holding hydraulic system over relief. Reduce load.
Leakage in work circuit. Do boom and bucket cylinder leakage
test in group 3.
Plugged fins in oil cooler. Inspect and clean oil cooler.
Internally plugged oil cooler. Do hydraulic oil cooler restriction test.
Incorrect system or circuit relief valve Do loader system and circuit relief valve
setting. pressure test in group 3.
Restriction in oil lines or loader control Inspect for dented or kinked lines.
valve (MCV).
Malfunctioning steering valve. Do hydraulic system restriction test in
group 3.
Leaking system main relief valve. Do hydraulic system restriction test in
group 3.
Remove and inspect valve and seals.
Worn hydraulic pump (internal leakage). Do hydraulic pump performance check
in group 2.
Function drops before Stuck open lift check valve. Do control valve lift check in group 2.
raising when valve is
activated
6-38
Problem Cause Remedy
Hydraulic oil foams Low oil level. Add recommended oil.
Wrong oil. Change to recommended oil.
Water in oil. Change oil.
Loose or faulty suction lines (air leak in Tighten or install new lines.
system).
Remote control valve Leaking plunger seals. Remove, inspect and replace plunger
(RCV) leaking seals.
※ Followings are general precautions for the hydraulic system and equipment.
1) Every structure has its limit of strength and durability. The relief valve is installed to limit the
pressure on the hydraulic equipment and protect various parts of the wheel loader from possible
damage. Therefore, never change the preset pressure of the relief valve unless absolutely
necessary.
2) Since the hydraulic equipment is built with precision, the presence of only the slightest amount of
dust and / or other particles in the hydraulic circuit might cause wear and/or damage, resulting in
unstable functions and/or damage, resulting in unstable functions and/or unexpected accidents.
Therefore, always keep hydraulic oil clean. Periodically, check the filter in the return circuit and
replace the element as necessary.
3) Extract about 200cc of hydraulic oil from the tank as a sample every 6 months. If possible, have it
analyzed by a specialist to confirm that the oil can still be used. Never extract the oil for sampling
until the oil temperature has become the normal operating temperature. Since the replacement
period varies depending on operating conditions, refer to Operator's Manual and change oil.
4) Should the equipment get damaged due to the presence of metal particles and/or foreign matter in
the circuit drain out the hydraulic oil and carry out flushing. Also, replace the filter element and
clean the hydraulic tank. Change the hydraulic oil entirely.
5) When checking the filter, if found metal particles in the element, drain out the hydraulic oil entirely,
flush the whole circuit, and then fill with new oil. The presence of metal particles may indicate
internal damage to the equipment. In such a case, check carefully before flushing, and repair or
replace as required.
6) To add and/or change the hydraulic oil, always use recommended oil. (Refer to the list of
recommended oils and lubricants at page 1-22, Recommended lubricants
lubricants..) Never mix oil of
different makes of kinds.
7) To change the hydraulic oil, use a clean vessel and funnel for pouring it into the tank. Never use
cloth because it might cause the presence of lint in the circuit.
8) When removing the hydraulic equipment, be sure to put plugs or caps on hoses, tube lines and
ports. Also, enter mating marks for later identification.
6-39
9) Disassemble and/or assemble the hydraulic equipment only in a clean place free of dust. When
disassembling, be careful about the interchangeability of parts, and clean the disassembled parts
with pure and clean mineral cleansing oil. Clean the internal passages as well. After the parts
have dried, wipe them off with a clean lint-free cloth.
10) When overhauling the hydraulic equipment replace all O-rings, backup rings, etc. with new ones.
Assemble O-rings with grease or vaseline applied.
11) After installing the equipment, add more hydraulic oil to make up for that lost during disassembly.
12) Tighten joints correctly. Loose joints will cause the hydraulic oil to leak. If the oil leaks, the tank oil
level drops and air gets sucked in, so the pump will break down. Also loose joints in suction lines
will take air in and might cause abnormal noise, malfunction or damage to pumps.
6-40
GROUP 3 TESTS AND ADJUSTMENTS
6-41
5) Start the filter caddy. Check to be sure oil is
flowing through the filters.
Operate filter caddy approximately 10
minutes so oil in hydraulic oil tank is
circulated through filter a minimum of four
times.
※ Hydraulic oil tank capacity : 203ℓ(53.6
U.S. gal)
Leave filter caddy operation for the next
steps.
6) Start the engine and run it at high idle.
※ For the most effective results, cleaning
procedure must start with the smallest
capacity circuit then proceed to the next
largest capacity circuit.
7) Operate all functions, one at a time,
through a complete cycle in the following
order: Clam, steering, bucket, and boom.
Also include all auxiliary hydraulic functions.
Repeat procedure until the total system
capacity has circulated through filter caddy
seven times, approximately 30 minutes.
Each function must go through a minimum
of three complete cycles for a through
cleaning for oil.
※ Filtering time for machines with auxiliary
hydraulic functions must be increased
because system capacity is larger.
8) Stop the engine. Remove the filter caddy.
9) Install a new return filter element.
10) Check oil level in reservoir; Add oil if
necessary.
6-42
2. BOOM HEIGHT KICKOUT ADJUSTMENT
1) Lift the boom up to a desired height, set the
boom control lever at hold, then stop the
engine.
Be careful lest work equipment fall down.
Put the hydraulic safety lever in the LOCK Boom
position.
Proximate switch
7707WE20
Plate
7707WE21
Boom
7707WE22
7809S4OP26
6-43
3. TEST TOOLS
1) CLAMP-ON ELECTRONIC TACHOMETER
INSTALLATION
·Service equipment and tools
B
Tachometer
A : Clamp on tachometer.
Remove paint using emery cloth and
C
connect to a straight section of injection
line within 100 mm (4 in) of pump. Finger
Tighten only-do not over tighten. D
B : Black clip ( - ). Connect to main frame.
C : Red clip (+). Connect to transducer. A
D : Tachometer readout. Install cable.
75795SE32
75795SE33
75795SE35
6-44
4. HYDRAULIC OIL WARM UP PROCEDURE
1) Install temperature reader (see temperature
reader installation procedure in this group).
6-45
5. MAIN HYDRAULIC PUMP FLOW TEST
· SPECIFICATION
Oil temperature 45±5˚C (113±9˚F)
Engine speed 2000±25 rpm
Test pressure 210±5 bar (2990 psi)
Maximum pump flow 242ℓ/min (63.9 gpm)
· FLOW METER GAUGE AND TOOL
To MCV
Gauge 0~35 MPa (0~350 bar, 0~5000 psi) Flow meter
Temperature reader
1) Make test connections.
2) Install temperature reader.
(see temperature reader installation
procedure in this group)
3) Heat hydraulic oil to specifications. Hyd tank
(see hydraulic oil warm up procedure in this
group)
4) Run engine at test specifications.
5) Close flow meter loading valve to increase
pressure to test specifications.
6) Read flow meter.
7) If flow is below specifications, check suction
line and suction pressure for abnormality
before removing pump. 7807AWE24
6-46
6. L
LOADER
ADER SYSTEM AND PORT RELIEF
VALVE PRESSURE TEST
· SPECIFICATION
Oil temperature (40~50˚C)
Relief valve Engine speed Relief pressure
210±5 kg/cm2 U D
System (M) High
(2990±70 psi) R
Boom 240±5 kg/cm2
Low
raise (U) (3410±140 psi)
Bucket 240±5 kg/cm2
Low
rollback (R) (3410±140 psi)
Bucket 240±5 kg/cm2 M
Low
dump (D) (3410±140 psi)
6-47
※ Do not adjust the system relief valve
above 250 kg/cm2 (3560 psi). Damage to
the pump will result from excessive
pressure settings.
6-48
7. HYDRAULIC SYSTEM RESTRICTION TEST
· SPECIFICATION
Oil temperature 45±5˚C (113±9˚F)
Engine speed High idle
Maximum pressure 2MPa (20bar, 285psi) at flow
amplifier.
Maximum pressure at main control valve EF port
1MPa (10bar, 145 psi)
· GAUGE AND TOOL
Gauge 0~7 MPa (0~70 bar, 0~1000 psi) 2EA
This test will check for restrictions in the hydraulic
system which can cause overheating of hydraulic
oil.
Flow amplifier
1) Install temperature reader.
(see temperature reader installation procedure in
this group)
2) Heat hydraulic oil to specifications.
(see hydraulic oil warm up procedure in this
group)
3) Connect fitting and gauge to steering valve.
4) Connect fitting and gauge to main control valve.
Do not operate steering or loader functions or
test gauge may be damaged.
5) Run engine at specification and read pressure T
gauges.
Hyd tank
If pressure is more than specification at the
loader control valve, check for a kinked, dented
or obstructed hydraulic line. Check loader control
valve for a binding spool.
If pressure is more than specification at the
steering unit, inspect neutral condition of the
steering unit and flow amplifier for a stuck spool.
Make sure orifice plugs are installed in ends of
priority valve spool.
Check for plugged orifice in priority valve "LS"
7807AWE68
port and dynamic signal orifice on flow amplifier
body.
6-49
8. LOADER CYLINDER DRIFT TEST
· SPECIFICATION
Oil temperature 45±5˚C (113±9˚F)
Boom horizontal
Bucket horizontal A
Bucket loaded
Item Standard value
Retraction of boom
7 mm B
cylinder rod
Retraction of bucket
11 mm
cylinder rod
A : Retraction of bucket cylinder rod
· GAUGE AND TOOL
B : Retraction of boom cylinder rod
Stop watch
Temperature reader
Put the safety lock lever in the lock
position.
Do not go under the work equipment.
6-50
9. BOOM AND BUCKET CYLINDER LEAKAGE TEST
· SPECIFICATION
Oil temperature 45±5˚C (113±9˚F)
Engine speed Low idle
Maximum leakage 15 mℓ/min (1/2 oz/min)
· GAUGE AND TOOL
Temperature reader
Stop watch
Measuring container
1) Fasten temperature sensor to head end
port of cylinder to be tested. Cover sensor
with a shop towel.
2) Heat hydraulic oil to specifications (see
hydraulic oil warm up procedure in this
group).
Never work under raised equipment
unless it is supported with a hoist or
support stands.
3) Full extend the cylinder to be tested. If
testing the boom cylinders, restrain boom in
the fully raised position using a hoist or a
stand.
※ Check cylinders for leakage in the fully
extended position only. In the retracted
position contacts the end of the cylinder
and seals off piston seal leakage.
4) Remove and plug cylinder rod end hose or
line.
5) Run engine at slow idle. Activate control
lever to extend cylinder for 1 minute over
relief while measuring leakage for open
port.
If leakage is within specification, excessive
cylinder drift is caused by leakage in the
(770-3ATM) 6-56
loader control valve or circuit relief valve.
6-51
10. PILOT CONTROL VALVE P
PRESSURE
RESSURE TEST
· SPECIFICATION
Oil temperature 45±5˚C (113±9˚F)
Engine speed Low idle
Begin metering 1/4" of lever travel
Pressure in detent :
Boom float detent 1.9 MPa (19 bar)
Pressure at feel position :
Boom power down 19~22bar
Boom raise 19~22bar
Bucket rollback 19~22bar
Bucket dump 19~22bar
· GAUGE AND TOOL
Gauge 0~7 MPa (0~70 bar, 0~1000 psi)
As the control lever is moved from neutral,
the pilot pressure will suddenly jump up to
approximately 6.5bar at 1/4in. travel. The
pressure should then increase smoothly to
the specification at the FEEL position (or
3/4 lever travel), and then jump up about
30bar as the lever is moved into detent.
This test will determine if adequate pilot
pressure is available to move the loader
control valve spools.
※ The FEEL position is when lever is
moved to feel the ramp of the detent
before lever passes into detent position.
1) Lower boom to ground.
2) Connect gauge to the pilot pressure port of
function to be checked.
3) Install temperature reader (see temperature
reader installation procedure in this group).
4) Heat hydraulic oil to specification (see
hydraulic oil warm up procedure in this
7809S6WE35
group).
6-52
5) Run engine at specification. Activate
function to be checked and record pressure
reading.
※ If boom raise or bucket rollback FEEL
positions are not operation due to boom
or bucket position, plug boom float detent
wires into bucket leveler solenoid or
boom height kickout solenoid. This will
provide a feel position on the control
lever.
6-53
11. CYCLE TIME TEST
· SPECIFICATION
Oil temperature 45±5˚C (113±9˚F)
Engine speed High idle
Function Operating conditions Maximum cycle time (seconds)
Boom raise Bucket flat on ground to full height 6.7
Boom lower (float) Full height to ground level 3.0
Bucket dump Boom at full height 1.4
Bucket rollback Boom at full height 1.9
Steering (number of turns) Frame stop to stop 3.9 turns
6-54
12. HYDRAULIC OIL FILTER INSPECTION
PROCEDURE
1) Lower the bucket to the ground, stop the
engine, move the control lever back and
forth several times, and clean all over the
upper surface of the hydraulic oil tank.
2) Remove the bolts and take out the filter
case cover and O-ring.
3) Remove the spring and bypass valve.
Cover
4) Remove the filter element from the tank. O-ring
Spring
5) Check the element and the filter case By-pass valve
bottom for debris. Excessive amounts of
Return filter
brass and steel particles can indicate a
failed hydraulic pump or a pump failure in
process. A rubber type of material can
indicated cylinder packing or other packing
failure.
※ The hydraulic oil filter in the filter case of
the hydraulic oil tank should be replaced
every 250 operating hours or more often.
When the filter element is replaced,
please keep as follows.
(1) Clean the inside of the filter case.
(2) Place new element in the proper positions
inside the filter case.
(3) Install the bypass valve and spring.
Make sure the element stand upright, and
check for complete contact of the element
bottom with the filter case bottom.
(4) Install the O-ring and filter case covers.
Tighten them with bolt. Replace the
7809S6MI24
O-ring with new one if damaged.
6-55
GROUP 4 DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
P2 CARTRIDGE
27
34 39
35 1
20 26
17 21 22
16 21
P1 CARTRIDGE 19
7807WE28
6-56
STRUCTURE (2/2)
37
8
36 28
29
7
9
11
6
10
32
25
30
24
31
12
33
5 11
23
4
3
13
2
14
15
P2 CARTRIDGE P1 CARTRIDGE
7807AWE29
6-57
2) GENERAL INSTRUCTION
(1) Preliminary
※ Any servicing work done on main pump is to be done in a clean environment to prevent potential
contamination by foreign particles.
※ Appropriate tools and equipment are required in order to insure proper disassembly and
reassembly in suitable conditions. In case of repetitive service, a specific working bench is
recommended.
※ To prevent oil leakage and body tilting during assembly, housing bolts are to be tightened as per
the following pattern.
1 3 3 1
5 6
7 4
4 2 2
7803AWE05
(2) Parts
※ Parts must be kept clean at all time. If cleaning is needed, solvent is to be used. It is needed to
check and oil the inner parts before assembly.
※ In case of replacement of parts with mulitiple numbers, such as vanes and holdout pins, all the
parts are to be changed.
① Vanes
The faces and edges should be free of scratch from contamination. Vanes should move
smoothly in the rotor slots, without excessive clearance. Edges may be stoned with a fine lndia
stone to remove burrs.
② Vane holdout pins :
Holdout pins should have no matting marks.
Vane
Rotor
Pin
7803AWE50
③ Rotor :
Side surfaces and vane slots should be free of scratches. Side feeds, vane slots and holdout pin
orifices should be free of any contamination. Serration(driving splines) should not be deformed
by the shaft.
7803AWE51
6-58
④ Camring :
No scratches or vane shock marks(waves) should be seen. Visual axial waves on new camring
are from grinding process and therefore normal.
7803ASE06
⑤ Port plates :
Faces should not be scratched. No cavitation/aeration/fretting corrosion marks should be seen.
When there, the bronze bushing should be clean, with no abnormal wear sign.
※ Bi-directional cartridges use same port plates for CW and CCW rotation. Unit-directional
cartridges require different port plates.
7803ASE08
⑥ Seals :
· All oil seals must be cleaned, with no wear or cutting mark. When servicing a pump from field
operation, it is highly recommended to change all seals. All seals are to be greased lightly
before assembly.
· Use seal driver tool to install shaft seal, and protective cone to install shaft assembly.
· Backup rings (1) on pressure plates are to be replaced, anytime a cartridge is taken out of a
pump. Backup rings are to be installed as follow, behind the square seal :
7803ASE07
⑦ Shaft :
· Key-way should be clean and not worn on the sides by excessive torque. No fretting corrosion
due to poor coupling should be visible. On spline shaft, splines should not be deformed.
· No axial scratch should be on the sealing area (1). The shaft seal lip contact line may be visible,
but should not be a groove. Bronze-bushing contact area (2) should be clean and cylindrical,
without scratch marks.
6-59
2 4 1
7803ASE10
· Ball bearing (3) should turn freely and snap ring (4) should be in place. Some shaft assemblies
have 2 snap rings, before and after the ball bearing.
※ Never insert a snap ring from shaft seal side, to avoid scratching the sealing surface.
※ Use protective cone to install shaft assembly. If not available, make sure not to damaged the
shaft seal lips.
(3) Pre start check and priming.
① Before operating the pump again, the following points are to be checked :
· Pump rotation is as per electric motor or engine.
· All fittings are properly connected and tight. No oil-leak and/or air intake being allowed.
· If any, valve on suction line is to be fully opened.
② When electric motor or engine is started up, the pump should prime immediately. However,
depending on installation and amount of air in the discharge lines, priming may take a few
seconds.
③ In case priming does not occur within 15 seconds, equipment should be switched off at once.
· Then :
· Manually fill the pump housing with fluid.
· Bleed off air that may be trapped in the pump.
· Check air bleed-off valves.
· Start rotation in a jogging manner until a prime is picked up.
6-60
3) DISASSEMBLY
(1) Install the pump on the table.
※ Two bolts will help to unscrew the 4 pump
bolts.
(2) Unscrew the bolts.
7707WE31
7707WE32
6-61
(4) Disassemble the P2 cartridge/end cap
with an extractor.
※ If you want to continue the pump disasse-
mbly (P1 & shaft), go to page 6-63.
※ If you want to reassemble the P2 cartrid-
ge, go to page 6-64.
7707WE33
7707WE34
7707WE35
6-62
(7) Remove the front cap.
※ P1 cartridge will come with the front cap /
shaft assembly.
7707WE36
7707WE37
7707WE38
6-63
(9) The pump is now disassembled.
4) ASSEMBLY
(1) Fit the cartridge P1 into the housing.
7707WE40
7707WE41
6-64
A : Protective cone on the shaft assembly.
B : Shaft assembly + protective cone into the
front cap. Slightly rotate the shaft to avoid C
the shaft seal lip(s) to be deteriorated.
C : Retaining ring into the front cap.
※ To avoid damaging the shaft seal do not
B
forget to put a protective cone on the
shaft.
※ Push on the external bearing cage.
※ If the shaft Ø is bigger than the shaft seal
Ø, please contact HYUNDAI.
7707WE42
7707WE43
6-65
① Always check if the shaft rotates freely.
If not, disassemble and go back to the 19.1kgf .m(138lbf .ft)
previous step.
② Check the porting configuration.
③ Tighten the 4 bolts.
1 4
Step by step to
avoid damaging
the seals.
3 2
7707WE45
6-66
(6) Assemble the end cap on the housing
assy.
※ Position the shaft / front cap assy only if
the cartridge is well positioned, dowel pin
in the housing dowel pin hole.
※ Put some grease on the seals to prevent
them from moving.
※ Always check if the shaft rotates freely.
If not, disassemble and go back to the
previous step.
7707WE46
1 4 1 4
6 7
3 2
3 2 5
6-67
2. MAIN CONTROL VALVE
1) STRUCTURE
10 17
7 9
7
11
12
16
13
10
6
14
17
5
7
8
2 15
4.2kgf.m(30.4lbf.ft)
6
2
7707WE50
6-68
2) DISASSEMBLY AND ASSEMBLY
※ Ensure that the machine is in a safe condition with no suspended loads or trapped pressure within
the system before removing any pipework or component.
Servicing must only be carried out by trained personel.
(1) MAIN RELIFE VALVE (Item 2)
① Removal
Unscrew both the pilot assembly and the plug from both ends of the relief valve. The main stage
assembly must be driven or pressed out in the direction of the pilot assembly using a soft drift.
Refitting
② Lubricate sleeve and assemble by pressing into housing until detent ring (12) locates on
housing.
Fit the pilot assembly and end cap.
③ Adjusting
The main relief valve must be adjusted to the required setting when the machine is
recommissioned.
Adjustment is made by first unscrewing the adjuster (1) until there is no load on the pilot spring
(10).
Select a machine service to its end stop.
Screw in the adjuster until the correct pressure setting is measured at the valve inlet, account
must be taken for the effect of back pressure on the measured setting.
8
1
16
3 15.5kgf.m(112lbf.ft)
14
10
5
Pil
ot 7
as
sy
9
12
17
4
6
Ma 15
in 13
sta 11
ge 14
as
sy 2
15.5kgf.m(112lbf.ft)
7707WE51
6-69
(2) DOUBLE ACTING SPOOL (Item 3, 4)
4
Control spools are not replaceable as 3
they are individually sized to suit the 2
housing. Bucket spool
8
3.1kgf.m(22.4lb.ft)
2
3
6
10
1 5
3.1kgf.m(22.4lb.ft)
6
9
7
16
4
12
9 15
9.7kgf.m(70.2lb.ft)
17
9.7kgf.m(70.2lb.ft)
7707WE53
6-70
(4) BOOM SPOOL CENTERING (Item 6)
Remove 4 retaining screws (8) from the spring centering end. Remove the cover (1) and withdraw
the spring pack and spool from the valve.
Hold the spool in a suitable soft clamp being careful not to damage the spool surface or bend the
spool. Remove the spool caps from the spool. The replacement assembly is supplied with the
spring set to the correct load. Refit the spool caps to the specified torque using loctite 542 or similar
medium strength oil tolerant thread locking product.
16
15
17
2
6
8
10,11,13
1
3
6
3.1kgf.m(22.4lbf. ft) 9
7
18
5 4
12
17
15
9.7kgf.m(70.2lbf. ft) 16
9.7kgf.m(70.2lbf. ft)
9
19
14
7707WE54
6-71
(5) COMBINED OVERLOAD AND ANTI-CAVITATION (Item 7)
This is a non servicable item and a replacement unit factory set to the correct setting should be fitted.
Inspect seat in valve housing for damage before refitting.
10
5 3
12
6
9
15 14
13
10
9.7kgf.m(70.2lbf.ft)
2
4
8
11
8.7kgf.m(62.9lbf.ft)
1
7
3.1kgf.m(22.4lbf.ft)
7707WE55
2
4
3 5
0.51kgf.m(3.7lbf.ft)
6-72
(7) CHECK VALVE ASSEMBLY (Item 9, 16)
This is a non servicable item and a 7
replacement unit should be fitted. 1
Ensure that orifice in check valve (1) is
6
clear when refitting. Inspect seat in float 5
check block for damage before refitting. 4
8
1 Float check valve 6 Spring 2
2 Housing 7 Composite piston seal
4 O-ring 8 O-ring
5 Back up ring
7.6kgf.m(55lbf.ft)
7707WE57
15
12
11
10
7
9
6
8
5
3
4
17 2
16
1
7707WE58
6-73
(9) PILOT OPERATED FLOAT CHECK BLOCK ASSEMBLY (Item 11)
Remove the three retaining screws (2)
and lift the block from the main housing. 2 3
Do not slide the block accross the face as
this may damage the sealing face and 1 3
seals. 78
8 7
6
3 3
4 5
1 Float check block 5 O-ring
2 Cap head screw 6 Plug
3 Plug 7 O-ring
4 O-ring 8 Plug
7707WE59
3
4
2
1
1 Adapter
2 Socket set screw
3 Check valve
4 O-ring
7707WE60
1
1 Seat
2 Metric ball
3 O-ring
7707WE61
6-74
(12) A/C CHECK VALVE ASSEMBLY (Item
14)
This is a non servicable item and a
replacement unit should be fitted. Inspect
4
seat in float check block for damage
before refitting. 2
3
1 Body 4 Piston seal 5
2 Check valve 5 O-ring
3 Spring 1
7707WE62
13
12
0.51kgf.m(3.7lbf.ft)
11
10 4.6kgf.m(33.2lbf.ft)
7
9
68 16
5
4
15
14
16
3
1
2
7707WE63
6-75
3. REMOTE CONTROL VALVE
1) STRUCTURE
36
45 13
38 15
37 14
16
33 8
5
34
9
7
41,42,43,44 35 6
4
32
12
27
26 28 11
1,3,4 1 10
4
25 3 2
3
2
29 T
24 30 4 1
31 3 2
1,3,4
2 1
23
46
4 1
22 49 49
3 2
20 47 47
19 19
21 48
18 48
1,3,4
2
39,40,41,42
17
7809S6WE48
6-76
2) DISASSEMBLY
(1) Remove the boots (32) and loosen nut
(31).
· Tool : spanner 19 mm
7607BRCV01
7607BRCV02
7607BRCV03
6-77
(3) Disassemble plate kit.
7607BRCV04
7607BRCV05
7607BRCV06
7607BRCV07
6-78
(7) Disassemble magnet (18) and rod stopper
(15).
7607BRCV08
7607BRCV09
7607BRCV10
7607BRCV11
6-79
(11) Disassemble plug (2).
· Tool : Wrench 10 mm
7607BRCV12
6-80
3) ASSEMBLY
(1) Coat oil on O-ring and mount plug (3) into
body assembly (1).
7607BRCV13
7607BRCV14
7607BRCV15
7607BRCV16
6-81
(5) Assemble plug kit.
7607BRCV17
7607BRCV09
Important
7607BRCV19
7607BRCV20
6-82
(9) Assemble plate (19).
7607BRCV21
7607BRCV22
7607BRCV23
7607BRCV24
6-83
(12) Assemble plate kit.
Put a bit of grease on rod (17) and Joint
(21).
7607BRCV04
7607BRCV03
7607BRCV02
6-84
(14) Assembled nut (31).
· Tool : spanner 19 mm
· Tightening torque (M12) :
40±4 kgf·cm (28±28.9 lbf·ft)
7607BRCV01
7607BRCV25
6-85
SECTION 7 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
1. LOCATION 1
15
3
12
25 24
5 22
4
23
14 16
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 17 18 19 20 21
M
A
7809S7EL02
1 Beacon switch (opt) 10 T/M shift mode switch 19 Parking brake switch
2 Rear wiper / washer switch 11 Clutch cut off mode switch 20 Ride control switch (opt)
3 Mirror defrost switch 12 Multi function switch 21 Differential lock switch
4 Emergency test switch (opt) 13 Horn switch 22 Machine control unit (MCU)
5 Fan control switch 14 Monitor 23 T/M control unit (TCU)
6 Main light switch 15 Radio & USB player 24 Engine control unit (ECU)
7 Work lamp switch 16 Aircon & heater switch 25 USB socket
8 Kick down switch 17 Starting switch
9 Hazard switch 18 Engine mode switch
7-1
2. LOCATION 2
1 2 3 4
OFF
11 12
13
6 7 8 9 10
7809S7EL02-1
7-2
CABIN-ROOF HARNESS
PTC
AC HARNESS
·ELECTRICAL
1
2
3
WITH PTC
REAR
OPTION
RELAY
CN-244A
STEER
WIPER
HI
AC
HEAT
UNIT
LOW
TIMER
LAMP
DIFF.
LAMP
REAR
LOCK
WORK
HORN
WORK
FRONT
RELAY
WIPER
RELAY
WIPER
RELAY
RELAY
MIRROR
EMERGENCY
RELAY
A
B
C
FLASHER
AC SYSTEM GND
BLOWER RELAY
SW2
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
GND 1
86
86
85
85
AC 24V
ILLUMINATION
WIPER SWITCH
WIPER SWITCH
WIPER SWITCH
Pf
NC
NC
B
E
MIRROR HEAT
MIRROR HEAT SWITCH
AC CONTROLLER B+
BEACON LAMP
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
EMERGENCY TEST SW
AC OPERATE SIGNAL
3
3
3
3
3
3
SWITCH ATT. LOCK
5
5
5
5
5
5
SWITCH ATT. UNLOCK
BOOM POSITION SELECT
WIPER SWITCH
NC
REVERCE SW_AUTO
REVERCE SW_ON
CASSETTE_ILLUMINATION
PTC POWER
30
30
AC COMP
G
IG
A
Hi 4
2
3
Lo 5
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
3
OUT
87 87a
87 87a
1
3
2
4
4
4
2
2
2
2
2
2
6
1
1
1
1
1
1
3
3
3
3
3
3
5
14
7
13
5
10
10
1
87a
87a
4
3
2
1
5
5
5
5
5
5
15
13
14
15
2
4
4
4
4
4
4
9
5
3
6
8
3
12
11
12
11
B 85
86
86
8
1
6
9
7
1
85
85
30
30
L 87
87
87
E 86
2
2
A
1
B
7
4
6
C
2
5
8
3
CN-7
CN-102
CR-79
CR-4
CR-2
CR-3
CR-55
CN-244
CR-26
CR-7
CR-37
CN-245
CR-11
CN-11
CN-9
L
L
L
L
L
L
B
Y
Y
Y
B
B
V
Y
B
Y
B
Y
B
V
B
CR-56
V
B
Y
V
B
R
R
R
R
R
G
G
G
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Br
Br
Br
Br
Gr
Gr
Gr
Gr
Or
Gr
5L
5B
WITHOUT PTC
YW
BW
VW
BW
RW
RW
RW
RW
GW
YOr
ROr
BrW
WOr
OrW
300
314
315
310
307
306
311
214
211
462
467
460
230
245
242
140
144
141
130
134
131
436
435
GW 500
RW 501
251
250
254
460
WOr 120
254
251
293
333
332
335
GOr 771
RW 770
520
LW 590
YOr 160
332
333
790
791
114
233
234
235
160
237
G02
G02
G01
G01
G08
G09
310B
310A
210A
230A
420A
426A
300A
300B
440D
WOr 690C
ELECTRICAL CIRCUIT (1/2)
G01F
G01E
G01C
G01D
G01G
240 2.0
G11 2.0
131 1.25
141 1.25
131 1.25
230 0.85
2.0
2.0
2.0
2.0
2.0
0.85
314
315
307
310
311
211
462
245
242
144
134
W 307
440A
1 WIPER MOTOR-LOW
GROUP 2 ELECTRICAL CIRCUIT
R 315
2 WIPER MOTOR-HI
G 311
43 WIPER RY_LOW
Y 310
4 WIPER SW_LOW
520
590
160
Br 314
42 WIPER SW_HI
Y 629
9 RS232 RX 2-MONITOR
L 623
10 RS232 TX 2-MONITOR
GBr 624
37 PROGRAM DUMP-MONITOR
Y 625
CR-59 38 RS232 RX-CLUSTER
Br 422 L 626
86 30 87a 39 RS232 TX-CLUSTER
B G01 RY 627
85 50 PROGRAM DUMP-CLUSTER
RIDE-
87
OrW 216
86
85 87 87a
CONTROL
Br 217 L 251A
SPEED RY
30 13 MIRROR HEATED
Gr 650
14 CLUSTER_BATT. 24V
Or 570C
CR-60 18 SHIFT LEVER_IG
V 580
86 30 87a 27 CLUSTER_ IG
L 425 RW 935
85 6 LAMP-JOYSTICK STR
RIDE-
Br 217 GOr 930
87 15 TCU_ED6-NEU.
W 426 LW 920
86 16 TCU_ED5-REV.
85 87 87a LOr 421 BrW 910
30 17 TCU_ED4-FWD.
435 WOr 451A
CONTROL RY
21 SHIFT LEVER_KD
425 ROr 915
CR-58 22 TCU_ED1
426 GrW 925
2 3 4 23 TCU_ED2
G 193 193 VOr 905
1 24 TCU_ED3
BrW 191 540
5
RELAY
Or 190
2
BACK-UP
1 5 4 190A OrW 150 1.25
3
Or MAIN SWITCH_ILL
33
G 180 2.0
34 MAIN SWITCH_HEAD
TO SHEET 2 OF 2
RELAY
5 32 MULTI_HEAD LAMP_HI
GW 202 202
2
1 5 4 Or 190B
3
STOP LAMP
CR-25
RW 501
86 30 87a 30 FLASHER_L
B G01A B 795
85 12 GROUND_SHIELD
Y 620 L 790
87 7 CAN2 LOW
RELAY
RW 531 Y 791
86 8 CAN2 HI
85 87 87a R 530B LOr 303
30 40 MCU_INT
Gr 305 305
ECM POWER
41 MCU & WASHER
Gr 305A
CR-35
Br 300C
86 30 87a 45 FUSE BOX
B G01 Y 134
85 46 WORK LAMP SWITCH
Gr 550 2.0 VW 144
87 47 WORK LAMP SWITCH
RELAY
RW 531 531 Or 505
POWER
86 28 RH TURN
85 87 87a R 530 2.0 530A GOr 506
30 29 LH TURN
534 BrW 740
57 5V_POWER
WOr 690
CR-38 58 GND_SENSOR
LOr 754
2 3 4 59 TM MODE
R 540 BW 755
CAN2 BUS
1 60 CLUTCH_MODE
335
305
LW 538A
G02A
G02B
5
Or 570 G16
RELAY
2 1
1 5 4 Or 570 RY 627
1
1
2
2
4
NEUTRAL
3
L 626
CN-22
3
PUMP
M
M
CN-103
538 Y 625
CN-127C
CR-5 2
WASHER
86 30 87a
VW 539 539 G16
85 1
G 535 GBr 624
87 4
RELAY
LW 538 L
SAFETY
86
623 3
85 87 87a GOr 534
CN-127B
Y 629 CN-126
30 2
G16
D BATTERY(-)
BW 560
CR-46 J BATTERY(+)
G 993E
86 30 87a E CAN_Hi
L 380 V 994E
85 F CAN_Lo
FUEL
2LW 381 Y 791
87 G CAN2_Hi
RELAY
SERVICE TOLL
Y 370A L 790
86 H CAN2_Lo
WARMER
85 87 87a 2Y 370
30
G16 1
R 781 786
2 B MCU_RS232_RX
Br 782 787
CR-36 3 C MCU_RS232_TX
CONNECTOR_MCU & CAN
W 780 785
2 3 4 4 A MCU_RS232 P_DUMP
CAN BUS
RELAY
5
RW 372 372
2
CN-127
1 5 4
PRE-HEAT
CN-127A
Y 373 373
3
CN-58A
G16B
A13 GND(MAIN)
CN-36 G16A
A14 GND(MAIN)
MCU
7-3
A23 WIPER INT SIG
610 Gr 305
A31 WASH SIG
621
A38 SPARE_DIGITAL INPUT_LOW
L 380
B14 FUEL WARMER
Y 620 Gr 235
A35 AC CONDENSOR FAN SIGNAL
20A ECM_IG Br 621 W 234
9 B15 AC COMP. OFF SIG_REVERSE FAN
Gr 550 630 Or 233
A16 BLOWER RUN SIGNAL_DINP
10A MCU BW 560 560
10 A24 SPARE_HIGH SOURCE
A26 SPARE_LOW_ENGINE OIL LOW
10A TCU Or 570 570B
11 B40 BOOM POSITION SENSOR
570C
B30 BUCKET POSITION SENSOR
10A CLUSTER V 580 580 BrW 740
12 A01 REF. POWER +5V
650
A37 MECHANICAL ENGINE SELECT
10A CASSETTE LW 590 BW 560
13 A11 POWER IG(+24V)
A12 BATTERY POWER(+24V)
10A SPARE GW 630
14 A02 BATTERY POWER(+24V)
LOr 154
B09 DETENT CONTROL_BUCKET
5A ILLUMINATION 1 YOr 160 160A
35 B08 DETENT CONTROL_BOOM UP
390
B19 DETENT CONTROL_BOOM DOWN
5A ILLUMINATION 2 Or 170 170
36 A30 COUNT_WEIGHT_SET SWITCH
A39 SPARE_ENGINE SPEED SENSOR
BrW 740
A29 SPARE-DIGITAL INPUT-LOW
WOr 690B
A40 SPARE_SPEED PULSE
CS-55 LOr 754
B31 TM MODE SELECT SIG
B G21 BW 755
12 B28 CLUTCH CUT OFF_SLT SIG
2 1 BW 261
2 B32 ENGINE POWER MODE SELEET
Y 423 BrW 740
10 B22 SPARE_PR SIGNAL
4 Br 217 WOr 690
8 9 B05 SPARE_HOUR METER
10 8 B06 SPARE_D_OUT_HIGH
3 WOr 690C
7 A28 SPARE-DIGITAL INPUT-LOW
7 6 WOr 420
9 6 B33 SPARE-DIGITAL INPUT-LOW
423 RW 770
B23 REVERSE FAN MODE-ON
BrW 424 424 GOr 771
4 B34 REVERSE FAN MODE-AUTO
LOr 421
3 A15 BOOM POSITION SELECT SIGNAL
RIDE CONTROL SW
Or 170F
1 A25 BUCKET POSITION SELECT SIGNAL
12 11 W 780
11 A27 PROGRAM DUMP
R 781
A19 RS-232(1) RX
CS-17 Br 782
A09 RS-232(1) TX
B G21B WOr 757
12 A21 RS-232 GND
12
Or 170B Br 758
11 A10 RS-232(2) TX
R 759
10 A20 RS-232(2) RX
10
8
9 CN-134 A06 SPARE-DIGITAL INPUT-HIGH
4
ROr 340C Or 570A
8 1
9
ROr 340B Or 800
7
7 2
3
W 801 CN-58B
4
3
LW 350 CN-157
6
DIAGNOSTIC
4
Y 352 B G17
3 1 VM1-GND
PARKING SW
G17A
TCU
1 2 VM2-GND 14
11
12
Or 800
15 SDDK-DIAGNOSTIC 16
W 801
18 EUPR-DIAGNOSTIC 33
CS-79 Or 570A
6 NC 34
12
B G21A Y 352
21 ED10-PARKING BRAKE SW(+) 35
1
12
10 25 CANF_H 48
0,2
Or 570D V 994
5 26 CANF_L 50
4
B 995 995
6 28 VGS-CAN SHIELD 53
6
9: AUTO
GW 671
7 36 SD4-SPEED METER CLUSTER 54
600A
3: MANUAL
10 3
8 23 VPE1-CONTINUANCE 24V 58
5
Or 570 570
4 45 VPI-POWER IG 61
DIFF LOCK SW
12
W 820
19 EF1-SPEED PICK-UP ENG
B 810A
27 CANF_T
RW 825
CN-125 41 EF2-SPEED PICK-UP TURBIN
GW 630 B 810B 850A
BATTERY(+) 1 12 VPS1-GEAR BOX VPS1(+)
BW 560 WOr 830
KEY IG(24V) 2 42 EF3-SPEED PICK-UP GEAR
G 840
NC 3 4 VMG2-SPEED SENSOR OUTPUT
UNIT
R 759 V 845
SERIAL "1"_L(RX) 4 62 EF4-SPEED SENSOR(SIG)
Br 758 VW 850 850
REMOTE
VOr 905
20 ED3-SHIFT LEVER-X1A-B3
CR-40 BrW 910
43 ED4-SHIFT LEVER X2B-FWD
86 30 87a ROr 915
OrW 746 746 63 ED1-SHIFT LEVER X1C-B1
85 LW 920
B G19 64 ED5-SHIFT LEVER X2C-REV
87 GrW 925
V 360 65 ED2-SHIFT LEVER X1B-B2
86 GOr 930
85 87 87a 67 ED6-SHIFT LEVER X2D-NEU
GrW 365
BUCKET RY
V 360 31 ED13-REV-JOYSTICK
2 DO-4 LOr 447
366 VOr 30 ED12-NEU-JOYSTICK
1 GrW 448
360 V 44 ED8-FWD-JOYSTICK
2 VOr 450
NC 14 59 ED15-JOYSTICK SELLECTER(+)
WOr 451
NC 15
V 360 360 W 426
24V(DETEND) 1 8 VPS2-RIDE CONT. RY(+)
Gr 440 440 R 540
24V(HANDLE) 9 52 ADM1-START INTERLOCK RY(-)
WOr 449 449 G 193
REV 2 5 ADM4-REVERSE DRIVE RY(-)
GrW 448 448 700 L 425
FWD 3 57 ADM5-RY RIDE CONT.(-)
LOr 447 447 945 Y 435
NEUTRAL 4 11 ADM6-RY DIFF LOCK(-)
CN-246
COUNT_WEIGHT SW16
YW 214B
HORN SWITCH 11
Or 170D
ILLUMINATION 12
B G19
FNR SWITCH 13
CN-160
8.0
8.0
5.0
L
Y
W
280
270
210
260
B G21
L
B
Y
B
B
B
V
V
V
V
B
V
Y
B
V
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
G
G
G
G
G
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
W
Br
Br
Br
Gr
Or
Or
Gr
Or
Or
Gr
LW
LW
LW
LW
YW
VW
VW
YW
RW
RW
LOr
RW
RW
RW
RW
LOr
RW
GW
VOr
YOr
YOr
YOr
ROr
ROr
GOr
GOr
GOr
BrW
BrW
BrW
OrW
WOr
WOr
OrW
WOr
OrW
B G19
EARTH
GOr 534
531
530
531
890
900
865
885
895
880
850
870
860
855
875
531
2LW 381
350
112
112
112
112
103
112
112
202
675
672
700
610
621
830
825
820
810
845
840
945
940
746
743
360
660
661
211
462
715
705
725
710
721
720
730
680
394
358
141
506
505
170
390
184
187
740
436
191
200
535
216
422
237
245
242
373
371
372
656
655
810B
810A
570B
440A
690A
160A
426A
995C
994C
993C
B G22
B
B
B
B
B
R
R
R
2.0
G
Or
3.0
3.0
3.0
3.0
3.0
3.0
3.0
RW
B G20
3
3
9
8
7
6
9
8
7
6
4
1
4
1
5
5
2
2
280
270
220
ROr 210
260
220
WOr 690
BW 261
BrW 740
G20
G20
G22
48
47
46
45
44
43
36
41
40
39
38
37
32
35
34
33
42
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
14
13
15
17
16
19
18
12
11
10
13
60
20
44
26
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
43
42
41
36
29
37
22
21
23
24
33
35
34
32
31
30
58
28
27
57
25
38
40
39
59
19
18
17
16
15
14
12
11
10
170E
G22B
G22A
CN-5
CN-6
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
1
3
2 2
2
2
1 1
1
HORN
5
4
2
6
1
3
A
B
C
SHIELD
CL-2
CS-2
PARKING
CN-139
AC R/DRY
AC R/DRY
TUU_GND
CN-172
AC COMP.
CN-171
CS-80
TCU_(5V+)
B
CN-138
FUSE MAXI
FUSE MAXI
FUSE MAXI
FUSE MAXI
FUSE MAXI
FUSE MAXI
FUSE MAXI
ECM-J1939-
STOP LAMP
REAR LAMP
ECM-J1939+
0, I
12V
24V
SENSOR_24V
2.5
GND
START RELAY
SERVICE
TUN LAMP_LH
SERVICE
FUEL SENDER
BACK BUZZER
TUN LAMP_RH
MAIN PUMP PS
ALTERNATOR I
GROUND_MCU
HEAD LIGHT HI
GEAR BOX - Y1
GEAR BOX - Y2
GEAR BOX - Y3
GEAR BOX - Y4
GEAR BOX - Y5
GEAR BOX - Y6
FUEL WARMER
ATT. LOCK SOL
PILOT CUT-OFF
ECM POWER IG
DIFF. LOCK SOL
REF. POWER 5V
SOCKET SOCKET
GEAR BOX TEMP
HEAD LIGHT LOW
PRE-HEAT RELAY
12V
HYD TEMP SENSER
4
STEERING PUMP PS
RIDE CONTROL SOL.
SPEED SENSOR_24V
FILTER RESTRICTION
SENSOR_STOP LAMP
H0 I
4
3
2
JUMP WIRE-JOYSTICK
6
5
AIR CLEANER SWITCH
BOOM UP PR SENSOR
ECM-AIR HEATER OUT
24V
BATTERY RELAY(DO-1)
SEERING PUMP RELAY
SEERING PUMP RELAY
BR ACC H
SPEED SENSOR_EF4(2)
C
PRO-PORTIONAL VALVE
PRO-PORTIONAL VALVE
PRO-PORTIONAL VALVE
PROXIMITY SWITCH_24V
BOOM POSITION SWITCH
CIGAR
FAN REVERSAL SOL CONTORL
PRESSURE SENSOR_JOYSTICK
CLUTCHBRAKE PEDALSENSING
24V_SENSOR-CLUTCH CUT-OFF
12V SOCKET
SWITCH
SWITCH
START KEY
FRAME HARNESS
DC/DC CONVERTER
ECONO MODE
7809S7EL01
·ELECTRICAL
ELECTRICAL CIRCUIT (2/2)
CN-94
RW 375 GRID HEATER ACTUATOR SIGNAL
OFF IDLE 10
5 GOr 374 DIFF.LOCK
11 GRID HEATER / SWITED OUTPUT RETURN
FEED BACK USB PLAYER(WITH H./FREE) POWER CONNECT SUB CONNECTOR
LINEAR THROTTLE
19 COOLENT LEVEL RETURN P.SENSOR
3 - S+ AUTO REVERSE FAN EMERGENCY TEST
7 COOLENT LEVEL SW +5 SUPPLY
REMOCON GND
12
CN-162
12
12
5
6 COOLENT LEVEL LOW SWITCH DIFF.LOCK 4 3
REMOCON+
6 5 COOLENT LEVEL HIGH SWITCH SOL. CN-20 0,2
BACK UP+
TEL MUTE
AUX_GND
ASSEMBLY
USB GND
YOr 646 G56
ANT 12V
Pa
USB D+
1
USB 5V
5 2
USB D-
31P OEM
AUX_R
AUX_L
Or 645 213
GND
ACC
CN-93
ILL+
1 2 0 1
CN-79
4
CD-79
ILL-
NC
NC
NC
NC
CS-73
CS-75
GW 644 YOr 646
11
4 11
CN-27A
4
6 10
CN-27
9
8 7
C
A
B
3 03 OFF IDLE SW
HORN
2
1
ON IDLE L 643 Or 645
10
11
12
11
10
12
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
2
9
CN-25
9
13
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1
3
3
1
ON IDLE SW
6 W 642 W 642 G56A
1 49 ACCEL POSITION RTN- 2
WOr
OrW
L 643 213A
GOr
YOr
RW
OEM PORT 50P
LW
RW
47 1
G57
ACCEL POSITION SIG.
WOr
Or
BW
685
694
357
438
GOr
W
Gr
R
B
B
GW 644
CN-6 48 ACCEL POSITION SUPPLY 5V
G 990 G 647 213 CL-3
ECM-J1939+ 7 09 SWITCH RETURN
V 991 G 990 179
CN-252
DIFF.
LOCK
G60D
G60C
46 Lo
G60E
ECM-J1939- 8 J1939 (+) 6
163C
163B
163A
B 992 V 991 189A
G60
G60
2
1
4
5
6
3
774
696
775
461
591
523
524
521
163
525
526
513
514
515
516
517
518
519
ECM-J1939 SHIELD 9 37 J1939 (-) 4 Hi
RW 375 B 992
PRE-HEAT RELAY 10 36 J1939 SHIELD 5
GOr 374
CN-99 172 172 SPEAKER
PRE-HEAT RELAY 11 18 BATTERY 24V 3 C
990A G56B
1 A A 28 2 E CN-23
ABL
BATTERY 24V
LH
991A B
510 510 T
526 WOr
2 07 BATTERY 24V 1 1
524
3 RESISTOR C B 08 BATTERY 24V 2
4 17 BATTERY 24V CL-4
622
CN-10 179 179 CS-1
5 38 KEY SW "ON"SIGNAL 6 Lo CN-24
RH
6 29 BATTERY RETURN 23
Br 685 189 189
4 Hi
HEAD R 522 525 W 1
LIGHT 523
774
696
775
30 BATTERY RETURN 22 5 2
13
W 611
39 BATTERY RETURN 21
162 162
3 C
-RH
Br 622 RW 357 G56C DOOR S.W
2 E CN-7
ABL
57 40 BATTERY RETURN 20
R 438 509 509 T CL-1 163 YOr 1
50 BATTERY RETURN 19 1 FUSE_ILLUMINATION
591 LW
18 3 3 FUSE-CASSETTE
Gr 521A 521 Gr
ECM EARTH 17 2 4 FUSE_ROOM LAMP
WOr 694 CN-100 G60I 696 WOr
7 1 5 MCU_RETURN
Gr 466 CN-29 2
GOr 510 742 742 BrW MG651032 774 RW
SEERING PUMP RELAY 52 2 1 B 7 MCU_REVERSE_MANUAL
R 463 R 243 Or 172 694A ROOM LAMP 775 GOr
SEERING PUMP RELAY 53 3 2 Pa R/DRY 3 3 E 8 MCU_REVERSE_AUTO
V 663 V 238 OrW 509 745 745 LW W 132
STEERING PUMP PS 55 1 1 4 4 S 1 9 NC
Or 662 YOr 179 LH G61
MAIN PUMP PS 56 5 CD-1 5 BOOM KICK OUT 2 10 NC
684 W 711 711 R 189 694 WORK
4 2 C 6 CL-5 11 NC
693A 693C HYD. TEMP YOr 162 CN-101 LAMP
6 1 1 12 NC
W 213 742 FRONT W 132A
CD-10 8 1 B 1 13 NC
CN-19 YW 726 726 BrW 742 694 RH G61A
Pa 9 3 E 2 15 NC
WOr 693 693 AIR-CLEANER LW 745 748 748
10 4 S CL-6 2 NC-NC
OrW 748 W 132 1.25 142 RW
CD-2 11 BUCKET LEVELER 6 WORK LAMP RELAY
B 657 693D B G56 1.25 1.25 132 W
G57
AC RELAY 14 14 1 2
Pa
S S + -
V 238 OrW 646 433
AC RELAY 16 CN-154(GRAY) 16 2 BOOM DOWN CL-35
W 711 G 722 722 Br 432 645
MCU_HYD TEMP SENSER 46 2 15 3 P./SWITCH
CN-141
1.25
YW 726 V 723 723 FAN PROPORTIONAL V/V W 133A
MCU_AIR CLEANER SWITCH 47 1 4 1
B 731 432 Or 433 G62A
CN-155(BLACK) 1 2
LW 706 LW 391 391 646 OrW 645
OPTION
MCU_FUEL SENDER 48 2 2 CN-136 CL-36
G 722 R 393 393 FAN REVERSE SOL 432 Br 432 432
MCU_FAN PROPORTIONAL VALVE 42 1 3 2 RIDE SOL
V 723 G57 G58 G58 RW 142 RW 142
CAMERA
FUSE_ILLUMINATION 31 2 1 1 1 SHD 5 REAR WIPER MOTOR
GOr 508 V 609 607 B 612 612 334 G
TURN LAMP_LH 35 4 2 2 2 GND 7 REAR WIPER MOTOR
Or 171 B 606 608 W 615 615 L 252
FUSE_ILLUMINATION 32 1 3 3 3 SIG 9 MIRROR HEAT CONT.
OrW 507 W 608 609 V 614 614
TURN LAMP_RH 34 3 4 4 4 24V 6 NC
5 5 14 NC
253 V
6 6 10 MIRROR HEAT CONT.
WOr 693 CN-10
GROUND_MCU 45 CL-23 11 NC
336
253
330
334
331
Br 684 161A RW 143 143 RW 146 146A 121 WOr
MCU_24V 36 1 12 12 1 12 FUSE_BEACON
508A 2
G71B
2 13 NC
171A
3 CL-22 WORK LAMP RH CL-7 15 NC
507A 146 R 122
4 1 BEACON 2 8 NC
YOr 185 185 B G70 1.25 G70 B G71 G71A WORK LAMP LH M G64B
MULTI_HEAD LIGHT LOW 28 5 11 11 2 LAMP 1
R 188 188 B G54 2.0 CL-21
MULTI_HEAD LIGHT HI 27 6
693B 171B Or 174 174 CR-39
7 10 10 2 FROM BATT. RY
519
513
518
517
516
515
514
W 212 212 G71 NUMBER PLATE LAMP 465 L 252
G60M
G60N
HORN 54 8 1 2
G60L
G60J
YOr 163H
YOr 163K
YOr 163J
BrW 741 741 CN-65 464 RH G64
334
331
OrW 336
330
253
122
WOr 121
MCU_REF. POWER 5V
MCU_BOOM POSITION SENSOR
26
44
LW 744 744
9
10
G54
1 CN-19 M CN-150
1
BACK BUZZER
OrW
OrW 747 747 BrW 192 192 374 MIRROR
GOr
Or
RW
RW
LW
MCU_BUCKET POSITION SENSOR 20 11 2 5 MOTOR RY
Or
Br
W
G
R
B
B
ATT. LOCK SWITCH 50 12 2
Gr 465 HEATER 2
L 252A
CN-27B
R 464 LH G64A
CS-35
CS-76
CS-23
13 CL-16 CD-40
9
3
1
3
1
3
1
2
1
3
5
4
3
ATT. UNLOCK SWITCH 1
10
10
9
10
9
8
51
12
12
12
11
11
11
10
571 Or 171 687 687
G62
G61
G64
G60
14
171 Br
A
- S+
4 C REAR 4 Pa CN-149 10 3 11 8 7 11 8 7 11
Br 430 430 OrW 507 507 V 664 664 1 I 0 1 1
RIDE CONTROL RELAY 17 15 3 T COMBI 1 B ELEC. STR PUMP PS
USB +(5V)
OrW 647 647 G54D 695 695
AUX GND
USB GND
16 RH WOr
RIDE CONTROL RELAY 18 6 C
USD D+
2 E
AUX S2
AUX S1
USD D-
LOr 201 201 G63
17 1 S CD-39
687A 0,I
18 CL-15 A
- S+
R 437 437 YOr 161 161 374 Pa 12 5 8 12 12 10 4 9 3 12 12 10 4 9 3 12
DIFF LOCK SOL._SWITCH 38 19 4 C B MAIN PUMP PS
RW 356 356 GOr 508 508 REAR 695A REAR WIPER SW MIRROR HEATER SW BEACON SW
DIFF.LOCK SENSOR_MCU 37 20 3 T COMBI C USB PORT
G54E
BOOM UP SENSOR_MCU 21 21 2 E LH
201A
BOOM DOWN SENSOR_MCU 22
684
22 1 S EMERGENCY STR
23
THER_ INCAR AMBIENT FET RELAY(HI)
NC 59 MISTER(+) TEMP ACT'R
CN-96 MODE-1 ACT'R MODE-1 ACT'R INTAKE ACT'R SENSOR SENSOR
17
CN-13 BLOWER
L 384 2.0 2.0 384 L
3
1
NC 58 1 B 2 7 2 7 2 7 2 7
L 384A 2.0 B G53 2.0 1.25 G53 B 1 4 1 4 1 4 1 4
M M M M
4
2
2
A
5 5 5 5
3
FUEL HEATER CN-28
1
1
5
6
7
5
6
7
5
6
7
5
6
7
4
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
2
3
2
12
CN-13 Gr 247 1.25 247 AC-2 AC-22
5 2
Gr 246 246 Y 377 1.25 G53B AC COMP.
RY
BY
BW
BY
AC COMP. 15 5 6 1 NC 10 10
Y 376 376 G 537 1.25
PRE-HEAT RELAY 12 6 7 CN-80 NC 5 5
G 536 536 ROr 717 1.25 CR-24
2.0
2.0
2.0
2.0
START RELAY 19 7 8 15W 707 NC 14 14
ROr 716 716 RS-1 377
MCU_ALTERNATOR I 49 8 NC 6 6 CN-11
ROr 717A 961 B BW 2.0 BW
3 2 15R 709 GND 1 1 1 1 1 GND(CONTROLLER)
12
RESISTOR 3W/300
1
RW 718 1.25 PREHEATER TAIL(+) 4
964 YOr 4 4
RY RY
8 ILLUMINATION
4
382B L 963 RW RW 2.0 RW
1 PREHEATER BATTERY(+) 3 3 3 3 5 FUSE(Battery)
382A L RELAY 988 W L L
2 ALTERNATOR CN-74 REVERSE FAN 13 13 13 13 4 REVERSE_MCU
CR-23 CN-45 962 R R R
NC 4 5W 727 IG2 2 2 2 2 3 FUSE(IG)
U
FI 3
ROr 717
G53A
537
M M ACT'R REF 7 7
965
968
G
BW
7 7
RG
GB
LY
YW
6 DPS(COMPRESSOR)
L 2 5R 728 SENSOR GND 8 8 8 8 7 CONDENSOR FAN
969 GW Y BR
~3 P 1
B+
THERMISTER(+) 9 9 9 9 2 BLOWER_SIGNAL
G 718 START RELAY 966 R YL
B+ 708 INCAR SENSOR 11 11 11 11
AC&HEATER CONTROLLER
708 15 R 970 OrW YB AIR CON
STARTER AMBIENT SENSOR 12 12 12 12
109 80R
FROM BATTERY RELAY 983 YW YW
CONDENSER FAN 18 18 18 18
987 Y 17
LY
COMPRESSOR 17 17 17
986 LW 16
BY
FET_F/BACK 16 16 16
985 YW BR
BLOWER RELAY_LO 15 15 15 15
984 BOr BL
FET_GATE 14 14 14 14
982 LW LW
MODE-2 ACT'R_PBR 12 12 12 12
981 Y LB
MODE-2 ACT'R_FOOT 11 11 11 11
980 LW LR
CD-3 MODE-2 ACT'R_DEF 10 10 10 10
684 Br Br 682 682A BRAKE ACC. PS 979 WOr LgW
A
- S+
3 3 Pa MODE-1 ACT'R_PBR 9 9 9 9
674 978 BW 8
LgB
B MODE-1 ACT'R_FOOT 8 8 8
693 WOr WOr 692 692A 977 Gr 7
LgR
5 5 C MODE-1 ACT'R_VENT 7 7 7
L 941 941 L L 942 976 Y 6
BrW
TCU_VMGA1(24) 60 6 6 TEMP ACT'R_PBR 6 6 6
G 946 946 G W 947 975 G 5
BrB
TCU_AU1(37) 25 9 9 TEMP ACT'R_WARM 5 5 5
974 BOr 4
BrR
TEMP ACT'R_COOL 4 4 4
673 R R 674 973 L 3
LW
1 1 INTAKE ACT'R_PBR 3 3 3
972 BW LB
CD-26 INTAKE ACT'R_REC 2 2 2 2
CN-5 682 971 WOr 1
LR
A
- S+
Pa INTAKE ACT'R_FRE 1 1 1
676 VW VW 677 677 PARKING
CN-160
4 4 B PS
NC 13 13 13 13
Br 662 2.0 692
JOYSTICK SELECT 10
16
11
13
14
15
12
4
6
5
1
3
2
C
8
FUSE_JOYSTIC SW 9
7
FUSE BOX_IG 16
W 611 2.0 AC-1 AC-11
FUSE BOX_IG 17 CD-4
3L 382 942
RELAY_BUCKET
FUEL WARMER REALY 33 7 7 1 Pa
ILLUMINATION
S S + -
RELAY_BOOM
HORN RELAY
947
KICK DOWN
2
R 673 203 GW GW 204 204
NEUTRAL
MCU_BRAKE OIL LOW PRESSURE 13 8 8 3 STOP LAMP
VW 676 701 Y Y 702 702
CLUTCH CUT-OFF
FWD
GND
MCU_PARKING PRESSURE 14 2 2 4
REV
24V
NC
NC
NC
NC
Y 701
TCU_EU1(38) 15 10 10 STOP LAMP &
G50B B B G51
CLUTCH CUT-OFF PS
363 GrW
442 WOr
11 11
362 VOr
441 Gr
G19 B
12 12
369 V
GW 359 LW LW 351
STOP LAMP RELAY 20 13 13 CN-71
G51
14 14 1
351
SWITCH PILOT CUT OFF 29 15 15 2
LW 359
SWITCH PARKING 30 PARKING
CN-12 SHIFT LEVER
NC 31
NC 42
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
AD1
CD-46 MONITOR CLUSTER
VM
VP
CN-110
ED
841 G
B1
B3
B2
1
AS
R
V
846 V SPEED SENSOR OUTPUT MULTI FUNCTION SWITCH 1
2 2 1 442
LAMP_JOYSTICK STR SELECTED
2 1
571 Or 2
Y 7
F
NC 34 3
B 5
WB 8
BG 3
BW 2
NC 35 CD-17 G19
4 3
811 B 6
CAMERA 0_INPUT_SIDE
Lo
CAMERA SIGNAL SHILD
OUTPUT SIGNAL
O
363
L
2
2 1
L
CAMERA 0_INPUT
CAMERA 3_INPUT
CAMERA 2_INPUT
CAMERA 1_INPUT
\U+f058
PROGRAM DUMP
MIRROR HEATED
5 BO- BO+ 2
PROGRAM DUMP
Lo Hi F
RS232 PC SHILD
B+
C
X1
RS232_SHILED
X2
ILLUMINATION
ILLUMINATION
AD5(R) C
D
A
D
C
B
4 3
FUSE_TCU 1 369
CAN2-SHILD
CAN2-SHILD
6 FL- FL+ 1
HIGH BEAM
RS232 RXD
RS232 TXD
G 841 812 BW 2
CAN2 LOW
CAN2 LOW
BATT. 24V
BATT. 24V
BATT. 24V
RS232 RX
RS232 TX
O
RH TURN
TCU_VMG2(04) 2
LH TURN
TURBIN PICK-UP
AD6(N)
1
AD4(F)
O J
G \U+f058
I
GND_B+
CAN2 HI
CAN2 HI
GND_IG
AD1
AD2
AD3
V 846 826 RW 1
BWG C
IG 24V
IG 24V
ED1(VP)
2 1
C
STANDARD
Hi
TCU_EF4(62)
J
3
AD7(KD)
HO
2
I
GND
N
GND
B 811 CN-114
NC
NC
NC
NC
TCU_VMG1(03)
RW
4
BVi
BY
FRONT WIPER
CN-57
CN-56
Gr
W 821
W
4 3
L
TCU_EF1(19) 5 CD-47(BLACK)
BW 812 813 BOr
6
2
6
1
3
5
4
14
18
16
14
11
12
13
16
19
17
13
12
11
17
18
10
19
15
20
10
15
20
TCU_VMG1(03) 6 2
8
6
6
2
1
1
7
4
5
4
3
2
INTER
D
9
K
RW 826 831 WOr
TCU_EF2(41) 7 1
CS-11
GEAR PICK-UP
CS-12
CS-5A
BOr 813
GOr
GBr
RW
SHIFT CLUTCH
RY
B G50 1.25
4
5
2
TCU_VMG1(03)
5
8
M
1
3
Or
Or
4
1
3
2
7
Or
R
R
Y
Y
B
WOr 831
L
L
V
GOr
YOr
YOr
LOr
RW
YW
SWITCH SWITCH
LW
B
JOYSTICK STEERING 10
Gr
Or
Gr
Or
5 Lo
153E
251A
Br
Br
4 Hi
G
R
R
V
Y
3R 104 104 3R
G15
G15
G15
G15
FUSE MAXI
187
790
791
624
596
594
592
650
650
580
790
791
935
625
626
627
505
506
650
580
153
629
623
JOYSTICK STEERING 11
2
3
1
M10 3R 102 111 15R 106 HAZARD SW ILL. HEAD LAMP WORK LAMP
CN-158
JOYSTICK STEERING 12
CN-159
X1
X2
12
12
12
182
184
187
180
214
303
305
314
311
317
300
501
505
506
12
12
12
3R
10
D
D
B
A
B
A
15R
0.5
0.5
4
9
V
80A
4
RW 532
4
CONT_JOYSTICK_INTPU1 18
M5 CN-95
451A WOr
GrW
BrW
RW 541
GOr
ROr
VOr
LW
3
CONT_JOYSTICK_SENSOR(-) 19
Or
G
R
3W 111F
L
CR-1
2
FUSE 21
3W 111A 532 80R 107 108
1
CS-41
570C
11
11
11
CS-42
CS-36
CS-59
CS-21
1
CN-21
9
7
9
7
FUSE 22
930
920
910
915
925
905
10
11
11
11
12
12
12
C
B
B
A
A
9
9
6
2
1
6
5
1
3
1
3
1
3
7
3W 111B G50 80R 109
FUSE 25
B
BATTERY
OrW
WOr
WOr
BrW
BrW
3W 111C
GOr
YOr
RW
LOr
LOr
LOr
LOr
VW
BW
LW
FUSE 26
Or
W
BATT. RY
G
R
R
B
B
3W 111D
G15
596
594
592
580
FUSE 27
3W 111E 15R 111 532A
FUSE 28 2
153D
153A
153B
G50A TO STARTER
G14
G14
G14
G14
307
315
317
310
505
506
501
501
150
182
180
154
153
134
144
154
154
740
754
690
740
755
690
1
NC 23 DO-2
G14 1.25
B G15 1.25
RW 541
START KEY SWITCH 37
3R 102
FUSE 24
CD-48
ROr 856 856
TCU_ER3(17) 39 1
FILTER RESTRICTION
B
876B
629 0.5
623 0.5
GBr 624 0.5
795 0.5
790 0.5
791 0.5
935 0.5
625 0.5
626 0.5
251A 0.5
NC 32 2 Pa
570C
WOr 451A
307
315
310
627
650
580
GOr 930
LW 920
BrW 910
ROr 915
GrW 925
VOr 905
505
GOr 506
501
214
303
305
314
311
300
YOr 184
187
OrW 150
180
LOr 154
134
VW 144
754
BrW 740
BW 755
WOr 690
CD-49
876A
G15
G15
2 C
580
592
596
580
592
594
RW
LOr
LOr
YW
RY
TCU_ER2(49) 40 1
Or
Or
Or
Gr
Br
Br
1 W
G
R
R
Y
Y
L
CN-112
10
9
37
12
38
39
50
13
14
27
15
16
17
18
21
22
23
24
28
29
30
19
40
41
42
43
45
HEAD LAMP_LOW 31
HEAD LAMP_HI 32
33
34
35
46
47
59
57
60
58
7
8
6
4
2
W
B
V
B
B
V
B
L
16
CN-250A
CN-250
TCU_VMGA2(46) 38 9 VMGA2
TCU_ED4-FWD.
CLUTCH_MODE
TCU_ED6-NEU.
TCU_ED5-REV.
WIPER MOTOR-HI
PROGRAM DUMP 2
SHIELD_GROUND
FUSE BOX_TCU
TM_SHIFT_MODE
WORK LAMP RY_RELAY
TCU_ED1
TCU_ED2
TCU_ED3
MCU-SERIAL_L
FLASHER_L
RH TURN
FUSE BOX_ILL
MCU & WASHER
MIRROR HEATED
FUSE BOX_HEAD
RS232 RX 2
WIPER RY_LOW
RS232_TX
WIPER RY_HI
FUSE BOX
GND_SENSOR
HORN RY
RS232 RX
MCU_INT
RS232 TX 2
RS232 P_DUMP
1
1
2
4
2
4
ILL
5V_POWER
FUSE BOX_BATT. 24V
TCU_KD
TCU_JOYSTCIK STR
FUSE BOX_BATT. IG
TCU_ER1(39) 41 8 TEMP
VW 851 851 FWD REV
TCU_VPS1(12,13) 36 7 VPS1(+)
BrW 881 881 1 2 3 4 1 2 3
TCU_AIP6(51) 43 6 Y6
LOr 896 896 Y5
TCU_AIP5(09) 44 5 Y5
Gr 886 886 Y1 Y2
TCU_AIP4(55) 45 4 Y4 Y3
OrW 866 866
TCU_AIP3(32) 46 3 Y3 Y6
VOr 901 891 YW
TCU_AIP2(10) 47 2 Y2 Y4
YW 891 901 VOr
TCU_AIP1(56) 48 1 Y1 Y2 Y1
TO SHEET 1 OF 2
GEARBOX 7809S7EL01-1
7-4
MEMORANDUM
7-5
1. ILLUMINATION CIRCUIT
1) OPERATING FLOW
Fuse box [CN-36 (18)] Illumination switch [CS-21 (3)] Switch ON, 1st step
[CS-21 (9)] Work and hazard switch, cluster, monitor indicator lamp ON
[CS-21 (7)] Fuse box [CN-36 (35)] Switch indicator lamp
I/conn [CN-6 (31)]
LH Combi clearance lamp ON [CL-15 (4)]
I/conn [CN-10 (1)] RH Head lamp ON [CN-4 (3)]
Fuse box [CN-36 (36)] Switch indicator lamp
I/conn [CN-6 (32)]
RH Combi clearance lamp ON [CL-16 (4)]
I/conn [CN-10 (3)] LH Head lamp ON [CL-3 (3)]
I/conn [CN-14 (10)] Number plate lamp [CL-21 (2)]
2) CHECK POINT
Engine Key switch Check point Voltage
① - GND (switch input)
7-6
ILLUMINATION CIRCUIT
CLUSTER
R
ILLUMINATION 17
CN-56
MONITOR
R
ILLUMINATION 18
CS-21 LOr
WORK LAMP SW HAZARD SW YOr ILLUMINATION 1 5A
35
12 11 11 12
1 1
3 3
Or ILLUMINATION 2 5A
36
4 4
CN-36
LOr
6
6 LOr 7
3
7 7
4 9
8
4
9 9 9 8
3 10
7 10
R R
11 11
12 1 B 1 12
12 12
CS-36 CS-41
CN-6
1
2
3
4
26
27
HEAD LIGHT-LH
Lo 6 3 28
Hi 4
5
29
Or
C 3
B 30
E 2
ABL
YOr YOr
T 1 1 31
CL-3 Or Or
2 32
HEAD LIGHT-RH 3 33
Lo 6 3 4 34
Hi 4
5
YOr 5 35
C 3
E
B CN-10 59
2
ABL
T 1
60 ALL SWITCH INDICATOR LAMP ON
CL-4
3 CN-14
1
REAR COMBI-LH
C 4
YOr 2
T 3
B 3
E 2
S 1
4
CL-15 3 5
REAR COMBI-RH 11
Or
CL-21
NUMBER
C 4 10 2
PLATE
T 3 1
B LAMP
E 2
S 1
CL-16
7809S7EL03
7-7
2. HEAD LIGHT CIRCUIT
1) OPERATING FLOW
Fuse box [CN-36 (19)] Head light switch [CS-21 (6)] Light switch ON, 2nd step [CS-21 (4)]
Multi function switch [CS-11(8)]
Multi function switch MIDDLE [CS-11(7)] I/conn [CN-6 (28)] I/conn [CN-10 (5)]
LH Head light low beam ON [CL-3 (6)]
RH Head light low beam ON [CL-4 (6)]
Multi function switch DOWN [CS-11(6)] I/conn [CN-6 (27)] I/conn [CN-10 (6)]
LH Head light high beam ON [CL-3 (4)]
RH Head light high beam ON [CL-4 (4)]
Cluster high beam pilot lamp ON [CN-56 (5)]
2) CHECK POINT
Engine Key switch Check point Voltage
① - GND (switch input)
② - GND (switch output)
③ - GND (multi function input)
④ - GND (multi function output)
OFF ON 20~25V
⑤ - GND (multi function output)
⑥ - GND (low beam)
⑦ - GND (high beam)
⑧ - GND (passing B+)
※ GND : Ground
7-8
HEAD LIGHT CIRCUIT
FUSE BOX
ILL & HEAD LAMP SW BEACON 10A
15
12 11
2 WORK LAMP_FRONT 20A
1 16
MIRROR,SER.SOCKET2 20A
3 17
YOr
4 ILL.LAMP 20A
18
G G HEAD LAMP 20A
6 19
6 7 BACK.STOP LAMP 10A
4 20
HORN/CONVERTER 20A
9 9 21
3 AIR-CON/HEATER 1 30A
7
22
12
11 1 FUEL WARMER 20A
1 23
12
CIGARLIGHTER 30A
CS-21 24
YOr ILLUMINATION 1 5A
1 35
2 Or ILLUMINATION 2 5A
36
1 3
CN-36
6 2 4
3 26
R R
HEAD LIGHT-LH 4 27
YOr YOr YOr
Lo 6 5 28
R
Hi 4
5
6 29
Or
C 3
B 7 30
E 2
ABL
YOr YOr
T 1 8 31
CL-3 7 9
Or 32 Or
10 33
11 34
HEAD LIGHT-RH
YOr 12 35
Lo 6
R
Hi 4
13 59
5
YOr
C 3
B
14 60
E 2
ABL
T 1 15 CN-6
CL-4 16
CN-10
4
YOr
YOr
R
G
5
3 8
R
CS-11
CN-56
16
14
19
18
17
13
12
11
10
20
15
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
9
8
6
7
1
4
3
2
LAMP_JOYSTICK STR SELECTED
4BWG
W
6
Hi
C
MIRROR HEATED
PROGRAM DUMP
RS232 PC SHILD
ILLUMINATION
Hi Lo
CAN2-SHILD
HIGH BEAM
CAN2 LOW
BATT. 24V
RS232 RX
RS232 TX
B+
RH TURN
LH TURN
C
CAN2 HI
F
IG 24V
L
R
GND
O
GND
L
R
NC
NC
NC
Y 7 Lo
B 5
WB 8
CLUSTER
BG 3
BW 2
7809S7EL04
7-9
3. WORK LIGHT SWITCH
1) OPERATING FLOW
※ Illumination switch : ON position (1st step)
(1) Work lamp switch ON (1st step)
ILL & head lamp switch [CS-21 (9)] Work lamp switch indicate lamp ON
Work lamp switch [CS-36 (7)→(3)]
Front work lamp relay[CR-3 (2)→(5)] I/conn [CN-7 (14)]
LH Front work lamp ON [CL-5 (1)]
RH Front work lamp ON [CL-6 (1)]
(2) Work lamp switch (2nd step)
Work lamp switch [CS-36 (6) → (4)] Rear work lamp relay [CR-55 (2)→(5)]
I/conn [CN-6 (33)] I/conn [CN-14 (12)] LH Rear work lamp ON [CL-22 (1)]
RH Rear work lamp ON [CL-23 (1)]
2) CHECK POINT
Engine Key switch Check point Voltage
① - GND (work lamp power input)
② - GND (work lamp power output)
OFF ON 20~25V
③ - GND (front work lamp)
④ - GND (rear work lamp)
※ GND : Ground
7-10
WORK LIGHT SWITCH
FUSE BOX
1
BEACON 10A
15
2 GW WORK LAMP_FRONT 20A
16
3 MIRROR,SER.SOCKET2 20A
17
4 ILL.LAMP 20A
18
HEAD LAMP 20A
5 19
RW RW BACK.STOP LAMP 10A
6 20
HORN/CONVERTER 20A
7 21
AIR-CON/HEATER 1 30A
8 22
FUEL WARMER 20A
23
9 CIGARLIGHTER 30A
24
10
3 11
SERVICE SOCKET 1 20A
12 25
SPARE 20A
13 26
W W W Y WORK LAMP_REAR 20A
27
FR WORK 1 14
B WIPER 20A
LAMP-LH 2 28
CL-5 15 PARK 20A
29
W CN-7 JOYSTICK-DETENT 10A
30
FR WORK 1 PRE-HEAT/FUEL WARMER 30A
B
LAMP-RH 2 31
FAN REVERSE/ATT 20A
CL-6 32
RIDE CONTROL 10A
33
OPTION JOYSTIC_SWITCH 10A
1 34
CL-35
W W W
1 2 LOr
B
2 5A
3 ILLUMINATION 1
35
FR WORK LAMP
4
W 5A
1 ILLUMINATION 2
B 5 36
2
CL-36 6 CN-36
7
CL-32
RW
1 8
B
2
9
RR WORK LAMP
10
RW
1
2
B 11 2 FR WORK LAMP RY
CL-33 12 4 3 2
B
1
13 W
5
4 14
Y
2
GW 4 5 1
3
8 15
CR-3
RW 9 CN-9
RR WORK 1
B
1
LAMP-LH 2 10 31 RR WORK LAMP RY
CL-22 B B 4 3 2
11 32 B
1
RW RW RW RW RW RW
RR WORK 1 12 33 5
B VW
LAMP-RH 2 2
CN-14 34 Y
CL-23 3 4 5 1
35 CR-55
59
2
60
WORK LAMP SW 1
CN-6
12 11
1
3
Y
4
VW
6
LOr
6 7
LOr
4
9 9
3
7
R
11
12 1
12
B
CS-36
12 11
1
3
4 CLUSTER
R 17 ILLUMINATION
6
6 LOr CN-56
7
4
MONITOR
R R
9 9 18 ILLUMINATION
3
7 CN-57
R
11
12 1
12
B
CS-21 7809S7EL05
7-11
4. STARTING CIRCUIT
1) OPERATING FLOW
Battery(+) terminal Fusible link [CN-60] Master switch [CS-74]
I/conn [CN-5 (24)] Fuse box [CN-36] Start switch [CS-2(1)]
ECM ECM power relay [CR-25(30)]
Power relay [CR-35(30)]
※ The gear selector lever is neutral position. It is necessary condition before the starting.
The gear selector has an output signal which is activated whenever the shift lever is in the neutral
position. This signal can be used to control a relay and prevent engine from starting whenever the shift
lever is not in the neutral position.
(1) When start key switch is in ON position
Start switch ON Start switch [CS-2(2)] I/conn [CN-5(37)] Master switch [CS-74]
Battery relay [CR-1]
Battery relay operating (all power is supplied with the electric component)
Start switch [CS-2 (3)] ECM power relay [CR-25 (30)→(87)]
Fuse box [CN-36 (9)] I/conn [CN-5 (16)]
ECM [CN-93(38)]
Power relay [CR-35(30)→(87)]
Fuse box [CN-36 (10)] MCU[CN-58A (A11)]
(2) When start key switch is in START position
Start switch START [CS-2 (6)] Start safety relay [CR-5 (30)→(87)] I/conn [CN-6 (19)]
I/conn[CN-13(7)] Start relay [CR-23] Starter (terminal B+ and M connector of start motor)
2) CHECK POINT
Engine Key switch Check point Voltage
① - GND (battery B+)
7-12
STARTING CIRCUIT
2
MASTER SW CN-60
3R 104 3R 105
MONITOR CLUSTER 3R 15R 106
CN-95
RW
FUSIBLE LINK
RW
CAMERA 0_INPUT_SIDE
FUSE BOX
USB PLAYER POWER CONNECT
10A BEACON CS-74 BATTERY RY
CAMERA 0_INPUT
15 RW 80R
REMOCON GND
20A WORK LAMP_FRONT
REMOCON+
BATT. 24V
BATT. 24V
BATT. 24V
20A MIRROR,SER.SOCKET2
RH TURN
BACK UP+
TEL MUTE
LH TURN
17 1 B 80R BATTERY
ANT 12V
IG 24V
IG 24V
20A ILL.LAMP
18
GND
ACC
2
ILL+
CR-1
ILL-
CN-127
NC
NC
NC
20A HEAD LAMP
CN-250A
CN-57
CN-56
CN-250
19
10A 3 DO-2 1
BACK.STOP LAMP RW
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
8
5
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
9
2
4
3
2
3
1
1
4
3
2
4
4
20 2
20A HORN/CONVERTER 14 B
21 1
30A AIR-CON/HEATER 1 15
LW
22 V STARTER
V
20A FUEL WARMER 16
23 M
24
30A CIGARLIGHTER
17 M
W START RY
21 5W
B B+
22
20A SERVICE SOCKET 1 G CN-45
25 5R
20A SPARE 23
26
20A WORK LAMP_REAR 24 CR-23
27
20A WIPER 25 CD-46 R ALTERNATOR
28
20A PARK 26
29 1 B+
G
10A JOYSTICK-DETENT 2 P ~
30 27 Or 1
30A PRE-HEAT, FUEL WARMER 3 ROr L 3
2
31 28
20A FAN REVERSE, ATT. 3 FI U
32 36
10A RIDE CONTROL 4 NC
33
10A JOYSTIC_SWITCH
37 CN-74
34
38 RESISTOR
Y RW
CN-5 5 1
CN-7
ROr 3W/300
3
1
4
2
2
RS-1
20A TURN LAMP
1 CN-13
5A CASSETTE/ROOM LAMP
2 1 5
30A START KEY SWITCH R
3
10A
2 6
TCU 24V BATTERY
4
20A ECM 24V BATTERY 3 7
5
20A MCU 24V BATTERY 4
6 8
10A AIR-CON/HEATER 2
7 5 3
10A CLUSTER 24V BATTERY
8 6 12
19 1
3R ECM
20 2
18 BATTERY 24V
21
28 BATTERY 24V
22 07 BATTERY 24V
23 08 BATTERY 24V
24 17 BATTERY 24V
Y 38 KEY SW "ON"SIGNAL
25
20A ECM_IG Br CD-41
9 26
CN-93
Gr CN-141 1
46
10
10A MCU BW CN-10 1 2 Pa
47 12 2 3
10A TCU Or 48 13
11 4
49 14 S S + -
10A CLUSTER V
12 59 15
X2
60
V AD5(R) C
10A CASSETTE LW D
13 AD4(F) B
C
CN-6
B AD6(N) D
10A SPARE B
14 A ED1(VP) A
CN-159 X1
5A ILLUMINATION 1 AD7(KD) D
35
8 3 AD1 C
5A ILLUMINATION 2
AD2 B
36
GOr
ROr
VW
BW
RW
4
LW
GOr
RW
Or
Or
6 AD3 A
BW
R
R
CN-36
RW
RW
GOr
AD7
VW
LW
LW
Gr
G
R
R
B
B
Y
Or
Or
CN-134
CN-58A
CN-157
CN-125
CS-2
R
68
45
3
8
7
A11
A34
ANTI-RESTART RLY B03
B36
12
1
3
4
5
2
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
3
2
6
5
4
R AD5
CR-5
CR-35
CR-25
SERIAL "1"_H(TX)
ED2-SHIFT LEVER X1B-B2
VPE2-CONTINUANCE 24V
SERIAL "1"_L(RX)
B DIAGNOSTIC V AD4
87a 85 87 86 30 87a 85 87 86 30 4 1 5 2 3 87a 85 87 86 30
VPS2-RIDE CONT.RT(+)
POWER IG(24V)
0, I
1
B3 AD3
BATTERY(+)
KEY IG(24V)
NETURAL SIG
GROUND
GROUND
B2 AD2
ALT LEVEL
VPI-POWER IG
30 87 30 87 2 5 30 87 B1 AD1
NC
NC
86 85 86 85 3 1 86 85
H 0 I II
4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 ED
4
6
5
3
2
H
C ST ACC BR REMOTE K N R F VP
POWER RY ECM POWER NETURAL RY SAFETY RY START SWITCH MANAGEMENT
D OUTPUT SIGNAL VM
RELAY MCU UNIT
TCU SHIFT LEVER
7809S7EL06
7-13
5. CHARGING CIRCUIT
When the starter is activated and the engine is started, the operator releases the key switch to the
ON position.
Charging current generated by operating alternator flows into the battery through the battery relay
(CR-1).
The current also flows from alternator to each electrical component and controller through the fuse
box.
1) OPERATING FLOW
(1) Warning flow
Altermator [CN-74 (2)] I/conn [CN-13 (8)] I/conn [CN-6 (49)] MCU [CN-58A (B36)]
Cluster charge warning lamp ON
(2) Charging flow
Alternator Starter [CN-45 (B+)] Battery relay [CR-1]
Battery(+) terminal Charging
Fusible link [CN-60] Master switch [CS-74] I/conn [CN-5 (24)]
Fuse box [CN-36)]
Fusible link [CN-95] I/conn [CN-5 (21, 22, 25~28)] Fuse box [CN-36]
2) CHECK POINT
※ GND : Ground
※ MCU : Machine control unit
7-14
CHARGING CIRCUIT
6
MASTER SW CN-60
3R 104 3R 105
3R 8W 106
CN-95
RW
FUSE BOX FUSIBLE LINK
10A BEACON
15
20A WORK LAMP_FRONT CS-74
16
20A MIRROR,SER.SOCKET2
17
20A ILL.LAMP
18
20A HEAD LAMP
19
10A BACK.STOP LAMP BATTERY
20 BATTERT RY
20A HORN/CONVERTER 1 RW
21 80R
30A AIR-CON/HEATER 1 2
22
20A FUEL WARMER B 80R
3
23
30A CIGARLIGHTER
1
24 4 CR-1
W 2
21
22
20A SERVICE SOCKET 1
25
20A
23
SPARE
26
20A WORK LAMP_REAR 24
27
20A WIPER 25 RW
28 2
20A PARK
B
29
26 1
10A JOYSTICK-DETENT
27 DO-2
30
30A PRE-HEAT, FUEL WARMER
31 28
20A FAN REVERSE, ATT.
32 36
10A RIDE CONTROL
33
10A JOYSTIC_SWITCH
37
34
38
Y 47
48
20A
CN-5
TURN LAMP
1
5A CASSETTE/ROOM LAMP STARTER
2
30A START KEY SWITCH M
3
10A TCU 24V BATTERY
M
4 START RY
20A ECM 24V BATTERY 5W
5
20A
B+
MCU 24V BATTERY
6 CN-45
10A AIR-CON/HEATER 2 5R
7
10A
8
CLUSTER 24V BATTERY
CR-23 3
3R
R ALTERNATOR
1 B+
~ G
2 1 P
ROr L 3
2
3
3 FI U
4 CN-13
46
4 4 NC
5 CN-74
20A ECM_IG
9 47 6
RESISTOR
48 RW
10A MCU 7 1
10 ROr 3W/300
49 8 2
10A TCU 50
RS-1
3
11
59 12
10A CLUSTER
12 60 1
CN-6 2
10A CASSETTE
13
ROr
10A SPARE 5
14
CN-58A
5A ILLUMINATION 1
B36
35
5A ILLUMINATION 2
36
CN-36
ALT LEVEL
MCU
7809S7EL07
7-15
6. ELECTRIC PARKING CIR
CIRCUIT
CUIT
1) OPERATING FLOW
(1) Parking OFF
Fuse box[CN-36 (29)] Parking switch OFF [CS-17 (8)→(4)] I/conn [CN-5 (30)]
I/conn [CN-12 (13)]
OFF ON
Parking solenoid ON (activated)
P
Parking brake released (by hydraulic pressure)
[CS-17 (8)→(3)] T/M control unit [CN-157 (21)]
(2) Parking ON
Fuse box [CN-36 (29)] Parking switch ON Parking solenoid [CN-71] OFF
Parking brake applied [By spring force]
2) CHECK POINT
7-16
ELECTRIC PARKING CIRCU
CIRCUIT
IT
PARKING SW 1
B FUSE BOX
12
12
Or
1
10 25
10
SPARE 20A
26
8
9
ROr
4
7 WIPER 20A
7
28
3
32
RIDE CONTROL 10A
CS-17 2 10A
33
JOYSTIC_SWITCH
34
BOOM UP RY
B
86 30 87a CN-36
LW
85
87
V
86
85 87 87a VOr
30 TCU
CR-41 1 VM1-GND
BUCKET RY 2 VM2-GND
86 30 87a 15 SDDK-DIAGNOSTIC
OrW 18 EUPR-DIAGNOSTIC
85
B Y
6 NC
87 21 ED10-PARKING BRAKE SW(+)
V
86 66 ED9 DIFF. LOCK SWITCH
85 87 87a GrW
30
Y 37 AU1-+5V SUPPLY_BRAKE PEDAL
CR-40
3 38 EU1-SIGNAL SENSOR_BRAKE PEDAL
DO-5 CN-157
GrW
1
V
2
DO-4
VOr
1
V
OrW
2
LW
LW
Y
V
4
CN-5
CN-6
JOYSTICK LEVER
16
20
21
25
26
44
45
33
47
48
30
31
32
14
29
13
3
15
1
1
2
NC 14
NC 15
V
24V(DETEND) 1
LW
Y
24V(HANDLE) 9
REV 2
FWD 3
LW
NEUTRAL 4
Y
JOYSTICK SELECT 10
CN-12
CN-10
KICK DOWN 8
10
10
11
12
13
14
15
11
12
7
3
8
9
6
1
7
8
9
2
2
4
5
BOOM DOWN(-) 7
GrW
BUCKET(-) 6
VOr
5
OrW
BOOM UP(-)
BrW
LW
LW
COUNT_WEIGHT SW 16
Y
HORN SWITCH 11
Or
ILLUMINATION 12
B
FNR SWITCH 13
CN-160
6
5
Y
LW
CD-4
CN-71 B
BUCKET LEVELER
1
2
3
4
CN-101
1
1
3
4
1
3
4
2
Pa
B
E
S
B
E
S
SS + -
STOP LAMP & PARKING SOL
CLUTCH CUT-OFF PS
7809S7EL08
7-17
7. WIPER AND WASHER CIRCUIT
1) OPERATING FLOW
Fuse box [CN-36 (28)] Wiper relay Hi [CR-4 (3)→(4)] Front wiper motor [CN-21 (1)]
Wiper relay Lo [CR-26 (5), (2)]
Multi function switch [CS-12 (6)]
I/conn [CN-9 (3)] Rear wiper & washer switch [CS-35 (3)]
Rear wiper motor [CN-102 (1)]
(1) Front washer switch ON
① Washer switch ON [CS-12(6)→(2)] Front washer [CN-22 (1)] Washer operating
MCU [CN-58A (A31)→(B02)] Front wiper relay Lo
[CR-26 (5)→(3)] Front wiper motor [CN-21 (5)]
Wiper motor operating (low)
2) CHECK POINT
Condition Check point
① - GND (front wiper switch power input) ⑥ - GND (wiper relay power input)
Engine : Stop ② - GND (rear wiper switch power input) ⑦ - GND (front washer power output)
Key switch : ON ③ - GND (wiper relay power input) ⑧ - GND (rear washer power output)
Voltage : 20~25V ④ - GND (front wiper motor Lo power input) ⑨ - GND (front wiper motor power output)
⑤ - GND (front wiper motor High power input) ⑩ - GND (rear wiper motor power output)
※ GND : Ground
7-18
WIPER AND WASHER CIRCUIT
FRONT REAR
WASHER WASHER
M
CN-103
CN-22
2
1
1
2
OrW
FUSE BOX
Gr
B
B
SERVICE SOCKET 1 20A
25
20A
1 SEAT HEAT/AIR-RIDE
26
WORK LAMP_REAR 20A
2 27
Br WIPER 20A
3 28
PARK 20A
4 29
JOYSTICK-DETENT 10A
30
RR WIPER & WASHER SW 5 PRE-HEAT, FUEL WARMER 30A
B 31
12
6
12
11 32
G
10 7 RIDE CONTROL 10A
33
5
JOYSTIC_SWITCH 10A
RW 8
10 3
8 34
8
9
OrW
10 CN-36
0,I
5 10
I 0
Br 11
3
1 12
11
12
8 13 Y
WIPER RY HI
CS-35 4
B 3 2
2 14
R
1
5
15 Br
2
Br
CN-9 3 4 5 1
CR-4
3
WIPER RY LO
G
4 3 2
W
1
Y
FRONT WIPER 5
Y Y Y
3E 1 2
G LW W
2Pf 2 3 4 5 1
B B
1B 3
L R B CR-26
R 4 W
4 Hi 5
M
5 Lo 6
CN-21
6
CN-102
5
4
Br
CN-102
1 3E
G
2 2Pf
B
9 3 1B
4
LOr
LW
RW
Gr
Br
Br
G
5 4 Hi
7 6 5 Lo
M
1
REAR WIPER
CS-11
CS-12
CS-5
CN-58A
WIPER INT SIG A23
A31
B02
1
2
3
4
5
6
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
HO
RW
BVi
BY
4BWG
Gr
W
G
L
WIPER RLY
Y
6
2
6
1
3
5
WASH SIG
C
Hi
J
C
W
II
II
J
Hi Lo
I
O
B+
C
MCU
F
L
R
O
L
R
Y 7 Lo
B 5
WB 8
BG 3
BW 2
7809S7EL09
7-19
HAZARD, TURN AND ROTARY CIRCUIT
11 FUSE BOX
WOr WOr WOr BEACON 10A
12 15
WORK LAMP_FRONT 20A
13 20A
16
MIRROR,SER.SOCKET2
17
14 ILL.LAMP 20A
18
15 HEAD LAMP 20A
19
CN-9 BACK.STOP LAMP 10A
20
HORN/CONVERTER 20A
21
AIR-CON/HEATER 1 30A
22
1 FUEL WARMER 20A
23
2 CIGARLIGHTER 30A
24
3
4 GW 20A
TURN LAMP
REAR COMBI-RH 1
C
33 CASSETTE/ROOM LAMP 5A
2
4
OrW START KEY SWITCH 30A
T 3
B
34 3
E 2 TCU 24V BATTERY 10A
S 1
35 4
ECM 24V BATTERY 20A
CL-16 36 20A
5
MCU 24V BATTERY
6
59 AIR-CON/HEATER 2 10A
7
60 CLUSTER 24V BATTERY 10A
8
REAR COMBI-LH
CN-6
C 4
GOr
T 3 CN-36
B
E 2
S 1
CL-15
FLASHER UNIT
RW
87 L
GW
85 B G
B
86 E
CR-11
CLUSTER
8 PROGRAM DUMP
7 NC
6 MIRROR HEATED
5 HIGH BEAM
Or
4 RH TURN
GOr
3 LH TURN
2 BATT. 24V
ILL & HEAD LAMP 1 IG 24V
SW : ON(1st step) CN-56
GOr
RW
Or
CS-11
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
WOr
GOr
RW
RW
YOr
YOr
4BWG
Or
W
R
B
R
B
6
CL-7
CS-23
CS-41
7
3
1
3
1
8
4
9
9
10
10
12
12
11
11
1
2
Hi
C
1 8 7 11 1 8 7 11
Hi Lo
BEACON
B+
C
LAMP
F
L
R
O
L
R
12 10 4 9 3 12 12 10 4 9 3 12
Y 7 Lo
BW 2
7809S7EL10
7-20
GROUP 3 MONITORING SYSTEM
1. CLUSTER
1) STRUCTURE
The cluster consists of gauges, lamps and LCD as shown below, to warn the operator in case of
abnormal machine operation or conditions for the appropriate operation and inspection.
· Gauges : Indicate operating status of the machine.
· Warning lamps : Indicate abnormality of the machine.
· Pilot lamps : Indicate operating status of the machine.
· LCD : Indicates selected the driving speed and direction.
※ The cluster installed on this machine does not entirely guarantee the condition of the
machine. Daily inspection should be performed according to chapter 6, M MAINTENANCE
AINTENANCE
in operator's manual.
※ When the cluster provides a warning immediately check the problem, and perform the
required action.
7809S7EL30
2) GAUGE
(1) Speedometer
Unit ① The speedometer displays the speed of machine in mph and
km/h.
※ The unit ((km/h
km/h or mph
mph)) can be set by the display set up menu
of the monitor and selected unit is displayed.
Refer to page 7-41.
75793CD03
7-21
(2) Fuel gauge
① This gauge indicates the amount of fuel in the fuel tank.
② Fill the fuel when the indicator moves red range or lamp blinks
in red, refuel as soon as possible to avoid running out of fuel.
※ If the gauge indicates below red range even though the
machine is on the normal condition, check the electric device
Red
75793CD04 as that can be caused by the poor connection of electricity or
sensor.
7-22
3) WARNING LAMPS
75793CD95
77073CD17
75793CD35
7-23
(4) Hydraulic oil temperature warning lamp
① This warning lamp operates and the buzzer sounds when the
temperature of hydraulic oil is over 105˚C (221˚F).
② Check the hydraulic oil level when the lamp is turned ON.
③ Check for debris between oil cooler and radiator.
77073CD21
77073CD23
77073CD20
77073CD18
7-24
(9) Steering warning lamp
① Primary
This lamp indicates that the primary steering has failed. When
the indicator comes on and the action alarm sounds, steer the
machine immediately to a convenient location and stop the
machine. Stop the engine and investigate the cause.
※ Do not operate the machine until the cause has been cor-
77073CD66
rected.
② Emergency
This lamp indicates the emergency steering system is active.
※ Immediately pull the machine to a convenient stop and stop
the engine.
※ The emergency steering system can be manually tested.
77073CD15
Refer to page 7-46.
77073CD22
77073CD16
7-25
4) PILOT LAMPS
7809S7EL32
75793CD17
7807A3CD11
7-26
(4) High beam pilot lamp
① This lamp works when the illuminating direction is upward.
② This lamp comes ON when the dimmer switch is operated, e.g.,
when passing another vehicle.
77073CD12
77073CD13
77073CD65
7-27
(9) Ride control pilot lamp (option)
① Auto ride control
This lamp lights ON when push in the bottom of the ride control
switch (auto position).
※ Refer to page 7-45.
75793CD33
75793CD34
(13)
7707A3CD40
78093CD33
7-28
5) LCD
Type 1 (1) The LCD can be used with the gear selector.
It indicates speed and driving direction.
2
3 No Symbol Meaning Remark
2
Forward, reverse, neutral
1 1 1, 2, 3, 4 Actual gear display Actual gear
75793CD39
P Parking brake mode active
7-29
2. MONITOR
·The monitor is adjustable.
- Vertical : 14˚
- Horizontal : 30˚
Vertical
Main display
Horizonta
l
1) BUTTONS
(1) Menu button
① Main display to main menu, main menu to main display.
② AEB cancel button in AEB setting.
75793CD90
75793CD91
75793CD92
75793CD93
75793CD94
7-30
2) MAIN MENU
Main display
1 3
6
7
4 Main menu
5
8
10 Press
9
TYPE A (default)
2 8
9
5
10
6
7
TYPE B 75793CD11
(1) Structure
No Main menu Sub menu Description
Engine speed Engine warming up, Engine speed
Kick down Mode 1 (down/up), Mode 2 (down only)
Wiper speed 4 steps
1
Fan-auto mode Interval and time setting
MODE AEB AEB setting
75793CD12
Speed meter Pulse setting
Fault code Active, Logged fault (Machine, ECU, TCU)
Machine monitoring Hyd temp, Battery, Coolant temp
T/M oil temp
2
Monitoring history Hour meter, ODO meter
MONITORING
75793CD13
Clock Clock
Display Brightness setting (Manual/Automatic)
Type display (A or B type)
4
Unit Temp (˚F/˚C), Distance (km/mile), Pressure (bar, Mpa, kgf/m2, psi)
DISPLAY SET UP Rear camera Reverse mode, Active camera, Display order
75793CD13
Language 12 languages
7-31
(2) Mode
① Engine speed
75793CD16
75793CD16A 75793CD16B
75793CD16C 75793CD16D
② Kick down
75793CD17
75793CD17A
· Mode 1 (down/up) : Press kick down button once, shift down and press button again, shift up.
· Mode 2 (down only) : Press kick down button every time, shift to lower gear respectively.
※ Refer to page 7-48.
③ Wiper speed
75793CD18
· Setting wipe speed 1 to 4.
75793CD18A
④ Fan-auto mode
75793CD110
75793CD111 75793CD112
7-32
⑤ AEB
Actual gear window
75793CD19
75793CD19A
* : Transmission stays in neutral, you have to restart the TCU (ignition off/on).
⑥ Speed meter
75793CD20
75793CD20B 75793CD20A
7-33
(3) Monitoring
① Fault code
75793CD23
75793CD23C 7709S3CD23D
75793CD23E 7709S3CD23
7709S3CD23G
75793CD23H 75793CD23I
75793CD23J
7-34
② Machine monitoring
75793CD24
7709S3CD24A 7709S3CD24B
③ Record monitoring
75793CD25
75793CD25A 75793CD25C
· Hour meter
- Total : total hour meter
To show the item in the main display, select "ON"
and press (this item could not reset).
- Latest : the latest hour meter after reset.
To show the item in the main display, select "ON"
and press . 75793CD25D
75793CD25F 75793CD25H
· ODO meter
- Total : total ODO meter
To show the item in the main display, select "ON"
and press (this item could not reset).
- Latest : the latest ODO meter after reset.
To show the item in the main display, select "ON"
and press .
75793CD25J
To reset the latest odometer, select "initializing" and
press .
7-35
(4) Management
① Machine security
75793CD26
75793CD26A 75793CD26B
· Interval setting
- If set interval setting to 5 minutes,
ESL system is activated after 5
minutes.
Therefore, the password does not
need to restart engine within 5
minutes. 75793CD26J 75793CD26K
7-36
· Change password
- Input 5 to 10 digits and press *.
75793CD26G 75793CD26H
Enter the current password.
75793CD26L
Enter the new password.
75793CD26N 75793CD26M
The new password is stored Enter the new password
in the MCU. again.
7-37
② Maintenance
75793CD27
75793CD27A 75793CD27B
75793CD27D 75793CD27C
· Alarm ( ) : Warning
Replacement : The elapsed time will be reset to zero.
Change cycle : The change or replace cycle can be changed in the unit of 50 hours.
· To change cycle, press or .
· Change or replace interval
No Item Interval
1 Engine oil 500
★1
2000
2 Hydraulic oil ★2
5000
3 Pilot line filter element 250
4 Hydraulic oil return filter 250
5 Engine oil filter 500
6 Fuel filter element 500
7 Fuel pre-filter 500
8 Hydraulic tank air breather 250
9 Radiator coolant 2000
10 Transmission oil and filter 1000
11 Axle oil (front and rear) 1500
★1
: Conventional hydraulic oil
★2
: Hyundai genuine long life hydraulic oil
7-38
③ Machine information
75793CD28
75793CD28A 7809S3CD28B
75793CD28C 75793CD28D
· Version
- Software versions of MCU, cluster and monitor can be
checked.
· Status info
- The machine status can be checked.
75793CD28E
④ Service contact
75793CD29
75793CD29A 75793CD29B
· The phone number of the service man can be checked and changed.
⑤ Service menu
75793CD30
75793CD30A 75793CD30B
7-39
(5) DISPLAY SET UP
① Clock
75793CD32
75793CD32A
② Display
· Brightness setting
75793CD33
75793CD33A
75793CD33B 75793CD33C
Manual (1st~8th step)
75793CD33D 75793CD33E
7-40
· Display type
75793CD33I
B type
③ Unit
75793CD34
75793CD34A 75793CD34B
· Temperature : ˚C ↔ ˚F
· Distance : km ↔ mile
· Pressure : bar ↔ Mpa ↔ kgf/m2 ↔ psi
7-41
④ Rear camera
75793CD35
75793CD35A 75793CD35B
75793CD35C 75793CD35D
75793CD35E 75793CD35F
· Reverse mode
- If transmission engages the reverse gear (R1~R3), the camera mode is displayed
automatically in main display.
· Active camera
- Three cameras can be installed on the machine.
- The display order can be set by this menu.
· If the camera was not equipped, this menu is not useful.
· In main display, if the button is pushed, the first ordered display camera will be viewed.
⑤ Language
75793CD36
75793CD36A 75793CD36B
· User can select preferable language and all display are changed the selected language.
7-42
3. SWITCHES
M
Rear wiper/washer switch
Beacon switch(option) M
P
Horn button
M
A
Starting switch
M
A
7809S3CD29
1) STARTING SWITCH
(1) There are three positions, OFF, ON and START.
· (OFF) : None of electrical circuits activate.
· (ON) : All the systems of machine operate.
· (START) : Use when starting the engine.
Release key immediately after starting.
※ If you turn ON the starting switch in cold weather, the fuel warm-
77073CD41
er is automatically operated to heat the fuel by sensing the cool-
ant temperature. Start the engine in 1~2 minutes after turning
ON the starting switch. More time may take according to ambi-
ent temperature.
※ Key must be in the ON position with engine running maintain
electrical and hydraulic function and prevent serious machine
damage.
7-43
2) HAZARD SWITCH
(1) Use for parking, or loading the machine.
ON
OFF (2) Both turn signal lights will flash simultaneously.
※ If the switch is left ON for a long time, the battery may be dis-
charged.
75793CD42
75793CD46
7-44
7) FAN CONTROL SWITCH
(1) This switch use to control the cooling fan.
OFF
AUTO (2) This switch has three positions.
MANUAL ·AUTO
UTO : The fan automatically work in reverse according to set
up interval and time.
※ Refer to page 7-32.
·OFF
OFF : Only forward rotation is possible.
75793CD49
·MANUAL
MANUAL : The fan rotates reverse only while pressing this position.
If release the switch, return to the OFF position.
(3) On pressing the switch, the indicator lamp is turned ON.
75793CD50
7-45
11) EMERGENCY TEST SWITCH (option)
(1) The emergency steering system can be manually tested. Push the
switch in order to determine if the emergency steering and the
emergency steering lamp are functional.
M
(2) When the switch is pressed, the emergency steering pump motor
will run. The emergency steering lamp will light. If the emergency
75793CD52
steering lamp does not light, do not operate the machine.
7-46
15) DIFFERENTIAL LOCK SWITCH (option)
(1) This switch is used to apply differential lock.
OFF
MANUAL The differential lock gives equal power to both rear wheels and is
AUTO used in conditions when traction is poor.
M
A
7609S3CD16
HB1003CD63
7-47
19) KICK DOWN SWITCH
Kick down switch (1) Manual mode
It is effective 2nd speed to 1st speed only and recover to 2nd speed
quickly when push the switch one more time.
(2) Automatic mode
① Mode 1 (down/up)
It shifts down quickly from current gear to one step lower speed by
pushing the switch and recover to current speed quickly when push
7609S3CD24
the switch one more time.
② Mode 2 (down)
It shifts down from current gear to one step lower speed when
push the switch every time.
The kick down function is released in only 1st speed.
※ Refer to page 7-32 for the kick down setting.
※ The normal autoshift function continues after the kick down
switch is released.
7-48
GROUP 4 ELECTRICAL COMPONENT SPECIFICATION
Gravity
12V × 220Ah 1.280 over : over charged
Battery
(2EA) 1.280 ~ 1.250 : normal
1.250 below : discharged
CR-1
H BR ACC ST C
23 56
H 0 I II 4
Resistance between each pin
B-BR : 24V 1A
Key off : ∞Ω(for each pin)
Start key 0, I 1
B-ACC : 24V 10A
B Key on : 0Ω(for pin 1-2 & 1-3)
B-ST : 20V 40A
1 2 3 4 5 6 Start : 0Ω(for pin 1-5)
CS-2
A
- S +
Pa Voltage
Pressure B
- Pin A, B : 24V
sensor C
Pin B, C : 1~5V
CD-3 CD-26 CD-39
CD-40 CD-79
CD-48
7-49
Part name Symbol Specifications Check item
1
Parking brake Resistance
2
24V 1A
solenoid normal : 15~25Ω
CN-71
1 2 1
Resistance at normal position
Relay 2
3 24V 20A about 200Ωbetween pin 1-3
(4pin)
4 4 3
∞Ω between pin 2-4
AC RY(HI)
CR-2 CR-26 AC RY1
CR-5 CR-30 AC RY2
30
87a 87 85
86 Resistance
87
normal : about 160Ω
Relay 85
87a 30 86 24V 20A (for pin 85~86)
(5pin)
CR-5 CR-37 CR-46 CR-79 0Ω(for pin 30~87)
CR-25 CR-40 CR-59 ∞Ω(for pin 30~87)
CR-35 CR-41 CR-60
7-50
Part name Symbol Specifications Check item
2 3 4
1 Resistance
5
normal : about 160Ω
Relay 1 5 4
2
3 24V 20A (for pin 1~2)
(5 pin)
CR-2 CR-7 CR-38 CR-63 0Ω(for pin 3~4)
CR-3 CR-26 CR-55 ∞Ω(for pin 3~5)
CR-4 CR-36 CR-58
2 Resistance
Hydraulic C
- normal : ∞Ω
temperature 1
105。C over : 0Ω
CD-1
1 Resistance
Speaker 4Ω 20W
2 normal : 4Ω
CN-23(LH)
CN-24(RH)
7
3
1
10
4
12
9
11
Switch
∞Ωbetween pin 1-5 and 2-6
(Non-locking 24V 8A
1
11
9
7
type)
9
4
6
1
3
Work lamp
1
Work lamp, 24V 65W
2
Room lamp, Number plate lamp Resistance
Number plate CL-1
CL-1 CL-21CL-6
CL-32 CL-22
CL-35 24V 10W normal : 1.2Ω
lamp CL-5 CL-22 CL-33 CL-23
CL-5 CL-21 CL-36 Room lamp
CL-6 CL-23
24V 10W
7-51
Part name Symbol Specifications Check item
2 24V
24V Resistance
DC/DC 1 GND 12V 3A 8.8Ω(for pin A-B)
Converter 3 12V
12V
7.7Ω(for pin B-C)
CN-138
2 Resistance
PA
Receiver dryer 24V 2.5A 0Ω: 2.1±0.3~27±2kgf/cm²
1
∞Ω: ~2.1±0.3, 27±2~kgf/cm²
CN-29
REMOCON GND
SPK FRT RH+
REMOCON+
Resistance
BACK UP+
TEL MUTE
ANT 12V
Radio &
24V 20W+20W Power ON : 4Ω+4Ω
GND
GND
ACC
ILL+
ILL-
NC
NC
USB player
(for pin 1-6, 4-8)
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
CN-27
7-52
Part name Symbol Specifications Check item
M 1 Resistance
Washer pump 2 24V 2.5A normal : 26.4 Ω
(for pin1-2)
CN-103
CN-22 (FR)CN-22
CN-103 (RR)
E 3 1
Pf 2 2
B 1 3
4 24V 1.5A
Hi 4 5
Wiper motor Lo 5 6
2-speed -
M
Auto parking
CN-21 (FR) CN-102 (RR)
B
A Coil resistance
Cigar lighter 24V 5A 1.4W
1 normal : about 1MΩ
CL-2
B+
G
1 P
3~
2 L
U
Voltage
Alternator 3 FI 24V 80A
4 NC normal : 24~28V
CN-74
M
Delco Remy 42MT
Starter Operating or not
24V-7.5kW
B+
B
+ M
CN-45
2
Aircon Resistance
1 24V 79W
compressor normal : 13.4Ω
CN-28
7-53
Part name Symbol Specifications Check item
Coil resistance
normal : 1-2Ω
Start relay 24V 300A Switch connection
∞Ωat normal open position
CR-23 0Ωwhen engaged
Resistance
Door switch 24V 2W
normal : about 5MΩ
CS-1 CS-55
3 E
G 24V
2 B
Flasher unit 1 L
85 ~ 190 C/M -
50dB
CR-11
6 Lo
4 Hi 24V 75W/70W
5 (H4 TYPE) Resistance
Head lamp 3 C
E
24V 5W normal : a fewΩ
2
ABL
1 T (T4W)
CL-3 CL-4
4 C
24V 5W
3 T
Combi lamp (R5W)
2 E -
(rear) 2×24V 21W
1 S
(P21W)
CL-15 CL-16
7-54
Part name Symbol Specifications Check item
Continuous capaci-
ty :
Master switch 180Amp -
Push in capacity :
CS-74 1000Amp
2
24V 200mA
Warning buzzer 1 -
90±5dB (ℓm)
CN-26
Resistance
Preheater 24V 200A
0.25~0.12Ω
CN-80
A A
B Resistance
Resistor 4W
C B A - B : 120Ω
CN-99
7-55
GROUP 5 CONNECTORS
1. CONNECTOR DESTINATION
Connector No. of Connector part No.
Type Destination
number pin Female Male
CN-5 DEUTSCH 48 I/conn (Frame harness-Main harness) DRB16-48SAE-L018 DRB12-48PAE-L018
CN-6 DEUTSCH 60 I/conn (Frame harness-Main harness) DRB16-60SBE-L018 DRB12-60PBE-L018
CN-7 AMP 15 I/conn (Main harness-Cab harness) 2-85262-1 368301-1
CN-9 AMP 12 I/conn (Cab harness-Main harness) 2-85262-1 368301-1
CN-10 DEUTSCH 23 I/conn (Frame harness-Front harness) HD34-24-23PE HD36-24-23SE
CN-11 DEUTSCH 8 I/conn (Main harness-Aircon harness) DT06-8S DT04-8P
CN-12 AMP 15 I/conn (Frame harness-Bottom harness) 2-85262-1 368301-1
CN-13 DEUTSCH 8 I/conn (Frame harness-Engine harness) DT06-8S DT04-8P
CN-14 DEUTSCH 12 I/conn (Frame harness-Grill harness) DT06-12S DT04-12P
CN-19 Econoseal J 6 I/conn (Emer steer harness-Front harness) S816-006002 S816-106602
CN-20 Molex 2 Horn 36825-0211 -
CN-21 AMP 6 Front wiper motor 936257-1 -
CN-22 KET 2 Front washer tank MG640605 -
CN-23 KET 2 Speaker (LH) 7123-1520 -
CN-24 KET 2 Speaker (RH) 7123-1520 -
CN-25 Molex 2 Horn 36825-0211 -
CN-26 250 2 Warning buzzer S810-002202 -
CN-27 MK II 16 Radio and USB player PK145-16017 -
CN-27A MK II 8 USB connector 174984-2 -
CN-28 NMWP 1 Aircon compressor NMWP01F-B R5-10
CN-29 KET 2 Receiver drier MG640795 -
CN-36 - - Fuse box 21Q7-10910 -
CN-45 Ring term - Starter R14-12 ST 710246-2
CN-56 AMP 20 Cluster 174047-2 -
CN-57 AMP 20 Monitor 174047-2 -
CN-58A DEUTSCH 40 MCU DRC26-40-SA -
CN-58B DEUTSCH 40 MCU DRC26-40-SB -
CN-60 MTA 2 Fusible link (40A) 07.00910 03.21000
CN-65 DEUTSCH 2 Back up buzzer DT06-2S -
CN-71 DEUTSCH 2 Parking solenoid DT06-2S-EP06 -
CN-74 PACKARD 4 Alternator 1218-6568 S820-108000
CN-79 DEUTSCH 2 Differential lock - DT06-2S-EP06
7-56
Connector No. of Connector part No.
Type Destination
number pin Female Male
CN-83 NMWP 2 Aircon fan PB625-02027 -
CN-93 DEUTSCH 50 ECM DRC26-50S-01 -
CN-94 DEUTSCH 31 ECM power HD36-24-31SE -
CN-95 MTA 2 Fusible link (80A) 07.00960 03.210000
CN-96 - 2 Fuel heater 1530-0027 -
CN-99 DEUTSCH 2 Resister DT04-3P-EP10 -
CN-100 Econoseal J 3 Boom kick out S816-003002 S816-103002
CN-101A DEUTSCH 3 Bucket leveler - S816-103002
CN-102 AMP 6 Rear wiper motor 936257-1 -
CN-103 KET 2 Rear washer tank MG640605 -
CN-112 - 16 Gear box 21L7-60290 -
CN-114 - 6 Joy stick 1-480704-0 -
CN-126 DEUTSCH 9 Data link HD10-9-96P -
CN-136 AMP 2 Ride control solenoid 85202-1 -
CN-138 250 3 DC/DC Converter S810-003202 -
CN-139 250 2 12V socket S810-002202 -
CN-141 Econoseal J 6 I/conn (Ride control harness-Front harness) S816-006002 S816-106002
CN-154 AMP 2 Fan speed solenoid 85202-5 -
CN-155 AMP 2 Fan reverse solenoid 85202-1 -
CN-157 AMP 60 T/M control unit 962175 -
CN-158 PACKARD 4 Gear shift lever - 1201-0974
CN-159 PACKARD 4 Gear shift lever 1201-5797 -
CN-162 Econoseal J 6 Pedal S816-006602 -
CN-249 DEUTSCH 4 Camera DT06-4S DT04-4P
CN-250 Econoseal J 4 Rear view camera - S816-104602
CN-252 Econoseal J 6 I/conn (Diff lock harness-Front harness) S816-006002 S816-106002
Relay
CR-1 Ring term - Battery relay S820-104002 -
CR-2 AMP 5 Horn relay VCFM-1002 -
CR-3 AMP 5 Front work lamp relay VCFM-1002 -
CR-4 AMP 5 Wiper relay (Hi) VCFM-1002 -
CR-5 HELLA 5 Safety relay 8JA003526-001 -
CR-7 AMP 5 Aircon relay VCFM-1002 -
CR-11 HELLA 5 Flasher unit 8JA003526-001 -
CR-23 Ring term - Start relay S820-105000 -
CR-24 Shur 1 Preheater relay S822-014000 R5-10
7-57
Connector No. of Connector part No.
Type Destination
number pin Female Male
CR-25 HELLA 5 ECM power relay 8JA003526-001 -
CR-26 AMP 5 Wiper relay (low) VCFM-1002 -
CR-36 AMP 5 Preheater relay VCFM-1002 -
CR-39 Ring term - Emergency steering pump relay S820-104000 -
CR-46 HELLA 5 Fuel warmer relay 8JA003526-001 -
CR-55 AMP 5 Rear work lamp relay VCFM-1002 -
CR-56 KET 4 Mirror heat relay MG610047-1 -
CR-58 AMP 5 Back up relay VCFM-1002 -
CR-63 AMP 5 Stop lamp relay VCFM-1002 -
Switch
CS-1 Shur 1 Door switch S822-014004 -
CS-2 SWP 6 Start key switch S814-006000 -
CS-5 Shur 1 Horn switch S822-014000 -
CS-11 SWP 8 Multi function switch S814-008000 -
CS-12 SWP 6 Multi function switch S814-006000 -
CS-17 SWF 12 Parking switch 589790 -
CS-21 SWF 12 Main light switch 589790 -
CS-23 SWF 12 Beacon switch 589790 -
CS-35 SWF 12 Rear wiper 589790 -
CS-36 SWF 12 Work lamp switch 589790 -
CS-41 SWF 12 Hazard switch 589790 -
CS-42 DEUTSCH 3 Clutch cut off dial switch - DT06-3S-E008
CS-55 SWF 12 Ride control switch 589790 -
CS-59 DEUTSCH 3 Transmission shift dial switch - DT06-3S-E008
CS-73 SWF 12 Fan reverse switch 589790 -
CS-74 Ring term 4 Master switch ST710287-2 S820-205000
CS-75 SWF 12 Emergency steering test switch 589790 -
CS-76 SWF 12 Mirror heater switch 589790 -
CS-80 DEUTSCH 3 Econo mode dial switch DT06-3S-E008 -
7-58
Connector No. of Connector part No.
Type Destination
number pin Female Male
Light
CL-1 KET 3 Room lamp MG651032 -
CL-2 250 3 Cigar lighter S810-003202 -
CL-3 DEUTSCH 6 Head light (LH) DT06-6S -
CL-4 DEUTSCH 6 Head light (RH) DT06-6S -
CL-5 DEUTSCH 2 Work light (LH) DT06-2S-EP06 -
CL-6 DEUTSCH 2 Work light (RH) DT06-2S-EP06 -
CL-7 250 2 Beacon lamp S810-002202 -
CL-15 SWP 4 Combi lamp (RR, LH) S814-004000 -
CL-16 SWP 4 Combi lamp (RR, RH) S814-004000 -
CL-21 SWP 2 Numberplate lamp S814-002000 -
CL-22 DEUTSCH 2 Work light (LH) DT06-2S -
CL-23 DEUTSCH 2 Work light (RH) DT06-2S -
CL-24 SWP 2 Turn lamp (LH) S814-002000 -
CL-25 SWP 2 Turn lamp (RH) S814-002000 -
CL-30 KET 2 Room lamp MG610392 -
CL-32 DEUTSCH 2 Rear work light (RH) DT06-2S-EP06 DT04-2P-E005
CL-33 DEUTSCH 2 Rear work light (LH) DT06-2S-EP06 DT04-2P-E005
Sensor, sender
CD-1 AMP 2 Hyduaulic oil temp sendor 85202-1 -
CD-2 SWP 2 Fuel sendor S814-002000 -
CD-3 DEUTSCH 3 Brake fail pressure switch DT06-3S -
CD-4 DEUTSCH 4 Stop lamp / Clutch cut off pressure switch DT06-4S-EP06 -
CD-5 PACKARD 3 Clutch cut off pressure switch - 12015793
CD-10 Ring term 2 Air cleaner switch GP890469 -
CD-17 AMP 2 Engine pick-up sensor 85202-1 -
CD-26 DEUTSCH 3 Parking pressure switch DT06-3S -
CD-27 AMP 2 Turbin pick up sensor 85202-1 -
CD-41 DEUTSCH 4 Boom down pressure switch DT06-4S -
CD-46 AMP 3 Output speed sensor 282087 -
CD-47 AMP 2 Gear chain senser 85202-5 -
CD-48 AMP 2 Oil filter 282080 -
CD-49 AMP 2 Converter sensor 85202-1 -
CD-73 AMP 2 Speed sendsor 174352-2 -
CD-79 DEUTSCH 3 Differential lock sensor - DT06-3S-EP06
7-59
2. CONNECTION TABLE FOR CONNECTORS
1) 58-L TYPE CONNECTOR
No. of
Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
pin
1 1
S813-030100 S813-130100
1 2 1 2
S813-030200 S813-130200
7-60
2) PA TYPE CONNECTOR
No. of
Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
pin
2 5 1 3
1 3 2 5
S811-005002 S811-105002
3 7 1 4
1 4 3 7
S811-007002 S811-107002
4 9
1 5
1 5
4 9
S811-009002 S811-109002
5 11 1 6
11
1 6 5 11
S811-011002 S811-111002
7-61
No. of
Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
pin
6 13 1 7
13
1 7 6 13
S811-013002 S811-113002
1 9
8 17
17
1 9 8 17
S811-017002 S811-117002
110 21 1 11
21
1 11 1
10 21
S811-021002 S811-121002
7-62
3) J TYPE CONNECTOR
No. of
pin Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
1 2
1
2 12
S816-002001 S816-102001
2 3 1
3 1 2
S816-003001 S816-103001
3 1 4 2
4 2 3 1
S816-004001 S816-104001
8 5 2
6 3 1
8 5 2 6 3 1
S816-008001 S816-108001
7-63
4) SWP TYPE CONNECTOR
No. of
pin Receptacle connector (Female) Plug connector (male)
1 1
S814-001000 S814-101000
2 1
1 2
S814-002000 S814-102000
3 1
2 1 23
S814-003000 S814-103000
2 4 1 3
1 3 2 4
S814-004000 S814-104000
7-64
No. of
pin Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
3 6 1 4
3 6
1 4
S814-006000 S814-106000
4 8 1 5
4 8
1 5
S814-008000 S814-108000
4 12 1 9
12
4 12
1 9
S814-012000 S814-112000
3 14 11
1
14
1 11 3 14
S814-014000 S814-114000
7-65
5) CN TYPE CONNECTOR
No. of
pin Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
1 1
S810-001202 S810-101202
2 2
1 1
S810-002202 S810-102202
3 2
1 2 1 3
S810-003202 S810-103202
2 4 1 3
1 3 2 4
S810-004202 S810-104202
7-66
No. of
pin Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
3 6 1 4
1 4 3 6
S810-006202 S810-106202
4 8 1 5
1 5 4 8
S810-008202 S810-108202
7-67
6) ITT SWF CONNECTOR
No. of
pin Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
10
1 12
11
SWF589790
6 3
4
6
6189-0133
8) MWP02F-B CONNECTOR
No. of
pin Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
2 1
2
PH805-02028
7-68
9) AMP ECONOSEAL CONNECTOR
No. of
pin Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
12
1
12
13 24
36
25
24 36 1
13
36
25
344111-1
344111-1 344108-1
344108-1
85202-1
12 1 6
7 12
174045-2
7-69
12) KET 090 WP CONNECTORS
No. of
pin Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
2 1
MG640795
2
10
1 10
SWF593757
1
1
NMWP01F-B
7-70
15) DEUTSCH DT CONNECTORS
DT 06 - 3S - ★★★★
No. of
pin Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
1 2 2 1
2
DT06-2S DT04-2P
2 1 1 2
3 3
DT06-3S DT04-3P
4 1 1 4
3 2 2 3
DT06-4S DT04-4P
7-71
No. of
pin Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
6 1 1 6
4 3 3 4
DT06-6S DT04-6P
4 5 5 4
1 8
8 1
DT06-8S DT04-8P
7 6
6 7
12
1 12 12 1
DT06-12S DT04-12P
7-72
16) ECONOSEAL J TYPE CONNECTORS
No. of
pin Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
S816-001002 S816-101002
1 2 1
2
S816-002002 S816-102002
S816-003002 S816-103002
S816-004002 S816-104002
7-73
No. of
pin Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
S816-006002 S816-106002
S816-008002 S816-108002
10
S816-010002 S816-110002
12
S816-012002 S816-112002
7-74
No. of
pin Receptacle connector (female) Plug connector (male)
15
368301-1 2-85262-1
12040753
5
1 6
11 1
10
2
3
11 4
5
21
6
40 21 31
32
7
8
9
33 10
34
35
31 36
37
20
30
20
38
39
35 40
36
30
40
DRC26-40SA/B/C
7-75
GROUP 6 TROUBLESHOOTING
1. WHEN STARTING SWITCH IS TURNED ON, CLUSTER AND MONITOR LAMP DOES NOT
LIGHT UP
·Before carrying out below procedure, check all the related connectors are properly inserted and the
fuse [CN-36] No.12 is not blown out and ON/OFF of bulb.
·After checking, connect the disconnected connectors again immediately unless otherwise
specified.
Cause Remedy
YES
Defective cluster Replace
Check voltage Defective monitor Replace
between CN-56
(1), CN-57(1) and
chassis
Disconnection in Repair or
NO
wiring harness or replace
poor contact (after clean)
between CN-56
(1), CN-57 (1)
and fuse No. 12
MONITOR
CN-57
CLUSTER
FUSE[CN-36]
1
No.12
CN-56
Check voltage
YES 20 ~ 30 V
NO 0V
7609A7EL24
7-76
2. WHEN BATTERY LAMP LIGHTS UP (engine is started)
·Before carrying out below procedure, check all the related connectors are properly inserted.
·After checking, connect the disconnected connectors again immediately unless otherwise
specified.
Cause Remedy
YES
Check voltage Defective Replace
YES controller
between CN-58A
(B36) and chassis
NO Disconnection in Repair or replace
Voltage : 27.5~30V wiring harness or (after clean)
poor contact
Check voltage between CN-58A
YES between CN-6
(B36) and CN-6 (49)
(49) and chassis
YES
Voltage : 26~30V Disconnection in Repair or replace
wiring harness or (after clean)
Check voltage poor contact
Check voltage between CN-13 between CN-13
NO
between (8) and chassis (8) and CN-6 (49)
alternator
terminal "2" and Disconnection in Repair or replace
chassis NO
wiring harness or (after clean)
Voltage : 26~30V poor contact
Starting switch : ON
between CN-13
(8) and alternator
terminal " 2 "
CONTROLLER(MCU)
49
ALTERNATOR
B36 8 " 2 " TERMINAL
CN-6 CN-13
CN-58A
Check valtage
YES 20 ~ 30 V
NO 0V 75797EL30
7-77
3. WHEN PARKING SOLENOID DOES NOT WORK
·Before carrying out below procedure, check all the related connectors are properly inserted and the
fuse [CN-36] No.29 is not blown out.
·After checking, connect the disconnected connectors again immediately unless otherwise specified.
Cause Remedy
YES
Defective parking Replace
Check voltage brake solenoid
YES between CS-17
Check voltage (4) and chassis
YES between CN-5 Disconnection in Repair or replace
Voltage : 20~30V NO wiring harness or (after clean)
(30) and chassis
Check voltage
poor contact
between CN-71 Voltage : 20~30V
between CS-17
(2) and chassis
(4) and CN-5 (30)
Starting switch : ON
Parking switch : ON-OFF YES
Voltage : 20~30V Disconnection in Repair or replace
wiring harness or (after clean)
poor contact
Check voltage between CN-12
between CN-12 (13) and CN-5
NO
(13) and chassis
(30)
Voltage : 20~30V
Disconnection in Repair or replace
NO
wiring harness or (after clean)
poor contact
between CN-12
(13) and CN-71
(2)
YES
Difective parking Replace
Check voltage
switch
between CS-17
NO
(7) and chassis
Disconnection in Repair or replace
Voltage : 20~30V NO
wiring harness or (after clean)
poor contact
between CS-17
(7) and Fuse
No.29
PARKING SWITCH
8 FUSE [CN-36]
7
4 No.29
CN-5 CN-12
CS-17
30 13 2
1
CN-71
7609A7EL31
7-78
4. TRANSMISSION IS NOT RETURNED TO NEUTRAL WHEN PARKING BRAKE IS APPLIED
·Before carrying out below procedure, check all the related connectors are properly inserted and the
fuse [CN-36] No.29 is not blown out.
·After checking, connect the disconnected connectors again immediately unless otherwise
specified.
Cause Remedy
YES
Defective T/M Replace
control unit
YES
Voltage : 20~30V Defective switch Replace
Parking switch : ON Check voltage
between CS-17
NO
(7) and chassis
Disconnection in Repair or replace
NO
Voltage : 20~30V wiring harness or (after clean)
poor contact
between CS-17 (7)
and fuse No.29
PARKING SWITCH
8 FUSE[CN-36]
7
3 No.29
T/M CONTROL UNIT
CS-17
21
CN-157
Check resistance
YES MAX 1Ω
7609A7EL32
NO MIN 1MΩ
7-79
5. MACHINE DOES NOT TRAVEL
·Before carrying out below procedure, check all the related connectors are properly inserted and the
fuse [CN-36] No.11 (transmission controller) is not blown out.
·After checking, connect the disconnected connectors again immediately unless otherwise
specified.
·Wiring diagram : See page 7-17.
Cause Remedy
YES
Defective clutch Replace
cut-off mode
Check resistance
YES switch
between CD-4
and chassis
Is there continuity
NO
between CN-157
(38) and chassis? Defective T/M Replace
NO
control unit
Is voltage between
Defective T/M Replace
CN-157(21) and NO
chassis 20-28V? control unit
Check resistance
YES MAX 1Ω
NO MIN 1MΩ
7-80
6. WHEN STARTING SWITCH IS TURNED ON, WIPER MOTOR DOES NOT OPERATE
·Before carrying out below procedure, check all the related connectors are properly inserted and the
fuse No.28 is not blown out.
·After checking, connect the disconnected connectors again immediately unless otherwise
specified. FUSE BOX
SERVICE SOCKET 1 20A
25
SEAT HEAT/AIR-RIDE 20A
26
WORK LAMP_REAR 20A
27
Cause Remedy Br WIPER 20A
28
PARK, PILOT CUT
YES 20A
29
Check voltage Defective front Replace JOYSTICK-DETENT 10A
30
30A
YES between front wiper motor PRE-HEAT, FUEL WARMER
31
FAN REVERSE, ATT. 20A
wiper motor and RIDE CONTROL 10A
32
YES chassis
between CN-21(5) Starting switch : ON CN-36
Wiper switch : 1st
and chassis
Voltage : 20~30V
WIPER RY HI
Starting switch : ON Disconnection in Repair or replace Y
4
Wiper switch : 1st NO 3 2
YES Check voltage
B
1
wiring harness or (after clean) R
between CS-12 Br
5
(4) and chassis poor contact Br
2
3 4 5 1
between CN-21(5) CR-4
Voltage : 20~30V and CR-26(3)
Starting switch : ON WIPER RY LO
Wiper switch : OFF G
4 3 2
W
1
Y
FRONT WIPER 5
Y Y Y
3E 1 2
G LW W
Defective wiper Repair or replace 2Pf
B
2
B 3 4 5 1
NO 1B
L
3
R CR-26
Check voltage switch or (after clean) R
4
W
4 Hi 5
CS-12 (6) disconnection in M
5 Lo 6
CN-21
wiring harness or CN-102
Voltage : 20~30V poor contact
Starting switch : ON
Wiper switch : 1st
between CS-12(4)
and CR-26(4)
LOr
LW
Gr
Br
Br
G
poor contact
between CS-12(6)
and fuse [CN-36]
CS-11
CS-12
CS-5
CN-58A
WIPER INT SIG A23
A31
B02
1
2
3
4
5
6
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
No.28
HO
RW
BVi
BY
4BWG
Gr
W
G
L
WIPER RLY
Y
6
2
6
1
3
5
WASH SIG
C
Hi
J
C
W
II
II
J
Hi Lo
I
O
B+
C
MCU
F
L
R
O
L
R
Y 7 Lo
B 5
WB 8
BG 3
BW 2
MULTI FUNCTION SWITCH
7609A7EL33
7-81
7. WHEN STARTING SWITCH "ON" DOES NOT OPERATE
·Before carrying out below procedure, check all the related connectors are properly inserted and the
fuse No.3 is not blown out.
·After checking, connect the disconnected connectors again immediately unless otherwise MASTER SW CN-60
3R 105
specified. 3R 106
CS-74-CR-1. 1
20A TURN LAMP 36
5A RADIO/ROOM LAMP 37
2
30A START KEY SWITCH R
38
Check voltage 3
Disconnection in Repair or replace 4
10A TCU 24V BATTERY
47
and specific NO 20A ECM 24V BATTERY
5
gravity of battery wiring harness (after clean) 20A MCU 24V BATTERY
48
6
20A AIR-CON/HEATER 2 CN-5
or poor contact 7
Specific gravity : MIN 1.28 10A CLUSTER 24V BATTERY
8
Voltage : MIN 24V b e t we e n f u s e 3R
No. 3 and CS-2
CN-36
(1) or defect of
start switch
RW
R
CS-2
2
6
5
4
1
B
0, I
1
H 0 I II
4
6
5
3
2
H
C ST ACC BR
START SWITCH
7579S7EL34
7-82
8. WHEN STARTING SWITCH IS TURNED ON, WORK LAMP DOES NOT LIGHTS UP FUSE BOX
1
BEACON 10A
·Before carrying out below procedure, check all the related connectors are properly inserted, and 2
GW WORK LAMP_FRONT 20A
15
16
3
the fuse [CN-36] No. 16, 27 is not blown out. MIRROR,SER.SOCKET2 20A
17
4 ILL.LAMP 20A
·After checking, connect the disconnected connectors again immediately unless otherwise 5 HEAD LAMP 20A
18
19
RW RW 10A
specified. 6 BACK.STOP LAMP
HORN/CONVERTER 20A
20
7 21
AIR-CON/HEATER 1 30A
22
8 20A
FUEL WARMER
23
9 CIGARLIGHTER 30A
24
Cause Remedy 10
YES 11
Defective lamp Replace
YES Check voltage
SERVICE SOCKET 1 20A
12 25
SPARE 20A
between each 13
Y WORK LAMP_REAR 20A
26
W W W 27
lamp and chassis FR WORK 1
B
14 WIPER 20A
Disconnection in Repair or replace LAMP-LH 2
15
28
NO CL-5 PARK 20A
29
Check voltage Voltage : 20~30V wiring harness or (after clean) CN-7 JOYSTICK-DETENT 10A
Starting switch : ON W 30
between poor contact FR WORK
LAMP-RH
1
B PRE-HEAT/FUEL WARMER 30A
31
YES 2
CN-7(14), between CL-6 (2), CL-6 FAN REVERSE/ATT 20A
32
RIDE CONTROL 10A
W W W
Check voltage Voltage : 20~30V CN-7 (14), CN-6 1
B
2 LOr
2
between Starting switch : ON (33). 3 ILLUMINATION 1 5A
35
FR WORK LAMP
4
W
YES CR-3(5), 1
B 5
ILLUMINATION 2 5A
36
CR-55(5) and Disconnection in Repair or replace 2
NO CL-36 6 CN-36
chassis wiring harness or (after clean)
7
poor contact CL-32
RW
Voltage : 20~30V 1 8
Starting switch : ON between CN-7 2
B
9
Check voltage (14) -CR-3 (5) and RR WORK LAMP
between 10
RW
CN-6 (33) - CR-55 1
B 11
CR-3(3), (5) 2 FR WORK LAMP RY
CL-33 12 4
CR-55(3) and B
1
3 2
13 W
chassis Defective work Replace relay Y
5
14 2
Voltage : 20~30V NO GW
lamp relay 8 15
3 4 5 1
Starting switch : ON CR-3
YES RW 9 CN-9
RR WORK 1
Disconnection in Repair or replace LAMP-LH 2
B
10 31 RR WORK LAMP RY
wiring harness or (after clean) CL-22 B
11
B
32 B
4 3 2
1
Check voltage poor contact RR WORK 1
RW RW
12 RW RW 33 RW RW
5
B VW
LAMP-RH
between fuse between CR-3 (3), 2
CL-23
CN-14 34 Y
2
4 5 1
3
NO [CN-36] No. 16, CR-55 (3) and fuse 35 CR-55
6
LOr
6 7
LOr
4
9 9
3
7
R
11
12 1
12
B
CS-36
12 11
1
3
4 CLUSTER
R 17 ILLUMINATION
6
6 LOr CN-56
7
4
MONITOR
R R
9 9 18 ILLUMINATION
3
7 CN-57
R
11
12 1
12
B
CS-21
7809S7EL35
7-83